Home
        ONKYO TX-NR646
         Contents
1.                                                                                                                                                                                          Remote Control Codes Amstrad 10037  10171  Bang  amp  Olufsen 10620 Bush 11037  10037   11037 Barco 10556 12676  10668   E Television  A to E  Anam 10037  10650 Base 10698 10714  13790   A R  Systems 10037  10556 Andersson 12676  11585 Basic Line 10037  10668  13005  11667   ACCENT 10037 Anitech 10037 11037  10556 11687  11983   Acoustic Solutions 11667  11585  Ansonic 10668  10037 Bauer 12197 10556  12125     11523  11037 AOC 11589  12769  Baur 10037  10512  a Wee  Action 10650 11365  13720  10195 Se D  Accom a 12014  12087  BBK 12098  11523 on    Addison 10653  11150 13790  10093  Beaumark 10178      Admiral 10093 10178  10625  Bailinig 10208  10812 E e  SES 12197  11037  ass Beko 10714  12125   12239 Apex Digital 12397 10037  12239 Camper 10037  Affinity 13717  13870  Apollo 12239 Bell  amp  Howell 10017 Carad 11037  10668  13577 Ardem 10714  10037 Carena 10037  Belson 10698  11667  Aftron 13478 Arena 10037 Bento 11037 Carrefour 10037  Aiko 10037 Ario 12397 BenQ 12563  11562  Cascade 10037  Aim 10037 Aristona 10556  10037 11523 Casio 10037  Akai 12676  10812  ART 11037 Beon 10037 Cathay 10037  10037  10672  Art Mito 11585  11667 Berthen 10556  10668 CCE 13782  14091   10208  10714  AS 11667  11585  Bestar 10037 10037  11523  13067  11523  11037 ELI           Celcus 12676  11585  Bexa 12493  
2.                                                                                                                    Maxess 12493   Meck 10698   Mediator 10037  10556   Medion 12676  10714   10037  10668   11037  11585   11667  10512   12239  13067   10556  10698   12563   Megatron 10178   MEI 11037   Melectronic 10037  10195   10634  10512   10714   Memorex 11687  11037   11670  10178   10150   Memory 11983   Mercury 10037   Mermaid 10037   Metronic 10625   Metz 11037  10668   10195   MGA 10150  10178   Micromaxx 10037  10668   10714  11037   Microsonic 13419   Midland 10017   Mikomi 11585  11667   Minato 10037   Minerva 10195   Ministry Of Sound 11667   Minoka 10037                               Miray 12414  13183   10898  Misakai 10171                Kioto 10556   Kiton 10037  10668   KLL 10037   Kneissel 10037  10556   Kolin 11610  10150   11755  10037   11150   Kolster 10037   Konig 10037  10512   Konka 12881  13419   10037  10714   Korpel 10037   Kosmos 10037   Kunlun 10208   Kuppersbusch 12676   L amp S Electronic 10714   Lavis 11037   Leader 12876   Lecson 10037   Legend 12397  12309   Lenco 12676  11983   10037  11037   Leyco 10037   LG 11840  11860   11423  12 31   12182  12358   10178  12362   13941  12424   10037  10714   10017  10556   10698  11753   Liberton 13183   Liesenkotter 10037   Lifetec 10668  10037   11037  10714   Linetech 12676   Linsar 12676  11667   11585   Lloyd 13639   Lodos 11037                   Loewe 10512  10633   10037   Logic 11585   Logik 13
3.                                                                                        50       Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            hFX 01272   Howard Computers     01272   HP 01272   Hush 01272   iBUYPOWER 01272   iconBIT 03350  02709   ICY Box 03350   iNext 03350   lomega 02558   ISTAR 02260   JadooTV 02260   Keedox 04442   LG 03373   Linksys 01272   Magnavox 03339   Medea8er 02709   Media Center PC 01272   Micca 03669   Microsoft 01272  01805   04000   Mind 01272   Netgear 03324  04401   03292   NiveusMedia 01272   Northgate 01272   Omniverse 04421   Packard Bell 01272   Panasonic 03760   Philips 01272   Pivos 04339   PopBox 02260   Popcorn Hour 02260   RCA 03335   Ricavision 01272   Roku 03061  02371   Seagate 02698   Sony 02713  01272   Stack 9 01272   Sumvision 04339   Systemax 01272          Tagar Systems 01272  Toshiba 01272  Touch 01272  TrekStor 02723  Trust 01272  VIA Technologies 01272  Viewsonic 01272  VIZIO 03670  Voodoo 01272  Western Digital 02558  Woxter 02709  Xbox 01805  04000   01272  Xtreamer 02723  ZT Group 01272  NH CD  A V Internationa
4.                                                                        New Acoustic 10037  10178   Dimension   New Sonic 11826   New Tech 10037  10556   Newave 10093  10178   11150   NEX 13861   Nexus Electronics 12183   Nikkai 10037   Nikkei 12197  10714   Nikko 10178  10017   Nimbro 12104   Noblex 14029   Nokia 10208   Norcent 11365  11589   Nordmende 13419  13861   10037  10195   11585  13835   10714  11667   Normerel 10037   Nortek 10668   Novatronic 10037   Novex 11523   Novita 11585   NPG 13434   B Television  O to S    O K Line 11037   Oceanic 10208   OK Line 11037   OK  13434  12676   13047   Okano 10037   OKI 11667  12676   12125  13434   11585   Olevia 11610   Omni 10698   Onei 11667   Onida 10653  12414   En 70       Onimax 10714   Onix 10698   Onkyo 11807  13100   13500   Onn 12125  11667   Opera 10037  10714   Optimus 10650  10679   Optoma 12796   Optonica 10093   Orava 11037   Orbit 10037   Orion 12108  10037   12676  10556   10714  11037   11667  13540   13650   Orline 10037   Ormond 10668  11037   Osaki 10037  10556   Osio 10037   Osume 10037   Otic 11983  11498   11687   Otto Versand 10037  10512   10093  10556   10195   Pacific 10714  11037   10556   Palladium 10037  10714   10556   Palsonic 12461  10698   13067  10037   Panama 10037   Panasonic 11636  11480   11291  10650   11650  13825   12170  10037   10093  10150   10178  10208   10508   Panavideo 13825     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller  Panavision 10037 Polaroid 11523  11769   Panavo
5.                                                     Aiwa 30533   Akai 32966  30770   31233  30675   Akura 231233   Alba 32966  30713   30539  30730   Amitech 30770   Amphion MediaWorks   30872       Amstrad    30713  30770   32139                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Celcus 32966   Centrum 30713  30675   Changhong 30627   Cinea 30831   Cineral 30730   Cinetec 30713  30872   CJ Digital 31643   Classic 30730   Clatronic 30675  31233   Clayton 30713   CMX 31643   Coby 32494  30730   Codex 31233   Continental Edison 30831  30872   Craig 30831   Crown 30713  30770   Cybercom 30831   CyberHome 31023   Daenyx 30872   Daewoo 30770  30872   30490   Dansai 30770   Dantax 30713  30539   32966   Datsun 31233   Daytek 30872   Dayton Audio 30872   DCE 30831   Decca 30770   Denon 31634  32258   30490  32748   33851   Denver 31643   Dewo 31634   Dick Smith Electronics   32095  30675   Digihome 32966  30713   DigiLogic 30713   DiK 30831   Dikom 32494   Disney 30675  30831                   AMW 30872   Ansonic 30831   Anthem 32820   Anthem Statement 32820   Aristona 30539  30646   Arrgo 31023   AS 30730  30713   ASDA 32213   Audio Authority 32555   Audix 30713   Autovox 30713   Awa 30730  30872   Axion 30730   Basic Line 30713
6.                                                     Input Format Listening Mode Input Format Listening Mode  DTS HD MSTR Direct DTS X Direct  DTS HD MSTR      DTS X  Dolby Surround Game RPG    DTS Neural X Game Action     Game RPG   Game Rock    Game Action   Game Sports    Game Rock  AllCh Stereo     Game Sports    Full Mono   AllCh Stereo   T D  Full Mono      Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed   EES    Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  T D installed                 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode  DTS ES Direct   DIS    ES Matrix     ES Discrete   DTS ES Discrete      Dolby Surround    DTS Neural X  Game RPG 4  Game Action 4  Game Rock    Game Sports     AllCh Stereo     Full Mono     T D       Can only be selected when the back speakers are not installed       Back speakers need to be installed     3 Height speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed                                                  En 27             Connections Initial Setup Playing Back mvchifclniesciel bleu eN  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controll
7.                                   Sencor 12197  Sharp 10818  12676   12360  Shinelco 12104  Shivaki 12197  Skyworth 12963  Soniq 12493  13005  Sontech 11983  Sony 12778  10000  Soundwave 11037  12673  SOVOS 12239  Supersonic 11753  12104  Swisstec 12106  12104  Sylvania 11886  11864   11394  10171  Tauras 12197  Teac 10698  11983   13005  Technica 11037  12426  Technical 12676  Technika 12426  12197   12106  11983   13005  Techwood 12676  Telefunken 12239  10698   12676  Teletech 11037  Tesco 12426  Tevion 12426  Thomson 12675  10625   13047  Toshiba 13323  12676   11524  11656  TVE 12239  UMC 12426  12106  United 11037  11983  VD Tech 13067  Venturer 13005  Vestel 11037  Viewsonic 12049             En 93          Connections Initial Setup Playing Back exo eleejsie b  leen  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller          ONE YO    Onkyo Corporation  Kitahama Chuo Bldg  2 2 22 Kitahama  Chuo ku  OSAKA 541 0041  JAPAN  http   www onkyo com     The Americas   Onkyo U S A  Corporation   18 Park Way  Upper Saddle River  N J  07458  U S A    For Dealer  Service  Order and all other Business Inquiries   Tel  201 785 2600 Fax  201 785 2650  http   www us onkyo com     For Product Support Team Only   1 800 229 1687  http   www us onkyo com     Europe   Onkyo Europe Electronics GmbH  Liegnitzerstrasse 6  82194 Groebenzell  GERMANY  Tel   49 8142 4401 0 Fax   49 8142 4208 213  http   www eu onkyo com     Onkyo Europe Electronics GmbH  UK Branch    Meridien House  Ground floor
8.                         Cable America  Cable Axion Digitel    01376  01877  01376  00476                                              Go Video 30741   GPX 30741   Hitachi 31664   Humax 30646   Insignia 32095   Irradio 30646   JVC 30623  32612   LG 30741   Loewe 30741   Magnavox 30675  30646   31506   Medion 30741   NEC 30741   Panasonic 30490  31579   33580  32710   32859  32523   Philips 30646  31340   31506  32334   30539  32056   Pioneer 30631   Pye 30646  30675   RCA 30522   Samsung 31635  32942   39195  32107   30490  32069   32489   Schneider 30646   Sharp 39313  30630     30675  30713       Silva Schneider    30741       Sony    31070  31033   32861  31516   31536  32839   32180  31633    ABN 03322  02997   02979  03340   03407  03849   Access 01376  00476   Communications   ACT 02950   Adams Cable TV 01376    ADB    02586  01920   01585  01927   01481  01998   02254  02302   02437  03028                                                                                           Sylvania 30675   Targa 30741   Tchibo 30741   TCM 30741   Thomson 30551   Toshiba 32271  32551   30503   Universum 30741                                     Akado 02043   Aland 02030  02437  Alands 02030  02437  Datakommunikation   Alcom 02030  02437  Alice 01585  Allegiance 00476  01376  Communications   Allen TV Cable 00476   Altibox 02437  02030             Astound Broadband 01376  01977  Cable HK 01374  00476  02479  Cable One 01376  00476   04079 01877  AT amp T 00858 Cablecom 01582  AT amp 
9.                 REMOTE MODE          eg   50             EM    n    ie       e          Q    Re       SETUP       IJ        gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          The Setup menu is displayed on the TV screen        CH Setup    1  Input Output Assign        1LMOu   2  Speaker 2 HDMI Input   3  Audio Adjust 3  Video Input   4  Source 4  Digital Audio Input  5  Listening Mode Preset   6  Hardware   7  Remote Controller    8  Miscellaneous             2  With the cursors  select  8  Miscellaneous     Firmware  Update     Update via NET   and then press ENTER        ix Setup    1  Input Output Assign 1  Firmware Update  2  Speaker 2  Initial Setup   3  Audio Adjust 3  Lock   4  Source   5  Listening Mode Preset   6  Hardware   T  Remote Controller    8  Miscellaneous             e  f  Firmware Update  is grayed out and cannot be  selected  wait for a while until it starts up    e You will not be able to select  Update via NET  if  there is nothing to update     3  Press ENTER with  Update  selected to start update    e During the update  the TV screen may go black  depending on the updated program  In that case   check the progress on the display of the unit  The TV  screen will remain black until the update is complete  and the power is turned on again    e  Completed   is displayed when the update is  complete     4  Press OON STANDBY on the main unit to turn the unit  into standby mode  The process is completed and your  firmware is updated to the latest v
10.                 Setting Item Default Value Setting Details Network  Network Standby Off When this function is  On   you can turn on Make the network setting   the power of the unit via network using an e When LAN is configured with a DHCP  set  DHCP  to  Enable  to configure the  application such as Onkyo Remote setting automatically    Enable  is set by default  To assign fixed IP addresses to each  e When  Network Standby  is ed the power components  you must set  DHCP  to  Disable  and assign an address to this unit in  consumption increases even when the unit  IP Address  as well as set information related to your LAN  such as Subnet Mask and  is on standby  However  the increase in Gateway   power consumption is kept to a minimum    B    by automatically entering the HYBRID Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details  STANDBY mode  where only the essential Wi Fi Off  Wired  Connect the unit to network via wireless LAN  circuit is operating  router   Bluetooth Wakeup     Off This function wakes up the unit on standby by  On   Wireless LAN connection  connecting a Bluetooth enabled device   Off  Wired    Wired LAN connection   On   Use this function Wi Fi Setup     You can configure wireless LAN settings by   Off   Do not use this function pressing ENTER when  Start  is displayed   e Setting to On  increases the Pa Wi Fi Status     The information of the connected access point  consumption even when the unit is on ill    sol  standby  However  the increase in power will b
11.                 TV operation A    Bo e dh     LJ tJ LJ  p t 9 qo            Gi    Bd p  2  m ec  Press the REMOTE MODE button programmed with   atcur a 9 cube PREV CH  the remote control code for the relevant AV component KD Dem          aust dans  to switch the remote controller mode to that for the AV o o        OX  9   component  Then  operate by using the corresponding    ogg ma  buttons  Available buttons vary depending on the product D TI o o 0    SS     category of the component  Operation may be incorrect or    n       d ab db  impossible depending on the product    RO  e    m    6  TOP MENU  SEN    A     lt   gt   ENTER  o D HOME  Ie EA 3  gt   EE HE   gt  gt   Ie E  kl MENU    e   e   e       41  A  Red   B  Green   C  Yellow   D  Blue   9 RETURN  Iess GE  CE  Gall 42 Number 1 to 9  0   10  D     3  CLR  DISPLAY ee ee  CE ee 3  x Not CEC compatible  Dr Ca  GE GD    lo rl    Oo em gp CO mo  CORE ucl el CIT   Blu ray Disc player DVD player DVD recorder   Di Gi  9         INPUT Y ALBUM   i  Z operation             os         REMOTE MODE Press the REMOTE MODE button programmed with         e  D     O  INPUT  VOL AT the remote control code for the relevant AV component   el    mA   3 MUTING to switch the remote controller mode to that forthe AV     1            4  CH    component  Then  operate by using the corresponding  gt  IL ON Aa      L  a bb  buttons  Available buttons vary depending on the product o A Red   B  Gre C  Yell D  BI     Red   B  Green   C  Yellow   D  
12.                Full Mono             T D    Listening Mode                Dolby Surround  DTS Neural X       TV Logic        AllCh Stereo         Full Mono            T D          Mono       Dolby Surround       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed      Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed    3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be    installed     Dolby Atmos   e  he listening mode  of Dolby Digital Plus  or Dolby TrueHD can  be selected if back  speakers or height  speakers are not  connected     Direct       Mono       Dolby Atmos       TV Logic       AllCh Stereo       Full Mono       T D             Neo 6 Cinema        DTS Neural X       TV Logic        AllCh Stereo         Full Mono            T D        1 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     2 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed        En 19          Connections Initial Setup         Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                   Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format Listening Mode                Dolby D Direct  Mono       Dolby D            Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Cinema        DTS Neural X       TV Logic         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono             T D     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or su
13.              Connections    3 Remote Mode Setup    ro  Initial Setup    Would you like to setup your remote to   control your devices  This may take a while  depending on what and how many you have  connected  You can always come back to remote  setup from setup    7 2 Remote Mode Setup      Yes  Continue   No  Skip    You can enable operation of the other components using  the remote controller of the unit  When the Remote Mode  Setup start screen is displayed  select  Yes  Continue  with  the cursors and press ENTER on the remote controller   Follow the guidance to select the desired REMOTE MODE  button and in the keyboard screen  enter the first three  characters of the brand name of the device you are going  to program and search for the remote control code  The  guidance will also explain how to set the remote controller     4 Network Connection          ef B   H e    ion  Do you want to connect network connection    It gives you network services that our AV   receiver support  If you wish to skip this step    select    No  Skip      No  Skip          You can check the network connection and make the Wi Fi  setting  When the Network Connection start screen is  displayed  select  Yes  with the cursors and press ENTER  on the remote controller  If you select  Wired  in the next  screen  you can view the LAN cable connection status  To  make the Wi Fi setting  select  Wireless   press ENTER on  the remote controller and follow the sections below     ben            SS ccc   
14.              Game console                           Ep Sie       Blu ray Disc   Personal computer                                        DVD player                         Satellite Cable  set top box  etc     Streaming media Player  etc     HDMI cable connection    The unit has many HDMI jacks on its rear panel and each  of them corresponds to an input selector button of the  same name on the front panel  For example  a Blu ray Disc  player will be connected to the HDMI IN1 jack and the BD   DVD button on the front panel will be used to listen to the  playback sound  if the player is CEC compliant  input will  be switched automatically when play is started   If you add  another Blu ray Disc player  you can use any other jack  than HDMI IN1  It is possible to change assignment of the  input jacks and input selector buttons  For how to make  settings  see the Advanced Manual     To connect the TV and the unit  connect the HDMI OUT  MAIN jack of the unit and the HDMI IN jack of the TV using  a HDMI cable  With this connection  it becomes possible to  display the setting screen of the unit on the TV or transmit    En 8    video audio signals from the player to the TV  If your TV  supports ARC  Audio Return Channel   it is possible to  play the TV sound with the AV receiver s speakers with  this connection only  If your TV does not support ARC  you  need  in addition to the HDMI OUT MAIN jack connection   a digital optical cable connection between the digital audio  out optical j
15.           SM Electronic 30730   Smart 30713   Sonashi 30831   Soniq 30831   Sony 31516  31633   30533  31033   30864  31070   31548  32861   31536  32839   32180  30772   Sound Color 31233   Soundwave 30713   Spectra 30872   SR Standard 30831   Sunkai 30770   Sunstech 30831  32139   32966   Superior 31643   Supratech 32139   SV2000 30675   Sylvania 30675  30630   Symphonic 30675   Sytech 30831   Tandberg 30713   Targa 30741   Tascam 31818   Tatung 30770   TBoston 32139   Tchibo 30741   TCM 30741   Teac 30571  30675   30741  31818   32139  34004   Technica 30713   Technical 32966   Technics 30490   Technika 30770  30831   Technosonic 30730   TechnoStar 31643   Techwood 30713  32966   Telefunken 30551  32966   En 76     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Windsor 30713 Magnavox 30675  Windy Sam 30573 Marantz 32414  33444  Woxter 32139 Mitsubishi Electric 34004  Xbox 32083  31708  Onkyo 32147  32900   32202  30522 33101  33501   Xiron 30713 ec PUO  XMS 30770 oso   X View 31233 EE Ee  Yamada 30872  32139 Pangea e  Yamaha 30497  32298  32859  32523   30539  30817  32710  A e Philips Se 32434   ooo Pioneer 32442  32847   Yamakawa 30872 32854  30142  YBA 30872 RCA 39532  Yukai 30730 Samsung 30199  33195  Zenith 30741   30591 j Sharp 32250  33313  30503 Sherwood 32820  33837  Sony 31516  32180   B Blu ray Disc 30772  Anihem 32820 Sylvania 30675  Anthem Statement 32820 Tascam 34004  Cambridge Audio 32808 D  dus adu   Denon 32258  32748  SES PES PATIO  B VIZIO 32563  E
16.          Listening Mode       Input Format                Dolby D  Direct       Mono       Dolby D         Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Cinema        DTS Neural X       TV Logic         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono          T D       DTS Direct          Mono       DTS 1  2  Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Cinema         DTS Neural X       TV Logic         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono          T D              DTS Express Direct       Mono  DTS Express    2  Dolby Surround             Neo 6 Cinema    DTS Neural X  TV Loge    AllCh Stereo    Full Mono    T D                             1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch     2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed     4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed      1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch     2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed     4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed      1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 
17.        Reach Broadband    01376  01877   01982    Shaw    01376  01977   00476  02187   01982          Reliance    02556    Shenzhen  Broadcasting    01991  04162          RIO Media    02030    Shenzhen Digital TV    01991  04162          Rogers    01877  01376       Rostelecom    03611    Shijiazhuang  Broadcasting    04026          Sagem    02407  02436   03288    Shimanto CATV    02752       Sichuan Broadcasting    03953          Sagemcom    03514  02407   02436  03007   03288    SingTel    02275  01998   02802             Samsung    03322  02979   03319  01877   02407  02015   03340  03407   03451  03442   03477  02610   02955  01060   02683  03514   03783  02589   02889  02962   03265  03849   03928  01982   01987          Siti Digital 03664   SK Broadband 03442  02681   SK Btv 02681  03442  Sky Austria 02620  02447     02832       Sky Deutschland    02620  02447   02832                SaskTel    01998          SBN    03965       Scientific Atlanta    01877  00858   01982  02401   02345  01987   02047  02436   03028  02378                                                                                                                                                                                                 SCTV    02493          SCV       02950             En 80       SkyCable 02950  03521   03527  04177   SkyLife 02683  03478   Skyworth 03298  02960   03278  01991   03521  04177   03946  04162   Smartlabs 03611   Smile Content 02437   SMT 03527   SMtronics 03319   
18.       Connections Initial Setup   Playing Back   Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller    ONKYO       The Basic Manual includes information needed when starting up    and also instructions for frequently used operations   he Advanced  Manual has more detailed information and advanced settings         AV RECEIVER    Basic Manual    CONTENTS  ain M                         3 KE en c            I 12 9 Other useful PUriCIONS ee 20  P E E 4 3 Remote Moda Selup aids vie vise iveprieri ed ebrios For ver Ce ria ta 13  KE 4 4 Network Connection                ccccccccssseseeeeeeceeeseeeeeeseaneaees 13 ee    Lieler ln ER  Step he ll TE 5 Step 3  Playing Back                                             15   TADS OF image TesoluMOfIBu sietpues ok EEX ELE HERE In bo ERES 23  1 Connecting speakels          etr retrerete tries eret eo recep  5 1 Basic Operating TENENTE cae er er 15 Resolutions supported Dy HOMI  ssisssissirseirisisssisssssriss 23  e Speaker au essnee aa 5 e Part names and functions of the remote controller      15 supplied ADOBSSONROS ode Hdivudkrikpi eek ebat Back cover  e Height speaker types aces hiver reped toin ise ornare 5 2 Network FUNCIONS EEN 16  e Instructions on how to connect speakers                       T d ii EE 16  2 Connecting the TV and players                cccssssssseeeeeseeeeeees 8 RE 17  e HDMI cable connection EE 8 5 AM FM Radio EE ER 17  e Connecting Components without HDMI   9 A ES NETT 18  SEKR 10 e Making Multi zone
19.      Advanced Manual    Make the following preparations   Wi Fi connection requires an access point such  as wireless LAN router   gt    Write down the SSID  and password  key  of the access point if they are  shown in the label of the main body  If the access  point has an automatic setting button  may be  called differently according to the manufacturer    you can set up without inputting the password   For how to use the automatic setting button of the  access point  refer to its instruction manual    zk The unit supports Wi Fi connection with 2 4 GHz   access point     1  Select the method of Wi Fi connection with the  cursors and press ENTER   Scan Networks  Use this unit to search for and connect  to a wireless LAN router or other access point   Use iOS Device  iOS7 or later   Select this method to  let this unit share the Wi Fi settings with your iOS device  and establish a Wi Fi connection with ease   The device  must be compatible with iOS version 7 or later      B If you selected  Scan Networks     2  Select the SSID of the access point to be connected  with the cursor buttons and press ENTER   When the SSID of the access point appears on the TV  screen  select the desired access point    e  f you changed the initial setting of the access point to  skip password entry  step 3 is unnecessary    e  f you changed the initial setting of the access point  to hide the SSID  see  When the access point is not  displayed     3  Select and set the authentication method   The 
20.      Click  My Favorites  tab  then enter the name and URL    of the Internet radio station       Click  Save  to register the entered Internet radio station    in  My Favorites      To rename the registered radio station  Select the radio  station in the  My Favorites  list and press MENU to display  the menu screen  Select  Rename this station  with the  cursors and press ENTER to display the keyboard screen   Rename the station as desired    e Radio stations can be renamed also from  WEB Setup      E Playing a Registered Radio Station    de    Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen     el oe n E ul                         Co DID     Ohi hi Fl                        Select  My Favorites  with the cursors and press ENTER    to display the registered Internet radio stations       With the cursors  select a radio station and press    ENTER to start playing     ll Deleting a Registered Radio Station    le    Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen                                               2  Select  My Favorites  with the cursors and press ENTER    to display the registered Internet radio stations       With the cursors  select the radio station to delete and    press MENU to display the menu screen   I UJ UJ LJ    MENU                     With the cursors  select  Delete from My Favorites   and    then press ENTER  A confirmation screen will appear       With the cursors  select  OK   and then press ENTER to    delete th
21.     00253  00853       Portugal Telecom    02466       Premiere       01429  01114   01195  01197             Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                  SHOI 02938   Siemens 00173  01657   01429  02418   01626  01334   01672   Sigmatek 02418  02813   02738   SignalMAX 01956   Silva 00299   Silva Schneider 00740   SilverCrest 02026  02308   02458  02932   SKY 01662   Sky Austria 02754  02443   01429  01114   01915  01195   01197   Sky Brasil 01377  03110     00887  00856   00099  01499   02619                         Sky Deutschland    02754  02443   01429  01114   01915  01195   01197                                                       Samsung 03063  00253   01442  01377   02467  01682   01989  03266   00853  01662   02525  03321   03784  03834   03838  01255   01693   Sansui 01545   Sanyo 01626   Sat Control 01300   Sat Industrie 01611   SAT  01409   SatCatcher 01956   Satforce 03374   Satplus 01100   SatyCon 01631   Schaub Lorenz 02034  02418   Schneider 02842   Schwaiger 01672  01429   02308  02458   01631  02797   02813  00740   01334  02957   Schwaiger CS 01631   Scott 02738   SCS 00299  00740   Sedea 01626   Sedea Electronique  01626       SEG    01626  01284   02034    Sky Ireland 01175  01662   00847   Sky Italia 01693  02467   00853   Sky Mexico 00856  02619     00887  01377   03469                            Sky New Zealand    022
22.     Measurement position  with microphone      Listening area      Correct measurement will not be possible if the microphone is held  by hand  Measurement is not possible if headphones are being used     En 11       AN        Connections       The subwoofer sound may not be detected since it is extremely  low frequencies  Set the subwoofer volume to around the half of its  maximum volume and make its frequency to the maximum level    x Measurement may be interrupted if there is ambient noise or radio  frequency interference  Close the window and turn off the home  appliance and fluorescent light     2  After placing the microphone at the measurement  position  select  Do it Now  with the cursors and  press ENTER     3  When  Please plug microphone that came in a  box with AV receiver  is displayed  connect the  microphone to the SETUP MIC jack of the unit     SETUP MIC jack          Calibration  microphone       4  Select the settings for the connected speakers  the  type of the height speakers  and other appropriate  settings                                            Select how many speakers you have  ENER  Next    When the screen above is displayed  set the items with  the cursor buttons on the remote controller  Refer to  the on screen diagram for  Speaker Channels   which  changes each time a different number of channels   is selected  When all the items have been set  press  ENTER on the remote controller  After that  follow the    guidance displayed on the TV screen t
23.     Playing Back    Advanced Manual     1 Mark Andrews   mark  andrews gjisc org   Leitch atomic clock controller    2 Bernd Altmeier  lt altmeier atlsoft de gt  hopf Elektronik serial line and PCI bus devices    3 Viraj Bais  lt vbais mailman1 intel com gt  and  4 Clayton Kirkwood  lt kirkwood striderfm intel com gt  port to WindowsNT 3 5   5 Michael Barone  lt michael barone Imco com gt  GPSVME fixes    6 Jean Francois Boudreault  lt Jean Francois Boudreault viagenie qc ca gt IPv6 support    7 Karl Berry  lt karl owl HQ ileaf com gt  syslog to file option    8 Greg Brackley  lt greg brackley bigfoot com gt  Major rework of WINNT port  Clean up recvbuf and iosignal code into separate  modules     9 Marc Brett  lt Marc Brett westgeo com gt  Magnavox GPS clock driver    10 Piete Brooks  lt Piete Brooks cl cam ac uk gt  MSF clock driver  Trimble PARSE support    11 Reg Clemens  lt reg dwf com gt  Oncore driver  Current maintainer     12 Steve Clift  lt clift ml csiro au gt  OMEGA clock driver    13 Casey Crellin  lt casey csc co za gt  vxWorks  Tornado  port and help with target configuration        14 Sven Dietrich  lt sven_dietrich trimble com gt  Palisade reference clock driver  NT adj  residuals  integrated Greg s Winnt port      15 John A  Dundas III   dundas gsalt jpl nasa gov   Apple A UX port    16 Torsten Duwe  lt duwe immd4 informatik uni erlangen de gt  Linux port    17 Dennis Ferguson  lt dennis mrbill canet ca gt  foundation code for NTP Version 2 as specified in R
24.     Stop any playing Internet radio  USB storage device  or   server content    If the multi zone function is active  press OFF on the   main unit to turn it off    If  HDMI CEC  RIHD   is set to  On   set it to  Off     default value         After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller    press SETUP  Then  after selecting  6  Hardware      HDMI  and pressing ENTER  select  HDMI CEC   RIHD   to select  Off     x Some USB storage devices may take long to load  may not be loaded  correctly  or may not be correctly fed depending on the device or their  content     k Onkyo will not be liable whatsoever for any loss or damage of data  or  storage failure arising from the use of the USB storage device with this  AV receiver  Thank you for your understanding    x The description may differ from the on screen display but that will not  change the way to operate or the function     E Update  1  Connect the USB storage device to your PC     2  Download the firmware file from the Onkyo website to  your PC and unzip   Firmware files are named in the following way   ONKAVR     TEE    Unzip the file on your PC  The number of unzipped files    and folders varies depending on the model       Copy all unzipped files and folders to the root folder of  the USB storage device   e Make sure to copy the unzipped files       Connect the USB storage device to the USB port of the  unit   e  f you connect a USB hard disk drive to the USB  port of the unit  we recommend that you use its AC  adapte
25.     TV  The TV button on the remote controller is   preprogrammed with remote control codes for linked   operation of some CEC Consumer Electronics Control     compatible TV sets    e  f you cannot operate your CEC compatible TV   program one of the following remote control codes   11807 13100 13500  to the TV button     BD DVD player  By registering a remote control code   32910 33101 33501 31612  in the BD DVD button  your  remote controller will be able to take advantage of linked  operation with CEC compatible BD DVD players           NN      Connections Initial Setup Playing Back  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          Advanced speaker connections    e Before bi amping  be sure to remove the short   circuit connector that connects the tweeter  treble   jack and the subwoofer  bass  jack    e Use speakers supporting bi amping only  For  details  refer to the speakers    instruction manual     Advanced speaker connections       Connecting Bi amp Speakers    It is possible to connect speakers supporting bi amping to  improve quality of the bass and treble  Up to 5 1 ch will be  played in bi amping     B Connections    1  Connect as below using the FRONT terminals and  BACK or HEIGHT terminals     SPEAKERS       i A    l    Tweeter V  O0 Oo     high pitched tone     Oo00     a Xn Woofer a G          low pitched tone        Front R Front L    2  Turn the unit on and make the bi amping setting   CD After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller   press 
26.    3  With the cursors  select the target server  and then press  ENTER   e You can check the server name of your PC from the  PC properties     4  With the cursors  select the target shared folder  and  then press ENTER     5  If a username and password is required  enter the  necessary login information   e The login information is the account information set  at the time of creating the shared folder   e Once entered  the login information will be  remembered from the next time onward     6  With the cursors  select the music file to play  and then  press ENTER or p to start playback                 En 14                Connections Initial Setup    Playing Back       Operating Music Files with the    Remote Controller       About the Remote Controller    The remote controller of this unit allows you to play music  files stored on USB storage devices  Internet radio  PCs  and NAS devices on your home network  as well as on  Bluetooth enabled devices  It also allows you to view  information of the music file being played and perform  various other operations    e Available buttons may vary depending on the service  and device to play    e Some buttons cannot be used with Bluetooth enabled  devices  Furthermore  the Bluetooth enabled devices  must support the AVRCP profile  Some devices may not  be operated  even when they support AVRCP profile     Remote Controller Buttons    1  Press INPUT SELECTOR  NET  or BLUETOOTH     appropriate for the input source on the remote contro
27.    Beko 30831   Bel Canto Design 31571   Belson 32139   Berthen 31643   Best Buy 32139   Black Diamond 30713   Blu sens 31233   Blue Parade 30571   Blue Sky 30713   Brainwave 30770   Brandt 30551  30503   Bush 30713  30730   30831  32966   Byd sign 30872   California Audio Labs   30490   Cambridge Audio 32808   CCE 30730   En 74     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller   DK Digital 30831  32095  GoWell 31643   31643 GPX 30741  Donghai 31233 Gran Prix 30831  Dragon 30831 Grandin 30713  31233  DSE 32095  30675 Grundig 30539  30551   Dual 30831  30730  30713  31643    30713  32966  32966   31023 Grunkel 30770  30831  Durabrand 30713  30675  GVG 30770   31023  30831 H amp B 30713  31233  Dynex 32596 Hanseatic 30741  E max 30770  31233  Harman Kardon 30582  33228    31643 32927  ECC 30730 HE 30730  Electrocompaniet 32545 Hello Kitty 30831  Elfunk 30713 Hen  30713  Elin 30770 Hitachi 30573  32966   Elite 32854 30713  31664  Elta 30770  31643  Hoher 30713  30831    31239 31643  Eltax 31233 Home Electronics 30770  30730  Emerson 30675  30591  Home Tech Industries   31643   32213 Humax 30646  Enterprise 30591 HYD 31233  Epworth 30533 Hyundai 32966  EuroLine 30675  31233  Ingersoll 31023   31643 Inno Hit 30713  Ferguson 30713  32966 Insignia 32095  32596   Finlux 32966  30770  32428  30675    30591  30741 30741  Firstline 30713 Integra 30627  32147   Funai 30675 31769  31634   GE 30522 30571  30503   General Electric 30522 31612  GFM 30675 Irradio 31233  30646  G Hanz 32
28.    En 31           Connections Initial Setup    Supplied Accessories    Indoor FM antenna      1     AM loop antenna      1        Remote controller  RC 898M       1   Batteries  AA R6       2        Power cord  Taiwanese models       1     Speaker setup microphone      1        x The number in parenthesis indicates the quantity  On packaging  the  letter at the end of the product name indicates the color     Onkyo Corporation   Kitahama Chuo Bldg  2 2 22 Kitahama  Chuo ku   OSAKA 541 0041  JAPAN  http   www onkyo com     The Americas    Onkyo U S A  Corporation   18 Park Way  Upper Saddle River  N J  07458  U S A    For Dealer  Service  Order and all other Business Inquiries   Tel  201 785 2600 Fax  201 785 2650  http   www us onkyo com     For Product Support Team Only   1 800 229 1687  http   www us onkyo com     SN 29401979     C  Copyright 2015 Onkyo Corporation Japan  All rights reserved  Onkyo has the Privacy Policy  You can review it at  http   www onkyo com privacy         Playing Back    Advanced Manual    How to use the remote controller       Approx   16 ft   5 m       If you do not use the remote controller for a long time  remove the  batteries to prevent leakage      Note that keeping consumed batteries inside may cause corrosion  resulting in damage of the remote controller     Europe   Onkyo Europe Electronics GmbH  Liegnitzerstrasse 6  82194 Groebenzell  GERMANY  Tel   49 8142 4401 0 Fax   49 8142 4208 213  http   www eu onkyo com     Onkyo Europe Electronic
29.    Subwoofer  is set to  No               e  he Speaker  Equalizer Settings  may be unable to be changed depending on the settings in   Configuration     Speaker Channels     Subwoofer     e Adjust the volume of each speaker in  Level Calibration     e Adjust the volume in 1 dB steps    e This is not effective if the listening mode is Pure Audio  European  Australian and Asian models  or  Direct     e  he result may not be as expected depending on the input source and listening mode setting     En 35       50          Connections       3  Audio Adjust    Configure various settings related to sound  such as settings for listening to multiplex audio    Initial Setup       Playing Back    or multilingual TV broadcasts and sound field settings for listening modes     Multiplex Mono       Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Multiplex  Input Channel    Main    Set the audio channel or language to be output   when playing multiplex audio or multilingual TV   broadcasts etc     Main   Main channel only    Sub   Sub channel only    Main Sub   Main and sub channels will be   output at the same time    e  f multiplex audio is being played   1 1  will  be displayed when DISPLAY is pressed        Mono  Input Channel       Left Right       Set the input channel to use for playing any 2  ch digital source such as Dolby Digital  or 2 ch  analog PCM source in the Mono listening mode    Left   Left channel only    Right   Right channel only    Left   Right    Left and right 
30.    standard   2 4 GHz band   1   11 ch  North American   10   11 ch  Spain   10   13 ch  France   1   13 ch  Others    Wi Fi   standard     Bluetooth Section    Communication system  Bluetooth Specification version 2 1  EDR  Enhanced Data Rate   Maximum communication range  Line of sight approx  15 m      Frequency band  2 4 GHz band  Modulation method  FHSS  Freq Hopping Spread Spectrum   Compatible Bluetooth profiles  A2DP 1 2  Advanced Audio Distribution Profile   AVRCP 1 3  Audio Video Remote Control Profile   Supported Codecs  SBC  Transmission range  A2DP   20 Hz   20 000 Hz  Sampling frequency 44 1 kHz      The actual range will vary depending on factors such as obstacles between  devices  magnetic fields around a microwave oven  static electricity   cordless phone  reception sensitivity  antenna s performance  operating  system  software application  etc     General    Power Supply  AC 120 V  60 Hz  North American and Taiwanese   AC 220   240 V  50 60 Hz  Others   Power Consumption  6 4 A  North American and Taiwanese   630 W  Others   0 1 W  Stand by  North American and Taiwanese   0 15 W  Stand by  Others   2 6 W  Network Standby   70 W  No sound   Dimensions  W x H x D   435 mm x 173 5 mm x 329 mm  17 1 8  x 6 13 16  x 12 15 16   Weight  9 4 kg  20 7 Ibs    North American and Taiwanese   9 8 kg  21 6 lbs    Others      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       e HDMI  Input  IN1  BD DVD  HDCP2 2   IN2  CBL SAT  HDCP2 2   IN3  STRM BOX   HDCP2 2  
31.   01197  02026   Digi Raum Electronics   02622   Digi Romania 01416       DSTV    00879  02059   02060                      DTI Electronics  DTK Deutsche    02938  01195  01197                                           Digiality 01334  02813  Digihome 02034  01284    01935  DigiLogic 01284  02034  DigiQuest 02278  02738    01300  01631  Digital 02308  DigitAlb 01195  01197  En 82          Telekabel   DTV 03572   Dual 02034  Durabrand 01284  02034  Dyon 02738  02813  Easy One 03240     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Echostar 00775  02262  Freesat  02443  03266  02527  00853  freeview 02982  01409 Fte Maximal 02289  Eco Star 01413 Fuba 02750  00173   Edision 01631 00299  03726  Ekotech 03422 Fuji Onkyo 02728  01631  Elap 01413 Funai United 03012  Elbe 02418 Galaxis 00853  00879  Electron 01956 Galaxy 01956  Elisa 01322  02455 Galaxy Innovations 02799  04197  Elless 00740 General Instrument 00869  Elta 02738 General Satellite 03064  02622  Embratel 02796  03787 Gi 02799  04197  Energy Sistem 02418  01631  GigaBlue 03663  02289  02813 GigaTV 02738  Engel 03749  01611  Globo 02026  01334   01672 00740  01429   Etisalat 02443 02957  01626  Europhon 00299  01334 GMMZ 03538  Europsat 01611  01413 Go 01780  Eurosky 00740  00299 GoGen 02738  Eutra 00740 GOl 00775  Evesham Technology   02034 Gold Box 00853  Eycos 03374 Gold Vision 01631  F amp U 03012 Golden Media 04197  Fagor 01611 GoldMaster 01334  02928  FaVal 03422 Goodmans 01284  02376   Ferguson 02638  01291 
32.   02060   Murphy 02034   Mx Onda 02938   myfreeviewHD 02982   Mysat 02738   MySky Italia 02467   MySky New Zealand   01356  02211   Nagra 02262   NanoXX 01631   NC  00853  01409   NEOTION 01334   NET 02262   Netgem 01322  02455   Netsat 00099  00887   Neuf TV 01322   Neuling 02458  02026   Nevir 02938  02728   Next 02231   Next Level 00869   Nextvision 01956   NextWave 01956   En 84                             gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Pace 00847  00887  PremiumX 03374  01356  02754  Primacom 01176  01195   01682  01175  01197  01693  02475  Pro Basic 00853  P E ProLine 01284  02657  03469  ES ME  03790  01377  Si d  01662  02097  QooK TV 03321  02211  02059  Qook Skylife 03321  02060  02466  Quelle 00299  02796  02160 Qwest 01377  Pacific 01284 RadioShack 00869  Palcom 01611  00299  Radix 01255  01409 Raduga TV 01986  02957  Palsonic 02813 RCA 01291  01442   Panasat 00879 02108  Panasonic 03494  00847  RCS 01416  03099 Rebox 02928  Panda 00173 RiksTV 01692  peeKTon 02418 Rimax 02938  Philips 00099  00853  RIO Media 01780  02561  01499  Roadstar 00853  Mer i Rollmaster 01413  01114  01672   02619  02211    oe  03110  03469  SAB 01956  01631   00173  00856  04197  01300  00887  02631 Saba 00740  02205  Phoenix 01956  02418 Sagem 01692  01690   Phonotrend 01780 01114  02553   Pino 01334 01307  Pioneer 00853 Sagemcom 01692  04024   03789  Pixel Magic 02982  Saivod 02418  PLDT 02835  02836   02289 Samart DTH 03576  03574  PMB 01611  Polsat 02262  02527 
33.   69   71 Clarendon Road  Watford  Hertfordshire  WD17 1DS  United Kingdom  Tel   44  0 8712 00 19 96 Fax   44  0 8712 00 19 95   China   Onkyo China Limited  Hong Kong    Unit 1033  10 F  Star House  No 3  Salisbury Road  Tsim Sha Tsui Kowloon  Hong Kong    Tel  852 2429 3118 Fax  852 2428 9039   http   www hk onkyo com     Onkyo China PRC  Mainland    302  Building 1  20 North Chaling Rd   Xuhui District  Shanghai  China 200032   Tel  86 21 52131366 Fax  86 21 52130396   http   www cn onkyo com    Asia  Oceania  Middle East  Africa   Please contact an Onkyo distributor referring to Onkyo SUPPORT site   http   www intl onkyo com support    The above mentioned information is subject to change without prior notice   Visit the Onkyo web site for the latest update     F1505 0     C  Copyright 2015 Onkyo Corporation Japan  All rights reserved  Onkyo has the Privacy Policy  You can review it at  http  Awww onkyo com privacy     99402026                    50    
34.   88 2 kHz  96 kHz  176 4 kHz  192 kHz   Quantization bit  8 bit  16 bit  24 bit   x For playback from a USB storage device  sampling rates of 176 4 kHz  and 192 kHz are not supported    x For playback from a USB storage device  5 1 ch is not supported     Ogg Vorbis   ogg or  OGG    Supported sampling rates  8 kHz  11 025 kHz  16 kHz   22 05 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   Supported bitrates  Between 32 kbps and 500 kbps   Incompatible files cannot be played    Incompatible files cannot be played     LPCM  Linear PCM    Supported sampling rates  44 1 kHz  48 kHz  Quantization bit  16 bit    k Only for playback via DLNA     Apple Lossless   m4a  mp4  M4A  MP4    Supported sampling rates  8 KHz  11 025 kHz  12 kHz   16 kHz  22 05 kHz  24 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   64 kHz  88 2 kHz  96 kHz   Quantization bit  16 bit  24 bit    DSD   dsf or  DSF   Supported sampling rates  2 8224 MHz  5 6448 MHz  x For playback from a USB storage device  5 6448 MHz is not supported     Dolby TrueHD   vr  mlp   VR  MLP    Supported sampling rates  48 kHz  64 kHz  88 2 kHz   96 kHz  176 4 kHz  192 kHz   x Only sampling rates of 48 kHz is supported for playback from USB   x Playback via DLNA is not supported    x For playback from a USB storage device  7 1 ch is not supported     Radio Wave Caution    The AV receiver uses a 2 4 GHz radio wave  frequency  which is a band used by other wireless  systems as 1 and 2 described below     1  Devices which use a 2 4 GHz radio wave frequency    e Cordl
35.   ACTS  KSl Odetics  audio clock drivers  CHU  WWV H  IRIG   36 Wolfgang Moeller  lt moeller gwdgv1 dnet gwdg de gt  VMS port    37 Jeffrey Mogul  lt mogul pa dec com gt  ntptrace utility    38 Tom Moore  lt tmoore fievel daytonoh ncr com gt  i386 svr4 port    39 Kamal A Mostafa  lt kamal whence com gt  SCO OpenServer port    40 Derek Mulcahy  lt derek toybox demon co uk gt  and  41 Damon Hart Davis  lt d hd org gt  ARCRON MSF clock driver   42 Rainer Pruy  lt Rainer Pruy informatik uni erlangen de gt  monitoring trap scripts  statistics file handling   43 Dirce Richards  lt dirce zk3 dec com gt  Digital UNIX V4 0 port    44 Wilfredo Sanchez  lt wsanchez apple com gt  added support for NetInfo    45 Nick Sayer  lt mrapple quack kfu com gt  SunOS streams modules    46 Jack Sasportas  lt jack innovativeinternet com gt  Saved a Lot of space on the stuff in the html pic  subdirectory   47 Ray Schnitzler  lt schnitz unipress com gt  Unixware1 port    48 Michael Shields  lt shields tembel org gt  USNO clock driver    49 Jeff Steinman  lt jss pebbles jpl nasa gov gt  Datum PTS clock driver    50 Harlan Stenn  lt harlan pfcs com gt  GNU automake autoconfigure makeover  various other bits  see the ChangeLog    51 Kenneth Stone  lt ken sdd hp com gt  HP UX port    52 Ajit Thyagarajan  lt ajit ee udel edu gt IP multicast anycast support    53 Tomoaki TSURUOKA  lt tsuruoka nc fukuoka u ac jp gt TRAK clock driver    54 Paul A Vixie  lt vixie vix com gt  TrueTime GPS driver  generic TrueTi
36.   Digenius 00740 General Satellite 03064  Digi 01195  01197 Gi 02799  04197  Digihome 02034 GigaBlue 03663  DigiQuest 01300 Globo 02957  Digital 02308 Golden Media 04197  DigitAlb 01195  01197 GoldMaster 02928  DigitalBox 02540  03240 Goodmans 02034  Digiturk 03517  02097 Grundig 02738  03424  Dilog 01957 GVT 03789  DirecTV 01377  01442  Handan 01957   00099 HD Box 02928  Dish Mexico 00775 HD  02797  03095  Dish Network 00775 Hirschmann 00740  DishHD 04090 Hitachi 02034  Dishpro 00775 Hughes Network 01442  DNA 01957 Systems  DragonSat 02928 Humax 02443  01176   Dream Multimedia 01237  01923 01377  03517   D Smart 02231 01427  01808   DSTV 02059  02060 02231  02408     02754          50       Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          IceCrypt 04197  02928   ID Sat 01334   Indovision 01989   INETBOX 01237   Intv 04348   Inverto 03095   Jaeger 02797   JVC 00775   Kamosonic 02738   Kaon 01300   Kathrein 02569  01561   03658  00658   Labgear 03424   LaSAT 00740   LinkBox 02957   LogiSat 02797  02813   Luxor 01935   M vision 03562   M7 02631   Marusys 02799  03543   Maspro 03099   Maximum 01334  02813   Medion 02797  00740   MegaSat 01
37.   OK  to display the compatible devices     4  Select this unit  and then click  Allow    e Whenit is clicked  the corresponding icon is  checked     5  Click  OK  to close the dialog     e Depending on the version of Windows Media  Player   the names of the items you need to select may differ  from the explanation here     E Windows Media  Player 12  1  Turn on your PC and start Windows Media  Player 12     2  In the  Stream  menu  select  Turn on media streaming   to display a dialog box   e  f media streaming is already turned on  select  More  streaming options     in the  Stream  menu to list  players in the network  and then go to step 4     3  Click  Turn on media streaming  to list players in the  network    4  Select this unit in  Media streaming options  and check  that it is set to  Allow      5  Click  OK  to close the dialog   e Depending on the version of Windows Media  Player     the names of the items you need to select may differ  from the explanation here     DLNA Playback    e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance   displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the   cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen    press RETURN    e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the ma
38.   Object  form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical transformation or translation of a Source form  including but not  limited to compiled object code  generated documentation  and conversions to other media types      Work  shall mean the work of authorship  whether in Source or Object form  made available under the License  as indicated  by a copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work  an example is provided in the Appendix below       Derivative Works  shall mean any work  whether in Source or Object form  that is based on  or derived from  the Work and   for which the editorial revisions  annotations  elaborations  or other modifications represent  as a whole  an original work of  authorship  For the purposes of this License  Derivative Works shall not include works that remain separable from  or merely link   or bind by name  to the interfaces of  the Work and Derivative Works thereof     En 28    ben  mmm    Playing Back    Advanced Manual     Contribution  shall mean any work of authorship  including the original version of the Work and any modifications or additions to  that Work or Derivative Works thereof  that is intentionally submitted to Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright owner  or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized to submit on behalf of the copyright owner  For the purposes of this definition    submitted  means any form of electronic  verbal  or written communication sent to the Licensor or its representativ
39.   Orchestra         Unplugged         Studio Mix 4       AllCh Stereo            Full Mono           1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch     2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed     4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     DTS ES Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       DTS         ES Matrix        ES Discrete        Dolby Surround    DTS Neural X       Orchestra      DTS X Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo  DTS X  Orchestra              Unplugged        Studio Mix          AllCh Stereo    Full Mono              Unplugged          Studio Mix       1 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed    2 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed           AllCh Stereo            Full Mono             En 24        1 Can only be selected when the back speakers are not installed       Back speakers need to be installed     3 Height speakers need to be installed     4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed                 Connections Initial Setup       E GAME button  You can select a mode suita
40.   PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF  USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY  WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     21  Mersenne Twister   http   www math sci hiroshima u ac jp  m mat MT MT2002 CODES mt19937ar c   Copyright  C  1997   2002  Makoto Matsumoto and Takuji Nishimura    All rights reserved    Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer   Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution    The names of its contributors may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior  written permission    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS   OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCID
41.   To use SiriusXM Internet Radio  you must  have your AV receiver connected to the Internet  Using the  remote control  follow these steps     e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance   displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the   cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen    press RETURN    e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the main unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks   gt                                                 PLAYLIST    En 7         Remote Controller       Connections Initial Setup Playing Back prchifclniesciel bleu  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller             il Playing Back and you can listen to SiriusXM Internet Radio  You can  control the tracks with the buttons on the remote control   Enabled buttons  B    Bl  L       1          1  Press NET on the remote controller to display NET TOP                                                             screen    C t t 345 m to My Favorites  Adds a channel to My Favorites   Lt oL l l   C  C5     O Add to Presets  Adds the currently playing station to     5 presets list    ep AC ACD  Delete f P ts  Deletes th tly playi
42.   and Asian models       D W           HYBRID STANDBY          RT PTY TP     European  Austral  and Asian models        ian                Front Panel     D OON STANDBY button  Turns the unit on or into  standby mode     2 DOLBY ATMOS indicator  Lights when playing Dolby  Atmos     8 DTS X indicator  Lights when playing DTS X     4  ZONE2 button  Controls the multi zone function       Remote control sensor  Receives signals from the  remote controller       OFF button  Switches the multi zone function off    D Display   LISTENING MODE buttons  Allow you to select the  listening mode     9 DIMMER button  North American and Taiwanese  models   Switches the brightness of the display   RT PTY TP button  European  Australian and Asian  models   Can be used when receiving the station  transmitting text information    MEMORY button  Registers a station     41  TUNING MODE button  Switches the tuning mode     2  DISPLAY button  Switches the information on the  display     3  SETUP button  Used when making settings    Cursor buttons  VTUNINGA   button    PRESET  button and ENTER button  Move the cursor and  confirms the selection  When listening to AM FM  broadcasting  tune in to the station with VTUNINGA or  select the registered station with   PRESET     5  RETURN button  Returns the display to the previous  state    MASTER VOLUME  Allows you to adjust the volume    1  MUSIC OPTIMIZER button indicator  North American  and Taiwanese models   Turns on off the MUSIC  OPTIMIZER function
43.   elete from Presets  Deletes the curren ayin   OM hh  di                      station from presets list       Siriusxm           SiriusXM Internet Radio subscriptions are sold separately  SrvskM hee Radio    and are governed by the Sirius Terms and Conditions  see  www sirius com   Be sure to read this agreement before  you purchase your subscription   Sirius  XM and all related marks and logos are trademarks       Slacker Personal Radio                                                       of Sirius XM Radio Inc  and its subsidiaries  All rights E Playing Back  reserved  1  Press NET on the remote controller to display NET TOP  reen   2  With the cursors on the remote controller  select ibn   SiriusXM Internet Radio   and then press ENTER  Slacker Personal Radio  North American only                 3  Select  Sign In   and then press ENTER  If you have an  J UN X  existing SIRIUS account  you can sign in by selecting e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance Se GD C    Sign In   Enter your user name and password in the displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the C   31   3      3473  next keyboard screen  or in Web Setup  If you do not cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER  3 m  know your username or password  call Sirius XM at to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen  ONNI   888  539 7474 for assistance  press RETURN   e  f you want to use multiple user accounts  see  Using e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and
44.   he name is not displayed when  Status  is   Ready  or  Pairing    En 44    e Wait for a while if  Bluetooth  cannot be selected  It will appear when the Bluetooth function is started  up           Connections Initial Setup Playing Back prchifclniesciel bleu  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                7  Remote Controller e Wait for a while if  Firmware Update  cannot be selected  It will appear when the network function is  a started up   Setting Item Default Value Setting Details  Remote ID 1 Select an ID for the unit s remote controller Initial Setup  from  1    2   and  3  to prevent interference You can make the initial setup from the setup menu   between the unit and other Onkyo components e Wait for a while if  Initial Setup  cannot be selected  It will appear when the network  that are installed in the same room  After function is started up     changing the ID on the main unit  change the   ID on the remote controller accordingly with the   following procedure    1  While holding down RECEIVER  press and  hold SETUP for about 3 seconds until the Setting Item Default Value Setting Details  remote indicator lights    2  With the number buttons  press one of 1  2   and 3  The remote indicator flashes twice     Lock          Setup Parameter Unlocked Lock the Setup menu to protect the settings    Locked   The menu is locked    Unlocked   The menu is unlocked              Remote Mode     Input and register the remote controller code of  other devic
45.   installed   Input Format Listening Mode z    I EDTMETS Sireci g Input Format Listening Mode    Irec    DTS X Direct  Mono  DTS HD MSTR     2 Ge  Dolby S d x  O urroun    g   a   TV Logic    eo  Inema  TN e AllCh Stereo    eurat   pe Full Mono    OgIC  E T D  AllCh Stereo  1 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed   Full Mono      Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed   T D              1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed        En 21                   Connections       B MUSIC button    Initial Setup    You can select a mode suitable for music       Playing Back     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller             Input Format    Listening Mode    Input Format    Listening Mode             Input Format  Analog    Listening Mode    Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music         DTS Neural X  Orchestra         Unplugged        Studio Mix 2    Multich PCM    Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models     Dolby Atmos  e The listening mode       Direct    of Dolby Digital Plus  or Do
46.   qD H  This button pauses the playback     2  SEARCH  This button toggles between the playback  screen and list screen during playback     3  mi  This button stops the playback     MODE  This button displays the video from the input  selected in  Video Select   Each press of the button  displays or turns off the video  You can change the  display position of the OSD by pressing ENTER  while the video is displayed on the screen    e These buttons are disabled when the OSD  language is set to Chinese   European  Australian   Taiwanese and Asian models     b RANDOM  This button performs random playback    REPEAT  This button replays the track or tracks    Pressing this button repeatedly cycles through the  repeat modes     7  DISPLAY  This button changes the displayed track  information during playback  Pressing this button  when the list screen is displayed toggles the screen  to playback    e Bluetooth enabled devices  Usable buttons are  D L    da II   gt  gt    gt   and E     Icons Displayed during Playback    Icons are displayed on the display during music file  playback  The meaning of each icon is as follows     td  Folder   Hi  Track   Be Play   I  Pause   Z    Fast forward        Fast reverse    i it  Repeat one track    iz f  Repeat within a folder     i   Shuffle    En 15             Connections Initial Setup       Using the Listening Modes       Selecting Listening Mode    The listening modes allow you to select the best sound  effect for your input source     1  Af
47.  00476  01376                Kabel Deutschland       03514  01981   01983  02165   03607  02620    Matanuska Telephone  Association    01481  02254   02482  02586             Mediacom    01376  00476   01982  01877                      Mediastream       01376  00476             mio TV 02275  02802   Mitsubishi Electric 03274   MOD 03647  01917   Motorola 01376  00476   02378  02437   01998  02030   00858  01982   02952  00276   01562  02275   03916  01585   04034  02401   Movistar 01585  03288   Moxi 02187   Moyo 03611   MTS 01998  03611   01615  01481   01898   MyLGTV 02682   NET 01883   NewWave 00476  01376    Communications 02187   NIB 03322   Ningde Cable TV 04195   Noos 02436   Northland 01376   Communications   Novus 01376  00476   Now TV 02009  02014   NTL 01060  00276   NTT 03237  03274   NTV Plus 02762   NU Telecom 01998  03028       Portugal Telecom   02401     Premiere 02620   Primacom 02889   Primestar 02030   PrimeTel 03611  02030   02437   PrimeTV 02030   PT 02401          En 79       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back          Seokyung    03340          Service Electric    01376  00476   01982                                  SetaBox 01917  Shaanxi Broadcasting   03965  Shanghai 03865  Shanghai OCN 03865  Shanxi Broadcasting 03965    Network          PTCI 01376   PX 03348   QooK TV 02683  03478   Qook Skylife 02683  03478   Qrix 03465  02979   QuickLine 02493   Qwerty 01898  01481   01615   Qwerty TV 01898   RCN 01376  00476     03560
48.  01626  01334   EGO us 02026  02797  eh E Mega TV 03321  Lenoxx 01611 MegaSat 01631  02034   ES pee  02813  02289   Lifesat 00299 00740  02738  LinkBox 02957 Melita 01416  Linsar 01284  02842 Meo 02466  Listo 01626  02813 Mercury 03422  Lodos 01284                   En 83       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Nilox 02278   Nokia 00853   Nordmende 01611   Noru 02938   Nova 02475  00879   NPG 02289  01413   01631   NTV Plus 01307  01692   02443   Octagon 02928   Olleh TV 03321   Olleh Skylife 03321   Onn 02034  01284   Openbox 01956  02928   Opensat 02957  01956   02719   Opentech 02525   Opentel 02525   Optex 01626  01413   01611  03012   Opticum 02957  02797   02932   Optus 01356  00879   Orbis 01334   Orbitech 01195  01100   01197  01099   01351   Orchid 02289   Orion Express 01986   Orton 02957                P amp T Luxembourg       01322  02455                                              Metronic 01986  02418   02738  01334   01631  01413   01672  01935   02278   Metz 00173   Micro 02797  02813   Micro electronic 02308  02813   Micromaxx 00299   Microstar 00299   Miraclebox 02928   Mitsai 02738   Morgan s 02026   Motorola 00869  03110   00856  03469   Movistar 02527  02262   02263   MTEX 03539   Multichoice 00879  02059 
49.  02034  03652   01803  01935  02568  03346   02034 03439  Finepass 01780 Gradiente 00887  03110   Finlux 01626  02034 00856  Finnet 01780  01957 Gran Prix 00740  FinnSat 00740  01195  Grandin 01626  01197  01351 Grocos 01409  FMD 01413  Fortec Star 01631  Foxtel 01356  00879   01176  Freesat 01692  02928        03266  01986   02376                   Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Grundig 00173  00847   02376  01291   02034  00853   02813  01284   01780  02738   03424  00879   01672  02568   03346   GVT 03789   Haier 02418   Hailo 02289   Hallo 01626   Handan 01780  01957   Hanseatic 01099  01100   Hauppauge 01672   HD Box 02928   HD  02797  02443   01429  02569   03095   HDT 01416  01255   03321   Hirschmann 00173  00299   02026  00740   Hitachi 02034  01284   Homecast 02525   Hornet 01300   HTS 00775   Huawei 03787   Huaxian Radio and 04041   Television Network   Hubei Chutian 04041   Hubei Radio  amp  04041    Television Network          Hughes Network  Systems       01442  01377                                                                            Humax 01176  02443   01427  01808   02736  01882   01915  03140   02231  02408   02144  02616   02754  01377   03517  01989   02289  03321   01255   Hyundai 01416   Hyundai Digital 014
50.  02407   Pace 01998  00858   03454  02294   02401   PCCW 02009  02057   Philips 02378   Pioneer Telephone 02254  02302   Portugal Telecom 02401   Primestar 02030   PrimeTel 02030  02437   03611   PrimeTV 02030          SetaBox 01917   SingTel 02275  01998   02802   SK Broadband 03442  02681   SK Btv 02681  03442   Sky Austria 02620   Sky Deutschland 02620   Smartlabs 03611   Smile Content 02437   Sogetel 01998   Sonaecom 02437   SureWest 01998  01481   02254  02482   02586   Swisscom 02271   TalkTalk 02994   TOC 04409   TDC 02271   Technicolor 02994   Telefonica 01585  03028   03288   Telekom Deutschland   02132   Telia 02030   TELUS 03028   TeNeT 01898                    gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  T Home 02132 CenturyLink 01998  Thomson 03007  02407 CHT 03647  TVB 01615 Chunghwa 03647  U  tvG 02682 Cisco 03028  02132   U verse 00858 00858  02047   Verizon 02378 02345  02271   Viasat 02030 EE  Viken Fibernett 02030  02437 ClubInternet D  Vivo 03288 CNS pod  Vodafone 02401 TE 01998  unicati  e E Deutsche Telekom 02132  Youview 02994  Du 02401  Yuxing 02014  Zinwell 03139 Echostar 03452  STE 04196 Elion 03916  Entertain 02132  Entone 03048  B IPTV PVR Combination Freebox 01976  ADB 01585  02254  Frontier 02378  02437 Communications  Altibox 02437 GDCATV 02980  Amino 01615  01898 Glashart Media 01615  01898  Arcadyan 02952 Google 03666  Arris 01998  02378 Guangdong Cable 02980  AT amp T 00858 Hikari TV 0323   AT amp T U verse 00858 Huawei 02994  ATMC 03
51.  1   uses at run time a copy of the library already present on the user s computer system  rather than copying  library functions into the executable  and  2  will operate properly with a modified version of the library  if the  user installs one  as long as the modified version is interface compatible with the version that the work was  made with   C  Accompany the work with a written offer  valid for at least three years  to give the same user the materials    nn                    Playing Back    Advanced Manual    specified in Subsection 6a  above  for a charge no more than the cost of performing this distribution    d  If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated place  offer equivalent  access to copy the above specified materials from the same place    e  Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you have already sent this user a  copy    For an executable  the required form of the  work that uses the Library  must include any data and utility programs needed for   reproducing the executable from it  However  as a special exception  the materials to be distributed need not include anything   that is normally distributed  in either source or binary form  with the major components  compiler  kernel  and so on  of the  operating system on which the executable runs  unless that component itself accompanies the executable    It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other
52.  13067  12104   Apollo 12239   Audiosonic 12104  11983   Audiovox 11769   Azuki 12239   Baier 12239   Bauer 12197   Beko 12239   Black Diamond 11037   Blaupunkt 12426   Blue Sky 11037   BlueDiamond 12426    Bush    13005  12676   11983  12104   10698  11037                                                                      Celcus 12676  cello 12673  Centrum 11037  Coby 13627  12315  Crown 11037  Currys Essentials 12486          En 92                         Curtis 12855  12466   13895  13636   14035   Dantax 12676   Denver 12197  13067   12239   DGM 12239   Digihome 12676   Digimate 12239   Digitrex 13067   diVision 12197  12239   Dual 12197  12676   11037   Durabrand 10171   D Vision 12197   Dynex 12049   Easy Living 12104   ECG 12197  12125   Electrohome 11670   Element 12964   Elfunk 11037   Emerson 11886  11864   11394  10171   e motion 12426   Enox  12673   Essentials 12486   Favi 13382   Ferguson 13005  12426   11037  12676   Finlux 12676   Funai 11394   Goodmans 11983  11037   11687  12676   12426   Gran Prix 12197   Grundig 12239  12125   12676   Haier 11753  12309   13429  11749   11983   Hantarex 12197        gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller   Hikona 11983 Nordmende 13835  Hisense 13519 OK  13434  12676  Hitachi 12676  11037  OKI 12676   11667 Orava 11037  Hyundai 12676 Orion 11037  12676  Ingo Devices 12239 Otic 11983  Insignia 12049 Palsonic 13067  iSymphony 13429 Panasonic 11291  12170   Jay tech 13067 11636  11480  JMB 12676 Panavox 13835  J
53.  2  Press TUNING MODE so that the  AUTO  indicator on  the display goes off              m  CLEAR     MEMORY TUNING MODE DISPLAY    Kg                3  Press VTUNINGA to select the desired radio station   e  he frequency changes by 1 step each time  you press the button  The frequency changes  continuously if the button is held down and stops  when the button is released  Tune by looking at the  display     Y TUNING 4     PRESET         To return to automatic tuning  Press TUNING MODE  on the main unit again  The unit automatically tunes into a  radio station  Normally  AUTO  should be displayed     E Tuning to the frequency directly    It allows you to directly enter the frequency of the radio  station you want to listen to     1  Press TUNER on the remote controller several times to  select either  AM  or  FM      elc 1j    C  C TUNER C 2                Za  Nau NA  Mou Ne  CZE   SE       D  J                                  OIC  SR  JO  JC    2  Press D TUN           3  Using the number buttons  enter the frequency of the  radio station within 8 seconds   e To enter 87 5  FM   for example  press 8  7  5  or  8  7  5  0  If you entered the wrong number  press  D TUN and enter the correct one                    Presetting an AM FM Radio Station    It allows you to register up to 40 of your favorite AM FM  radio stations  Registering radio stations in advance allows  you to tune into your radio station of choice directly     ll Registration Procedure  1  Tune into the AM FM 
54.  As a means of improving the quality of our  products and services  Onkyo may collect  information about your usage over the network   Select  Yes  if you agree to our collecting this  information  Select  No  if you do not want us to  collect this information    e You can set this after confirming the Privacy  Policy  When you select  Usage Data  and  press ENTER  the Privacy Policy is displayed    The same screen is displayed once also  when setting up the network connection   If  you agree to the collection of the information   this setting also becomes  Yes   Note that  if you agree to the Privacy Policy but select   No  for this setting  the information will not be  collected     Usage Data No       You can check the network connection   Press ENTER when  Start  is displayed     Network Check                       e Wait for a while if  Network  cannot be selected  It will appear when the network function is started up     En 43             Connections       Bluetooth      Initial Setup    Playing Back     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details          Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Bluetooth    On    Select whether or not to use the Bluetooth  function     On   Enables connection with a Bluetooth   enabled device by using the Bluetooth function   Select  On  also when making various Bluetooth  settings     Off   When not using the Bluetooth function    Status   Displays the statu
55.  Asian models   Multiple Accounts   Login can be made from the If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations Qe   Users  screen  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  Usina he E EE looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the LL  ER Je  Le and ENTER to enter your user name display on the main unit does not support the display A NP   tunein  and password  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be Seis Parona Rado     Select  OK   displayed are replaced with asterisks   gt k   pus   89 Press ENTER  The  Confirm your entries  screen     appears    4  Press ENTER   Please wait     appears and then   SiriusXM Internet Radio  screen appears which  displays the category available for selection  2  With the cursors on the remote controller  select  4  Use A Y to select the category and then press ENTER  Slacker Personal Radio   and then press ENTER   The channel list screen for the selected category 3  If you do not have an account  create one on the Slacker  appears  website  www slacker com  with your computer  If you  5  Use A Y to select the desired channel and then press already have a Slacker account  select  Sign in to your  ENTER  account  and then press ENTER  The keyboard screen  The playback screen for the selected channel appears appears  You can enter information from the remote    control or the keys on the main unit     En 8             60         Initial Setup    Connections       BA      If there are no mistakes in the info
56.  BY APPLICABLE LAW  EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT  HOLDERS AND OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY  AS IS  WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY  KIND  EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND  PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU  SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE  YOU ASSUME THE  COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING  REPAIR OR CORRECTION    16  INNO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT  HOLDER  OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED  ABOVE  BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES  INCLUDING ANY GENERAL  SPECIAL  INCIDENTAL OR  CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE LIBRARY  INCLUDING BUT  NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU  OR THIRD PARTIES ORA FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE   EVEN IF  SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES        END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS    How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries   If you develop a new library  and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public  we recommend making it  free software that everyone can redistribute and change  You can do so by permitting redistribution under these terms  or   alternatively  under the terms of the ordinary General Publi
57.  Connechon    18  n e Performing Multi zone Playback                                  19  Step 2  Initial Setup EECH ENEE 11  EU S    101 a PDT ON 19  1 AccuEOQ Room CaliDralignh   aao etin etate ren Lectt ene Stans 11              Connections Initial Setup   Playing Back    Features    e Equipped with 7 ch amplifier   e Supports playback in Dolby Atmos format which  provides 360 degree placement and movement of  sounds including overhead sound   e Supports playback in DTS X  which is DTS s next   generation object based surround sound technology  that includes height to deliver a fully immersive listening  experience to your living room   e Dolby Surround listening mode expands 2 ch  5 1 ch or  7 1 ch source to available speaker configurations   e Equipped with 4K compatible HDMI IN OUT jacks   e Equipped with 2 HDMI output jacks   e Supports the HDMI Standby Through function which  allows signal transmission from players to the TV in  standby state   e Supports HDCP2 2  a strict copy protection for providing  high quality content  HDMI IN1 to IN3 HDMI OUT MAIN   SUB    e Supports ARC  Audio Return Channel    e Supports USB storage playback   e Supports variety of network functions such as Internet  Radio  DLNA  AirPlay etc    e Supports Wi Fi and Bluetooth     e Equipped with a PHONO jack enabling connection with  a turntable   e Bi Amping capability   e A V Sync Function to correct deviation of audio and  video   e Multi zone function which allows you to play a different  
58.  Connections      Initial Setup       Sound files that are protected by copyright cannot be played    e When the USB audio player and this unit are connected  the   audio player screen and the screen of the unit may be different    In addition  control functions of the audio player  classifying and   sorting music files and adding information  etc   are not available   on this unit    Do not connect a PC to the USB port of the unit  Inputting sound   to the USB port of the unit from a PC is not possible    Media inserted to the USB card reader may not be available in   this function    e Some USB storage devices and its contents may require some  time to be read    e Depending on the USB storage device  proper reading of the  contents and proper supply of the power supply may not be  possible    e Onkyo accepts no responsibility whatsoever for the loss or  damage to data stored on a USB storage device when that  device is used with this unit  We recommend that you back up  your important music files beforehand    e Performance of the hard disk that receive power from the USB  port of the unit is not guaranteed    e  f you connect a USB hard disk drive to the USB port of the unit   we recommend that you use its AC adapter to power it    e When an audio player that are operated with batteries is used   make sure that the batteries have enough remaining power    e  his unit does not support USB storage devices with security   functions     Supported Audio Formats    e For server
59.  ENTER   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen    press RETURN    e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the main unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks  EL    Listening to Internet Radio                                                 qu     lt p         RETURN       E Playing Back  1  Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen   GE NE  KE E E  ere a   20    2620     oNN                                           e    Spoti 5   tunein  SiriusXM Internet Radio  Slacker Personal Radio  Deezer  AirPlay          2  Select  Tuneln Radio  with the cursors and press  ENTER to display the Tuneln Radio top screen     3  With the cursors  select a radio station or program and  press ENTER to start playing     En 5       gie          Connections      Initial Setup       E Regarding the Tuneln Radio Menu    To display the Tuneln menu  press MENU or ENTER while  playing a radio station  Selecting the corresponding menu  item with the cursors and pressing ENTER allows you to  perform the following operations     Add to My Presets  Registers the radio station or  program being broadcast in  My Presets   Once  registered   My Presets  is displayed in the level under  Tuneln 
60.  Enter Password  screen may be displayed  automatically if the wireless LAN router does not have  an automatic setting button        Ez Wi Fi Setup    Select the authentication method     Enter Password  Push Button  PIN code          When this screen is displayed  select and set one of the  three authentication methods   Enter Password    Push     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       Button  and  PIN code   See below for details of and  how to set each method     Enter Password  Enter the password of the access point   to establish connection     D Select  Enter Password  with the cursor buttons and  press ENTER     2  Enter the password     on the keyboard screen  select   OK  with the cursor buttons and press ENTER      Select  A a  and press ENTER to toggle between upper and lower  case  Select        or       and press ENTER to move the cursor to  the selected direction  Select  lt x  and press ENTER to delete the  character at the left of the cursor position  To select whether to  mask the password with   gt  lt   or display it in plain text  press D on  the remote control  Press  10 on the remote controller to switch  between upper and lower case  Press CLR to delete all the input  characters     3  If the security method of the access point to be  connected is WEP  select  Default Key ID   select  OK   and press ENTER     Push Button  Use the automatic setting button of the   access point to establish connection     D Select  Push Button  with th
61.  Game Action          Game Rock         Game Sports         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono 4          T D          Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     DTS 96 24 Direct       DTS 96 24            Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG         Game Action         Game Rock         Game Sports         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono            T D    DTS HD HR Direct  DTS HD HR       Dolby Surround  DTS Neural X  Game RPG    Game Action    Game Rock    Game Sports    AllCh Stereo 4  Full Mono    T D                                              En 26     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed      1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed                 Connections Initial Setup Playing Back exc  elojejsie b  Miete  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller                     
62.  HOME  S  ffer   A e Be PELIS et PREV CH  BHAA PRORA nicis  DL   DEEN Ree     Go  ee O Si  4 00 c0   e me   G  TO Satellite receiver   Cable receiver operation   Gar ur a  Oni  OT Se A    ZE E Press the REMOTE MODE button programmed with I 4  gt       0    C an     the remote control code for the relevant AV component    to switch the remote controller mode to that for the AV              REMOTE MODE component  Then  operate by using the corresponding 2  RE             OSOURCE buttons  Available buttons vary depending on the product  ara   s  e     B   8 MUTING category of the component  Operation may be incorrect or   OM uen oodd    CH     impossible depending on the product           11 1        P   ii  E  da kk  eG kk  I LI tJ LJ J SOURCE  0 A  Red   B  Green   C  Yellow   D  Blue    B  e   vii  gt   e LP RN  A 2 Eech  6 ned E  ew ed pa GO     CLR  DISPLAY      pe e   e   ex  here  Z    S ere   e     mn Of  alt    5 GUIDE ew rp E     A     lt   gt   ENTER   3  D HOME  PREV CH    REMOTE MODE   9 RETURN    OSOURCE   3 MUTING    CH       En 49                Connections      Initial Setup    Playing Back        gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       CD player operation    Press the REMOTE MODE button programmed with  the remote control code for the relevant AV component       I  o   mi   I   I   I   I       l   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I   I    ARCH REPEAT RANDOM MODE                to switch the remote controller mode to that for
63.  IN4  PC   IN5  GAME   IN6  IN7  AUX INPUT HDMI  front   Output  OUT MAIN  ARC   OUT SUB  Video Resolution  4K 60 Hz  RGB YCbCr4 4 4 YCbCr4 2 2  24 bit   Audio Format  Dolby Atmos  Dolby TrueHD  Dolby Digital Plus  Dolby Digital  DTS X   DTS HD Master Audio  DTS HD High Resolution Audio  DTS 96 24  DTS   ES  DTS  DTS Express  DSD  Multichannel PCM  up to 8ch   Supported  3D  Audio Return Channel  Deep Color  x v Color     LipSync  CEC   4K  Extended Colorimetry  sYCC601  Adobe RGB  Adobe YCC601    Content Type  3D Dual View  21 9 Aspect Ratio Video Format    e Video Inputs  Component  IN1 BD DVD   IN2  GAME   Composite  IN1 CBL SAT   IN2  STRM BOX   IN3  PC     e Audio Inputs  Digital  OPTICAL 1  CD   2  TV   COAXIAL  BD DVD   Analog  BD DVD  CBL SAT  STRM BOX  PC  GAME  TV  CD  PHONO    e Audio Outputs  Analog  ZONE2 LINE OUT  2 SUBWOOFER PRE OUT  Speaker Outputs  FRONT L R  CENTER  SURROUND L R  BACK or HEIGHT L R  ZONE2  L R  Phones  PHONES  Front    6 3     e Others   Setup Mic 1  Front    RI REMOTE CONTROL 1   USB 1  1 1  5 V 1 A   Ethernet 1    Supports multi language on screen display    North American  English  German  French  Spanish  Italian  Dutch    Swedish    Taiwanese  English  German  French  Spanish  Italian  Dutch  Swedish    Chinese  ki    Others  English  German  French  Spanish  Italian  Dutch  Swedish    Russian  Chinese   gt       zk OSD is not displayed when the input selector is  NET  or    BLUETOOTH   Use the display on the main unit when operating th
64.  If multiple video signal inputs are put into one input  m  Analog audio  RCA  cable system  the output will be made in the order of  HDMI  COMPONENT VIDEO composite video           COMPONENT VIDEO    IN  IN      CBL SAT     TH     5  Connect a turntable that uses an MM type cartridge and  does not have a built in audio equalizer  If the connected  turntable has a built in audio equalizer  connect it to the   4  CD jack      If it uses an MC type cartridge  install an audio equalizer compatible  with MC type cartridge between the unit and the turntable by  connecting it to the   CD jack  For details  refer to the turntable s    m instruction manual   zk If the turntable has a ground wire  connect it to the GND terminal of   BD  this unit  If connecting the ground wire increases noise  disconnect it              9   9   9     w g  S  z  g   EA   E   faj   E    E   E   E    DIGITAL IN     ASSIGNABLE           En 9       A Initial Setup Playing Back Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller          Network connection   You can enjoy Internet radio  DLNA and AirPlay by  connecting the unit to LAN  The unit can be connected to  the router with an Ethernet cable or to the wireless LAN  router with Wi Fi connection  In case of wired connection     3 Other connections       AM FM antenna connections connect the Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port  See  4  Connect the antennas to listen to AM FM broadcast  When Network Connection  of  Step 2  Initial Setup  f
65.  Menu    A V Sync    the simple measures on both the unit and the  connected device  If the problem is that the video       Cannot play digital surround        or audio is not output or the HDMI linked operation e To enjoy digital surround sound including Dolby Digital and  does not work  disconnecting connecting the HDMI DTS  audio output should be set to  Bitstream output  on the  cable may solve it  When reconnecting  be careful connected Blu ray Disc Player or other device   not to wind the HDMI cable since if wound the     2   Press OON  1   While holding  HDMI cable may not fit well  After reconnecting  turn Cannot output audio such as Dolby Atmos according STANDBY  down CBL SAT   off and on the unit and the connected device  to the format of the source      e  f you cannot output audio according to the format of the e How to reset the remote controller     source  Dolby TrueHD  Dolby Atmos  DTS HD Master Audio     1  While holding d RECEIVER th t troller   etc    in the Blu ray Disc Player settings try setting  BD video ere on wie remote CONIONET    press Q until the remote indicator stays lit  about 3                                        The AV receiver turns off unexpectedly  supplementary sound   or secondary sound  to  Off   Change seconds     e The AV receiver will automatically enter standby mode when the listening mode for each source after changing the setting to Ep                   acain  Auto Standby or Sleep Timer is set and launched  confirm  p ds   e Th
66.  My  Favorites list     Using Multiple Accounts  The AV receiver supports  multiple user accounts  which means you can freely switch  between several logins  After registering user accounts   login is performed from the  Users  screen   Press MENU while the Users screen is displayed   Add  new user    Remove this user  menu appear  You can  either store a new user account  or delete an existing one   e Some of the services do not allow the use of multiple  user accounts     Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       e You can store up to 10 user accounts    e To switch between accounts you must first log out from  the current account  and log in again on the  Users   Screen     Registering Other Internet Radios    To listen to other Internet radio program  register the  program in the  My Favorites  list as described in the next  section   My Favorites  are displayed in the level under the  one displayed when you press NET    e You can register up to 40 Internet radio stations    e The unit supports Internet radio stations stored in the  following formats  PLS  URL ending in  pls   M3U  URL  ending in  m3u  and RSS  URL ending in rss rdf xml    Depending on the data type and playback format  there  may be some you cannot play    e Available services may vary depending on your area of  residence     e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance   displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the   cursor buttons of the remote controller and press EN
67.  Not all listening modes use all speakers  the problem  If the measures above do not solve the problem  reset  the unit with the following procedure  If you reset the unit status   There s no picture  your preferences will be reset to the defaults  Note them down  e A wrong input selector button has been selected  before starting reset   e Video from the analog input is not displayed if the listening mode  is Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models  e How to reset     e To display video from the connected player on the TV screen  while the unit is in standby  you need to enable HDMI Standby  Through function    e When the TV image is blurry or unclear  power cord or 2  Press OON STANDBY on the main unit   Clear  appears on    connection cables of the unit may have interfered  In that case  the display and the unit returns to standby      1  While holding down CBL SAT on the main unit  note that  step 2 must be performed with this button pressed down     En 21           Connections   Initial Setup    Specifications    Amplifier Section    Rated Output Power  North American   With 8 ohm loads  both channels driven  from 20 20 000 Hz  rated 100  watts per channel minimum RMS power  with no more than 0 08  total  harmonic distortion from 250 milliwatts to rated output   Surround Mode Output Power   gt       6 ohms  1 kHz THD 0 9   170 W per channel    x Reference output for each speakers    Depending on the source and the listening mode settings    there may be no soun
68.  P 02187 ANE 01334 03424 Canal Digital 02553  01780   indi i   00853  01334  Windjammer Cable   00476  01376  Altech UEC 02059  02097  Axitronic 01626 Ze SE SE  01877 03517 AZ America 01631 ana ee n  WNC 03118 Amiko 04197 AZBox 02719 en ES  WOW  01877  01376  Amstrad 00847  01662  B net 01672  00476  02187  01175  01693  B ytronic 00740 E E  02479 m Century 03110  00856      02467 Beijing 03299 CGV 02034  01413  Xfinity 01376  01982  AMTC 02738  02813 Bell 00775 dO    00476  01877  Ansonic 02418 Bell ExpressVu 00775 Chess 02026  01334  SEN e E Aonvision 02279 Bell Fibe TV 00775 See    uyi Radio  YBN 03322 Apro 01672 Bell Satellite TV 00775 Cignal 02289  02835   YCV 02703  01760 Argos 02568 Belson 02418 02836  i Arion 03374  04348 BENsat 02957  02938 CitvC 00299  00658  Youview 02994 IDN Or      Arnion 01300 Best Buy 02728  02842 02957  Yunnan Broadcasting   03961   fuxng              jU2zUI4d                       AS 01284 BIOSTEK 02738 Claro 03787  03790  Zhong Hua Dian Xin   01917    Ziggo 02589  03607 ASA 00740 BiS Television 01986 Classic 01291  01284   02015  02762  ASCI 01334 Black Diamond 01284 01672  02447 AssCom 00853 Blu sens 02938 Clayton 01626  Zinwell 03139 Astrell 01986  02418 Boca 02026  02458  CME 00173  Zito Media 01376  01982 Astro 00173  01838  02797  02308  CMX 02205  02932  ZTE 04196 02627  00658  02813 Cobra 02728  03012  03838  01099  Boshmann 01413  01631 Gom Hem 01176  01915  01100  02026 Botech 02738  03749                                  50       C
69.  PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES    LOSS OF USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON   ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR  OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  SUCH DAMAGE      gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller       En 29           Connections Initial Setup    License and Trademark Information     I  DOLBY    Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories  Dolby  Dolby  Atmos  Dolby Surround and the double D symbol are trademarks of Dolby  Laboratories     Sy  dts   e   EEE    Tra     For DTS patents  see http   patents dts com  Manufactured under license from  DTS  Inc  DTS  the Symbol  DTS in combination with the Symbol  the DTS HD  logo  and DTS HD Master Audio are registered trademarks or trademarks of  DTS  Inc  in the United States and or other countries     DTS  Inc  All Rights  Reserved     CIN ew  rwcren     CINEMA FILTER  and  CINEMA FILTER  logo   are trademarks of Onkyo  Corporation   e    HIGH DEFINITION MULTIMEDIA INTERFACE    The terms HDMI and HDMI High Definition Multimedia Interface  and the HDMI  Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the  United States
70.  Telstra 01356  SKY PerfecTV  03099 TELUS 00775  Sky UK 01175  01662 Thomson 01662  01175   SkyCable 01631  01957 e 01307   Skylink 02957  01545     n 02443  02928 TiVo 01377  01442  011 95  01197  T Mobile 02631  02443   Skymaster 02932  01545 01545  Skypex 00740 TNT SAT 01692  Skyplus 00740  01175  Topfield 01545  02838  01334 TPS 01307  Skytec 02928 Tricolor TV 03064  Skyvision 02797 True Visions 03784  SkyWay 02928 TV Cabo 02160  Skyworth 01631 TV Vlaanderen 02631  02466  SL 00740 TVA Digital 02895  Smart 03095  01631 TVonics 01906  Spiderbox 03562 UPC   02443  Star Choice 00869 UPC Direct 02443  Starmax 02638 Vantage 02797  Stream System 01300 Vestel 02231  03517  Strong 03424  01300  Via Embratel 02796  02813  01682  Viasat 01682  01197   02278 01195  Sunny 01300 Vivo 02895  01692   TDS Telecom 00775 02527  Teac 01957 Vut 03458  02799   Technicolor 03790   03543  Wisi 00740  02957          En 91       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                      Xoro 02738  02813   03422   Xtreme 01300   Xtrend 03320   Zehnder 03422  03424   01777  02034   00740   Ziggo 02443   Zircon 02957                B TV DVD Combination                                                                                                                                                                   AEG 12197  12239   Affinity 13870  13717   Akai 12676  13067   12197   Akura 12289  11983   12239   Alba 12676  13005  
71.  Temple Place   Suite 330  Boston  MA 02111 1307  USA    Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail    If the program is interactive  make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode    Gnomovision version 69  Copyright  C  year name of author Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY  for details  type    show w   This is free software  and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions  type    show c  for details   The hypothetical commands    show wi and    show c  should show the appropriate parts of the General Public License  Of course     En 26    ben  mmm    Playing Back    Advanced Manual    the commands you use may be called something other than    show w  and    show c     they could even be mouse clicks or menu  items  whatever suits your program    You should also get your employer  if you work as a programmer  or your school  if any  to sign a  copyright disclaimer  for the  program  if necessary  Here is a sample  alter the names    Yoyodyne  Inc   hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program  Gnomovision   which makes passes at compilers  written  by James Hacker      signature of Ty Coon gt   1 April 1989   Ty Coon  President of Vice   This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into proprietary programs  If your program is a  subroutine library  you may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library  If this is
72.  Universum 00173  00299   00740  01099   Unixbox 01652   UPC 01780  02443   UPC Cablecom 01195  01197   UPC Direct 02443   Vantage 02797   Variosat 00173   VEA 02418   Vectra 01195  01197   Vestel 01626  01284   02231  02034   03517   VH Sat 00299   Via Embratel 03787  02796                      En 86     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Viasat 01682  01197  Zehnder 01777  03422   01195  02235  01334  01413   00253 02289  03424   Videocon 03077 02034  00740   Vietnam Television 03834 01631  Corporation Zenega 02604  Viola Digital 01672 Zenith 00856  03110   Vision 01626 03469  VisionNet 01631 Ziggo 02443  01499   Visiosat 01413 01657  00253  Vistron 00740 Zircon 02957  Vitecom 01413 Zodiac 03726  Viva 00856 Zon 02160  Vivax 02418 Zon Optimus 02160  Vivo 02262  02895   01692  02527 E Video   Accessory  Volcasat 02418 A C Ryan 02709  03350  Voom 00869 ABS 01272  VTC 03834 Acer 01272  Vu 03458  02799  Alienware 01272  03543 Apple 02615  Walker 02034 ASRock 01272  Wavelength 01413 Boxe 03693  Wharfedale 01935  02034  Ceton 01272    01284  01906 Claritas 01272  ad E CyberPower 01272  Ser  eg 00173 ESSO 1L  00299  02957  zal uu  01986 Digitech 02260  Woxter 02418  02813 KS KEES  Xoro 02813  02738  Cas  03012  03422 aula a  Xtreme 01300 Eminent 03215  02260  Xtrend 03320 zur a  Yaleumo 01413 Fantec   03350  02709  Yes 00887  01887 Fujitsu Siemens 01272  Youview 03140 Ens i  ZapMaster 00740 Gateway 01272  G Box Midnight 04440  Hewlett Packard 01272                
73.  and other countries     Gri  CERTIFIED  The Wi Fi CERTIFIED Logo is a certification mark of the Wi Fi Alliance       ES    AirPlay       Made for          iPod   iPhone   iPad          AirPlay  iPad  iPhone  and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc   registered  in the U S  and other countries     iPad Air and iPad mini are trademarks of Apple Inc      Made for iPod    Made for iPhone  and  Made for iPad  mean that an  electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod  iPhone   or iPad  respectively  and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple  performance standards  Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device  or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards     Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod  iPhone or iPad may affect  wireless performance     AirPlay works with iPhone  iPad  and iPod touch with iOS 4 3 3 or later  Mac  with OS X Mountain Lion or later  and PC with iTunes 10 2 2 or later     Apple  Apple TV and Safari are trademarks of Apple Inc   registered in the U S   and other countries     En 30      Playing Back    Advanced Manual    C Bluetooth       The Bluetooth   word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by  Bluetooth SIG  Inc  and any use of such marks by Onkyo is under license   Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners     Onkyo does not guarantee Bluetooth compatibility between the AV receiver and  all Bluetooth enabled devices    For compatibility
74.  application does not supply it  the square root function must still  compute square roots    These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole  If identifiable sections of that work are not derived  from the Library  and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves  then this  License  and its terms  do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works  But when you  distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library  the distribution of the  whole must be on the terms of this License  whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole   and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it   Thus  it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you  rather  the intent is to  exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library   In addition  mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library  or with a work based on the Library  on a  volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License   3  You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this License to a given  copy of the Library  To do this  you must alter all the notices that refer to this License  so that they refer to the  ordinary GNU General Public License  version 2  instead of to this Licens
75.  between the AV receiver and another device with Bluetooth  technology  consult the device s documentation and dealer  In some countries   there may be restrictions on using Bluetooth devices  Check with your local  authorities       Siriusxm      INTERNET RADIO    SIRIUS  XM and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio  Inc  and its subsidiaries  All rights reserved     DLNAS  the DLNA Logo and DLNA CERTIFIED  are trademarks  service  marks  or certification marks of the Digital Living Network Alliance     This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft  Use  or distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a  license from Microsoft     Windows and the Windows logo are trademarks of the Microsoft group of  companies     QR Code is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED    X  v Color  and  x v Color  logo are trademarks of Sony Corporation   DSD and the Direct Stream Digital logo are trademarks of Sony Corporation     MPEG Layer 3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and  Thomson     AccuEQ  Music Optimizer  RIHD and WRAT are trademarks of Onkyo  Corporation      All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners      DISCLAIMER    Through this device you are able to link to other services or  websites which are not under the control of any company which has  designed  manufactured or distributed have distributed this device   and its affiliates  collec
76.  can be selected only when the  input is assigned to the COAXIAL jack in the   Digital Audio Input  setting    OPTICAL  Optical input    When giving priority  to input signal from DIGITAL IN OPTICAL jacks   e  he setting can be selected only when the  input is assigned to the OPTICAL jack in the   Digital Audio Input  setting    Analog   To always output analog audio  independently of the input signal  PCM Fixed Mode Off Select whether to fix input signals to PCM           except multi channel PCM  when you have  selected  HDMI    COAXIAL   or  OPTICAL  in  the  Audio Select  setting  Set this item to  On   if noise is produced or truncation occurs at the  beginning of a track when playing PCM sources   Select  Off  normally   e Changing  Audio Select  changes the setting  to  Off         e The setting cannot be changed when  TUNER    NET   or  BLUETOOTH  input is selected     En 37       50          Connections         Initial Setup    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                   Video Select  Setting Item Default Value Setting Details  Video Select Last Select the video input played along with       audio output when either  TUNER    NET  or   BLUETOOTH  is selected    e This setting is effective only for an input  selector which is assigned in  HDMI Input  or   Video Input      Last   Select the video input played immediately  prior     BD DVD    CBL SAT    STRM BOX    PC     GAME    AUX    CD    PHONO    TV   Play the  video fr
77.  connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream     il DTS HD HR  DTS HD High Resolution Audio     Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in DTS HD   High Resolution Audio    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream     il DTS HD MSTR  DTS HD Master Audio     Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in DTS HD   Master Audio   e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream     B DTS Neo 6    This mode expands any 2 ch source for 5 1 ch multichannel  surround playback  It offers full bandwidth on all channels   with great independence between the channels  There   are two variants for this mode  one ideal for movies and  another ideal for music         Neo 6 Cinema  Use this mode with any 2 ch movie       Neo 6 Music  Use this mode with any 2 ch music  source     B DTS Neural X    Neural X enables upmixing of legacy content such as  mono  stereo  5 1 or 7 1ch to many higher speaker count  including the layout using elevated channels set for DTS X  playback     Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       E DTS X    This mode is for use with DTS sources  DTS X is DTS s  next generation object based surround sound technology  that includes height to deliver a fully immersive listening  experience to yo
78.  cursors  and press ENTER   The input name will be saved              e To name a preset radio station  press TUNER on the remote controller  select AM FM and select the  preset number   e It cannot be set if the  NET  or  BLUETOOTH  input is selected      gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Audio Select    Make the audio input setting  The setting can be separately set to each input selector  button  Select the input selector to configure              Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details  Audio Select BD DVD  Select the priority for input selection when  HDMI multiple audio Sources are connected to one  CBL SAT  input selector  such as connections to both the  HDMI  BD DVD  of HDMI IN jack and  BD DVD  of  STRM BOX  AUDIO IN jack  You cannot select a jack that is  HDMI not associated with the currently selected input   PC  e The priority is HDMI     COAXIAL OPTICAL      HDMI Analog if this setting is not changed   GAME  ARC  When giving priority to input signal from  HDMI ARC compatible TV   AUX  e The setting can be selected only when  HDMI   HDMI    Audio Return Channel  is set to  Auto  and  CD  also the  TV  input is selected   OPTICAL HDMI  When giving priority to input signal from  TV  HDMI jacks  OPTICAL o The setting can be selected only when the  input is assigned to the HDMI IN jack in the  PHONO   HDMI Input  setting   Analog  COAXIAL  Coaxial input    When giving priority  to input signal from DIGITAL IN COAXIAL jacks   e  he setting
79.  green   blue  and red from left to right  press the buttons on  the AV receiver s remote controller in that order    e Programming is complete when the remote indicator  flashes twice  The remote indicator flashes once  slowly when programming the remote control code  fails  Try programming again    e Pressing any other button than a colored button  cancels the remap operation              O f IE   SEARCH REPEAT RANDOM MODE   Ew mE   D    C Cy   3    E Resetting the REMOTE MODE Buttons    You can reset the remote control code registered in the  REMOTE MODE button to its default status  This operation  can be executed on a single REMOTE MODE button     1  Press and hold Q for 3 or more seconds while holding  down the REMOTE MODE button you want to reset   e  he remote indicator will light              2  Within 30 seconds  press the REMOTE MODE button  again   e Resetting is complete when the remote indicator  flashes twice     To reset all the remote controller settings  While holding  down RECEIVER  press and hold Q for 3 or more seconds  until the remote indicator stays lit  Within 30 seconds  press  RECEIVER again  Resetting is complete when the remote  indicator flashes twice     En 47          Connections Initial Setup Playing Back exc elejejsie b  ureugitel  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller                                                                                                                                                                     
80.  in a Shared Folder 13 Operating Other Components with the Remote  TE TEE 62  About Shared Folder 13   Controller 46  Setting PC 13 Functions of REMOTE MODE Buttons 46  Playing from a Shared Folder 13 Programming Remote Control Codes 46                Connections Initial Setup      Playing Back       Details on AM FM reception       Tuning into a Radio Station    E Tuning automatically    1  Press TUNER on the main unit several times to select  either  AM  or  FM      TV TUNER NET        E    2  Press TUNING MODE so that the  AUTO  indicator on  the display lights                 r    CLEAR    4  MEMORY TUNING MODE DISPLAY                     3  Press VTUNINGA to start automatic tuning    e Searching automatically stops when a station is  found  When tuned into a radio station  the   gt   TUNED  lt   indicator on the display lights  When  tuned into an FM radio station  the  FM STEREO   indicator lights    e No sound is output while the   gt  TUNED  e  indicator  is off     Y TUNING        PRESET            When the signal from an FM radio station is weak   Radio wave may be weak depending on the building  structure and environmental conditions  In that case   perform the manual tuning procedure as explained in the  next section   Tuning manually   to manually select the  desired station     En 2     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       E Tuning manually    1  Press TUNER on the main unit several times to select  either  AM  or  FM      TV TUNER NET   
81.  is  selected  connecting a headphone automatically selects  Stereo     Bl About DTS signals   e When DTS program material ends and the DTS  bitstream stops  the unit remains in DTS listening mode  and the dts indicator remains on  This is to prevent noise  when you use the pause  fast forward  or fast reverse  function on your player  If you switch your player from  DTS to PCM  you may not hear any sound because the  unit does not switch formats immediately  In such case   you should stop your player for about 3 or more seconds  and then resume playback    e With some CD and LD players  you will not be able  to playback DTS material properly even though your  player is connected to a digital input on the unit  This is  usually because the DTS bitstream has been processed   e g   output level  sampling rate  or frequency response  changed  and the unit does not recognize it as a  genuine DTS signal  In such cases  you may hear noise    e When playing DTS program material  using the pause   fast forward  or fast reverse function on your player may  produce a short audible noise  This is not a malfunction     B The beginning of audio received by an HDMI IN   cannot be heard   e Since it takes longer to identify the format of an HDMI  signal than it does for other digital audio signals  audio  output may not start immediately     Listening Mode    e When listening to Dolby Digital and or DTS sound   digital connection is necessary    e Check the digital audio output setting on t
82.  mode  Only  Auto  and  Auto Eco   can  be selected if  HDMI CEC  RIHD   is set to  On    If you select anything else  set  HDMI CEC   RIHD   to  Off     e Power consumption in standby mode  increases if set to anything other than  Off      BD DVD    CBL SAT    STRM BOX    PC      GAME    AUX    CD    PHONO    TV   For   example  if you select  BD DVD   you can play   the equipment connected to the  BD DVD   terminal on the TV even if the unit is in standby  mode  Select this setting if you have decided  which player to use with this function     Last   You can play the video and audio of the   input selected immediately prior to the unit being   switched to standby on the TV  When  Last    is selected  you can switch the input of the   unit even in the standby mode with the remote   controller or the Onkyo Remote app     Auto    Auto  Eco    Select one of these  settings when you have connected equipment  that conforms to the CEC standard  You can  play the video and audio of the input selected on  the TV  irrespective of what input was selected  immediately prior to the unit being switched to  standby  using the CEC link function    e To play players on the TV that do not conform  to the CEC standard  you will need to turn the  unit on and switch to the relevant input    e When using a TV that conforms to the  CEC standard  you can reduce the power  consumption in standby mode by selecting   Auto  Eco      Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details          En 40    A
83.  not supported  Name the SSID of the  wireless LAN router using single byte alphanumeric  characters only and try again     B Playback is interrupted and communication does   not work   e Cannot receive signals due to a bad connection   Shorten the distance from wireless LAN access point  or remove obstacles for a good visibility  and try again   Place the unit away from microwave ovens or other  access points  It is recommended to place the Wi Fi  router  access point  and the unit in the same room    e  f there is a metallic object near the unit  wireless LAN  connection may not be possible as the metal can effect  on the radio wave    e 2 4 GHz band for wireless LAN may not be enough   Connect ETHERNET port of the unit and the router  via an Ethernet cable after selecting  6  Hardware      Network  and changing  Wi Fi  to  Off Wired      e When other wireless LAN devices are used near the  unit  several issues such as interrupted playback and  communication may occur  You can avoid these issues  by changing the channel of your Wi Fi router  For  instructions on changing channels  see the instruction  manual provided with your Wi Fi router     Multi zone Function    B  There is no zone output from the connected player  e With multi zone function  sound is output only when the  signal input source is an external component connected  to the digital audio input jacks or analog audio input  jacks   NET    BLUETOOTH    AM  or  FM   Multi zone  output is not possible if the playe
84.  of LFE       120Hz       Set the low pass filter for LFE  low frequency effect   signals in order to pass lower frequency signals than  the set value and thus cancel unwanted noises  The  low pass filter will be effective only on sources with  LFE channel    The value from  80Hz  to  120Hz  can be set     Off   Do not use this function          En 33       50         Playing Back    Connections Initial Setup     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                                        Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details  Double Bass On This can only be selected when  Configuration    Back Right T  Oft 2 10m Specify the distance between each speaker and   Subwoofer  is set to  Yes  and  Front  is set to  Full the listening position   Band   e This setting cannot be changed if  Boost bass output by feeding bass sounds from  Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to  the front left and right  and center speakers to the  Yes  and Zone2 is set to on   subwoofer  Back Left 7T  Oft 2 10m Specify the distance between each speaker and   On   Bass output will be boosted  the listening position    Off   Bass output will not be boosted  e This setting cannot be changed if  e The setting will not automatically be configured  Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to  even if you performed the automatic speaker  Yes  and Zone2 is set to on   setup  Surround Left 7T  Oft 2 10m Specify the distance between each speak
85.  order to permit linking those libraries into non free programs    When a program is linked with a library  whether statically or using a shared library  the combination of the two is legally speaking  a combined work  a derivative of the original library  The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if  the entire combination fits its criteria of freedom  The Lesser General Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other  code with the library    We call this license the  Lesser  General Public License because it does Less to protect the user s freedom than the ordinary  General Public License  It also provides other free software developers Less of an advantage over competing non free programs   These disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries  However  the Lesser license  provides advantages in certain special circumstances    For example  on rare occasions  there may be a special need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain library  so that it  becomes a de facto standard  To achieve this  non free programs must be allowed to use the library  A more frequent case is that  a free library does the same job as widely used non free libraries  In this case  there is little to gain by limiting the free library to  free software only  so we use the Lesser General Public License    In other cases  permission to use a particular library in non free programs enables a greater number of p
86.  play a music file on another server  open    the target server from  Other Libraries  and select  the music file to play     4  Select this unit in  Play to  to open the  Play to  window  of Windows Media  Player 12 and start playback on the  unit     e Operations during remote playback are possible  from the  Play to  window on the PC  The playback  screen is displayed on the TV connected to the  HDMI output of the unit  If your PC is running on  Windows 8    click  Play to   and then select this unit     5  Adjust the volume using the volume bar on the  Play to   window    e Sometimes  the volume displayed on the remote  playback window may differ from that appeared on  the display of the unit    e When the volume is adjusted from the unit  the value  is not reflected in the  Play to  window    e This unit cannot play music files remotely in the  following conditions       tis using a network service     Itis playing a music file on a USB storage  device     e Depending on the version of Windows Media  Player   the names of the items you need to select may differ  from the explanation here              Connections Initial Setup       Playing Music Files in a Shared  Folder       About Shared Folder    A shared folder is configured in a network device such as a  PC or NAS  hard disk connected to your home network  for  access from other users    You can play music files in a shared folder on your PC or  NAS connected to the same home network as that of the  unit  To play mu
87.  playback and playback from a USB storage  device  this unit supports the following music file  formats    e Music files of the following formats that can be played  depend on the network server  For example  when using  Windows Media  Player 12  not all music files in the PC  can be played  The music files that can be played are  the ones registered to the Windows Media  Player 12  library    e Variable bit rate  VBR  files are supported  However   playback times may not be displayed correctly    e  his unit supports the gapless playback of the USB  storage device in the following conditions    When WAV  FLAC and Apple Lossless files are  continuously played back with the same format   sampling frequency  channels and quantization bit rate   e Remote playback does not support the gapless  playback    e For playback via wireless LAN  the sampling rate of    En 64    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       88 2 kHz or higher  DSD and Dolby TrueHD are not  supported     Caution    e With remote playback on this unit the following formats are not  supported       FLAC  Ogg Vorbis  DSD and Dolby TrueHD     E MP3   mp3 or  MP3    e Supported formats  MPEG 1 MPEG 2 Audio Layer 3   e Supported sampling rates  8 kHz  11 025 kHz  12 kHz   16 kHz  22 05 kHz  24 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   e Supported bitrates  Between 8 kbps and 320 kbps   Incompatible files cannot be played     E WMA   wma or  WMA    WMA stands for Windows Media Audio and is an 
88.  proprietary libraries that do not normally   accompany the operating system  Such a contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an   executable that you distribute    7  You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side by side in a single library together  with other library facilities not covered by this License  and distribute such a combined library  provided that the  separate distribution of the work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted   and provided that you do these two things    a  Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the Library  uncombined with any  other library facilities  This must be distributed under the terms of the Sections above    b  Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library  and  explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work    8  You may not copy  modify  sublicense  link with  or distribute the Library except as expressly provided under  this License  Any attempt otherwise to copy  modify  sublicense  link with  or distribute the Library is void  and will  automatically terminate your rights under this License  However  parties who have received copies  or rights   from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full  compliance    9  You are not required to accept this License  
89.  seconds                                                  To control on the main unit  press ZONE2 and within 8  seconds  press the input selector button of the source to be    Zone 2 again  press the ZONE2 button to enter the  Zone control mode        r4 Quick Setup Menu    You can perform common settings on the TV screen while    playing     1  Press Q on the remote controller   The Quick Setup menu is displayed on the connected  TV s screen        Quick Setup BD DVD     Listening Mode MOVIE TV   Audio MUSIC   HDMI GAME    Information                2  Select the item with the cursors of the remote  controller and press ENTER to confirm your  selection    e To return to the previous screen  press RETURN     3  Select the setting with the cursors buttons of the  remote controller     powerful bass sound can be obtained   e  t cannot be set if the listening mode is Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models  or Direct     Center Level  Subwoofer Level  Adjust the speaker   level while listening to the sound  The adjustment you   made will be reset to the previous status when you turn   the unit to standby mode    e Changes may not be possible depending on the  settings in speakers    e  his setting is not possible during MUTING or when  using headphones     AN Sync  If the video is behind the audio  you can   delay the audio to offset the gap  Different settings can   be set for each input selector    e  t cannot be set if the listening mode is Pure Audio   European  
90.  speakers  of the TV    Depending on your TV set or input signal of  the component  audio may not output through  the speakers of the TV even if this setting   is set to  On   In such case  audio is output  from the speakers of the unit    If you operate the MASTER VOLUME control  on the unit when  Audio TV Out  SUB   or   HDMI CEC  RIHD   is  On  and audio is  output from the TV speakers  audio will be  output from the unit  If you do not want to  output audio from the unit  change the unit or  TV settings  or reduce the volume of the unit   This setting is fixed to  Off  if  TV Out      HDMI Out  is set to  MAIN      You can enjoy sound of the HDMI connected  ARC compatible TV through the speakers  connected to the unit  To use this function  set   HDMI CEC  RIHD   to  On  in advance     Auto   When enjoying the TV sound through the  speakers connected to the unit    Off   When not using the ARC function     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       Power Management       Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Sleep Timer    Off    Select to turn the unit into standby mode  automatically when the specified time elapses   Select a value between  10 minutes  to  90  minutes      Off   Select if you do not want the unit to  automatically switch to standby        Auto Standby    On Off    This setting places the unit on standby  automatically after 20 minutes of inactivity  without any video or audio input     On   The unit will automatically en
91.  that improves the quality of the  compressed audio    PURE AUDIO button indicator  European  Australian  and Asian models   The display and analog video    circuits are turned off to switch the unit to Pure Audio  mode and provide purer sound    PHONES jack  Stereo headphones with a standard plug  are connected    AUX INPUT HDMI jack  A HD camera or such other  device is connected    00 TONE and Tone Level buttons  Adjust the high tone  and low tone    21  Input selector buttons  Switch the input to be played      SETUP MIC jack  The supplied speaker setup  microphone is connected    63 HYBRID STANDBY indicator  Lights if the unit enters  standby mode when the HDMI Standby Through  USB  Power Out at Standby  Network Standby or Wakeup  from Bluetooth function is enabled     En 3    50                                     Playing Back Advanced Manual              TTT REI  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller        9 wo 906  D  9 D 11 1 6    i   1 Cuef  eweg Dor  Bi  E  r   d  its up MSTR 96 24 ES Exp  M Opt  gt  TUNED 4 FM  STEBEOISEEEPI   IARC 20 RE Ee a   ENEE E E eg   DMI ssicnaste DIGITAL V AE EE E EE EE EE sense    memes EE Se   gpi   Ge  2  causa  3   4  PO 5  GAME 6   r    9   Display       AN R EN    mn    FEE          Rear Panel     D RI REMOTE CONTROL jack  An Onkyo product with RI  jack can be connected and synchronized with this unit     2 TUNER AM FM  750  terminal  The supplied antennas  are connected     3  USB port  A USB storage device is connec
92.  the AV E BE      component  Then  operate by using the corresponding       gt    E     buttons  Available buttons vary depending on the product           category of the component  Operation may be incorrect or     i  impossible depending on the product   0   2                           2   em em eb e   D m  NE   lt  lt    gt  gt   4  kb    SEARCH  REPEAT  RANDOM  MODE  p  eP       o e  9  Number 1 to 9  0   10   LE  Ge Cx    CLR  DISPLAY   e See imo  mj   O       Cassette tape deck operation                      Press the REMOTE MODE button programmed with  the remote control code for the relevant AV component       REMOTE MODE to switch the remote controller mode to that for the AV                                                          l  a component  Then  operate by using the corresponding    DISC     buttons  Available buttons vary depending on the product  category of the component  Operation may be incorrect or  IY LJ CJ UJ impossible depending on the product    5  T     Ecc ee d EH Q i    ple         S  D D      REN  es e  eis              5 A Y    4 p   ENTER              6 HOME CO  REMOTE MODE       OSOURCE   3 MUTING  6S 66  I CH CE CX     e EE T   4  m   a  Reverse Playback   Bl   lt  lt    gt  gt   4 lt    gt P  En 50    To operate CEC compatible components    If this unit is connected via HDMI to a TV or BD DVD   player  you may be able to control the devices using   the remote controller of this unit with CEC  Consumer   Electronics Control  linked operation
93.  the main unit  note  that step 2 must be performed with this button pressed        gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                                                                                                                            B How to reset B The unit turns off unexpectedly  The AV receiver will automatically enter standby mode   when Auto Standby or Sleep Timer is set and launched   e The protection circuit may have been activated  If this is             mode    5 ON STANDBY __    F       Clear T       CBL SAT    d        Before starting the procedure Ve   CO  Problems may be solved by simply turning the power on off    or disconnecting connecting the power cord  which is easier  than working on the connection  setting and operating  procedure  Try the simple measures on both the unit and E How to reset the remote controller  the connected device  If the problem is that the video or 1  While holding down  1  RECEIVER on the remote  audio is not output or the HDMI linked operation does not controller  note that step 2 must be performed with this  work  disconnecting connecting the HDMI cable may solve button pressed down     it  When reconnecting  be careful not to wind the HDMI 2  Press and hold    Q for 3 or more seconds until the     cable since if wound the HDMI cable may not fit well  After remote indicator stays lit  Within 30 seconds  press  1   reconnecting  turn off and on the unit and the connected RECEIVER again   device   e The AV 
94.  the next screen  The list of  folders and music files on the USB storage device are  displayed  Select the folder with the cursors and press   f ENTER to confirm your selection    E Playing Back 5  With the cursors  select the music file to play  and then   1  Plug your USB storage device with the music files into press ENTER or B to start playback   the USB port on the rear of the unit     En 4             60       Connections Initial Setup    LC  XE    C oem 5         e The USB port of this unit conforms with the USB 1 1  standard  The transfer speed may be insufficient  for some content you play  which may cause some  interruption in sound        Playing Back     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Listening to Internet Radio       About Internet Radio    The unit comes preset with Internet radio stations such   as Tuneln Radio for you to enjoy these services  just by   connecting the unit to the Internet    e Network services or contents may become unavailable if  the service provider terminates its service     2 tunein    SiriusXM Internet Radio  Slacker Personal Radio  Deezer  AirPlay       Tuneln Radio    With more than 70 000 radio stations and 2 million on   demand programs registered  Tuneln Radio is a service  where you can enjoy music  sports and news from all over  the world     e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance   displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the   cursor buttons of the remote controller and press
95.  to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the PC button  If you  do not assign a jack  select          To select an  HDMI IN jack already assigned to another input  selector  change its setting to         first        GAME    HDMI 5     HDMI 1  to  HDMI 7   Assign a desired HDMI  IN jack to the GAME button  If you do not assign  a jack  select          To select an HDMI IN jack  already assigned to another input selector   change its setting to         first           Screen Saver       3 minutes       Set the time to start the screen saver  Select  a value from  3 minutes    5 minutes    10  minutes  and  Off      AUX     Front     The setting cannot be changed           En 30    CD     HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2   to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the CD button  If you  do not assign a jack  select          To select an  HDMI IN jack already assigned to another input  selector  change its setting to         first        PHONO           HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2   to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the PHONO button  If    you do not assign a jack  select          To select  an HDMI IN jack already assigned to another  input selector  change its setting to         first           50          Connections    Initial Setup    Playing Back           gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                         Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details   TV         HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2   to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the TV button  If you  d
96.  tulenevatele  teistele asjakohastele s  tetele        ME THN MAPOY  A O KATAZKEYA2TH2 Onkyo Corporation AHAONEI  OTI TX NR646 ZYMMOPOONETAI lIPO2 TI  OYZIOAEI2 ANAITHZEIZ  KAI TIZ AOINE2   ZXETIKEZ AIATA EIZ TH   OAHTIAZ 1999 5 EK        Porla presente  Onkyo Corporation  declara que este TX NR646 cumple  con los requisitos esenciales y otras exigencias relevantes de la Directiva  1999 5 EC        Parla pr  sente  Onkyo Corporation d  clare que l appareil TX NR646 est  conforme aux exigences essentielles et aux autres dispositions pertinentes  de la directive 1999 5 CE        Con la presente Onkyo Corporation dichiara che questo TX NR646     conforme ai requisiti essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite  dalla direttiva 1999 5 CE        Ar   o Onkyo Corporation deklar    ka TX NR646 atbilst Direkt  vas 1999 5   EK b  tiskajam prasibam un citiem ar to saistitajiem noteikumiem          iuo Onkyo Corporation deklaruoja  kad   is TX NR646 atitinka esminius  reikalavimus ir kitas 1999 5 EB Direktyvos nuostatas        A Onkyo Corporation ezzennel kijelenti  hogy a TX NR646 t  pus   beren   dez  s teljes  ti az alapvet   k  vetelm  nyeket   s m  s 1999 5 EK ir  nyelvben  meghat  rozott vonatkoz   rendelkez  seket        Hierbij verklaart Onkyo Corporation dat het toestel   TX NR646 in  overeenstemming is met de essenti  le eisen en de andere relevante  bepalingen van richtlijn 1999 5 EG        Niniejszym Onkyo Corporation deklaruje   e TX NR646 jest zgodny  z zasa
97.  what you  want to do  use the GNU Library General Public License instead of this License    Notice Regarding Third party Software   This product includes the following software that is directly or indirectly licensed to Onkyo by third party developers     1  bfsh sk   2  ixml   3  libcurl   4  libFLAC   5  libipeg   6  libogg   T  libpng   8  libvorbis   9  ntp   10  OpenSSL   11  popt   12  RSA Data Security  Inc  MD5 Message Digest Algorithm  13  thttpd 2 25b  14  zlib   15  Apple Lossless  16  Boost   Tf  Expat   18  FastDelegate  19  Tremolo   20  Tremor   21  Mersenne Twister  22  cURL   23  c ares   24  LZ4    In response to requests from the copyright owners of each piece of software  Onkyo notifies you of the following     1  bfsh sk   2  ixml   3  libcurl   4  libFLAC   5  libipeg   6  libogg   T  libpng   8  libvorbis   9  ntp   10  OpenSSL   11  popt   12  RSA Data Security  Inc  MD5 Message Digest Algorithm  13  thttpd 2 25b  14  zlib   15  Apple Lossless  16  Boost   T  Expat   18  FastDelegate  19  Tremolo   20  Tremor   21  Mersenne Twister  22  cURL   23  c ares   24  LZ4    1  bfsh sk    Copyright  c  2007 Samuel KABAK   Permission is hereby granted  free of charge  to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files   the  Software    to deal in the Software without restriction  including without limitation the rights to use  copy  modify  merge   publish  distribute  sublicense  and or sell copies of the Software  and to perm
98. 0037   Welltech 10714   Weltstar 11037                Westinghouse    11712  19579   13382  13949   11826  12293   11755  12397    Zenith 10017  10178   11423  10000   12731  11365   12358  12362   Zepto 11585   Ziggo 11818   Zonda 10698             B TV DVD Combination                                                                                                                                  Venturer 13005   Vestel 11037  11585   10037  12676   10668  11667   Vexa 10037   Victor 11428  10000   10093  10150   11150  10650   10653   Videocon 10508  10037   Videoseven 11755   VideoSystem 10037   Vidikron 10735   Vidtech 10178   Viewsonic 12014  12745   12087  13706   11755  11627   12049  11365   Viore 12352  13392   13118  13429   12104   Visa 10037   Vision 11826  10037   VisionPlus 12426  12106       Visual Innovations    12106                         VIZIO    11758  13758   12707  12757   13415  12512   13174  12209                                                                                                    Vortec 10037   Voxson 12197  10178   10037  11667   VU 12098  11365   Walker 12676  11667   11585   Waltham 10037  11037   10668   Wansa 12098   Wards 10178  10017        10000             Mitsubishi Electric 34004  OK  32966  OKI 32966  Orava 30713  Orion 30713  Panasonic 32859  Philips 30539  Polaroid 32966  ProLine 32966  Prosonic 32966  Saba 32966  Salora 32966  Sanyo 32966  SEG 30713  Sharp 32966  30630  Sony 30864  Soundwave 30713  Sylvania 30675  30630  
99. 00858  02047   02401  02345   03028  02378                                                                                                                      Sky Austria 02620   Sky Deutschland 02620   SureWest 01998   Swisscom 02271   TalkTalk 02994   TCC 04409   TDC 02271   Telefonica 01585  03028   03288   En 90     sat 01300   ADB 02553   AEG 02738  02813   Airtel 02248   Altech UEC 02097  03517   Amiko 04197   Amstrad 01662  01175   02467  01693   Arion 04348   Astro 03838   Atevio 02928   Atlanta 03320   Austriasat 01195  01197   02957  02631   Auvisio 02932  02738   02813   Avanit 00299   Axil 03424   AZ America 01631   AZBox 02719   B ytronic 00740   Bell 00775   Bell ExpressVu 00775   Bell Fibe TV 00775   Bell Satellite TV 00775   BENsat 02957   Boca 02797  02308        02813                    gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller   Botech 02738  03749 DTK Deutsche 01195  01197  Boxer 01957 Telekabel  BSkyB 01175  01662 Dyon 02738  02813  Bush 02034 Easy One 03240  Canal Digitaal 02631  02466  Echostar 00775  02527   02957 Edision 01631  Canal Digital 02553 Elta 02738  Canal  02657 Engel 03749  CanalSat 02657 Etisalat 02443  CityCom 02957 Eurosky 00740  Clarke Tech 03320 FaVal 03422  Claro 03790 Ferguson 02638  CMX 02932 Finnet 01957  Comag 02797  02813  Foxtel 01356   02308 Freesat 01692  02928   Coship 03790 03266  Cyfrowy Polsat 02527 Freesat  02443  03266  DCR 03517 Fuji Onkyo 01631  Deutsche Telekabel 01195  01197 Galaxy Innovations 02799  04197
100. 01917  Chunghwa 03647  01917    Cincinnati Bell    01877  01376                   Cisco    01877  00858   03028  01982   02132  02345   02589  01883   01998  01582   02047  02378   02563  02401   02742  03265   02271  02947   03452                                  Citycable    03451  03477             CJ    03322  02897   02979  03340   03407  03849                         CJ Digital    02979  02897   03322  03340   03407  03849                CJ HelloVision    03322  02897   02979  03340   03407  03849          Fastway 03382   FCTV 01782  02703   Fidelity 01376   Communications   Finnet 02030  02832   First Media 03783   Freebox 01976   Frontier 02378   Communications   Fujian Broadcast  amp  TV   04195   Network Group   Fujian Broadcast and   04195   TV   Gangwon 03407   Broadcasting Network   Gansu Cable 04236   GCI 01376   GCS 03322   GDCATV 02980  03131   03132   Gehua 03278  00476   General 01376    Communications       General Instrument    00276  00476             Claro    01376  00476       ClubInternet    02132                CMA Communications    01376          CMB    03389  02979   03498                Coship 01991  02950   03278  04162   04408  04196   Cosmic 02897   Cox 01877  01376   00476   Cis 02703  03474   Daeryung 01877   Darty Box 02436   DASAN 02683   Delta 03607  02015   00660  02447   02762   DEN 02726   Deutsche Telekom 02132   Digeo 02187   Digi 02762  03479   Digicable 03382  02479   DigitAlb 02493   Director 00476   Dmg 03835   DNA 02832  00660   0
101. 028 i CAN 02437  BBTV 02980 Innovative Systems   01898  Belgacom TV 02047  02132 Invitel 02437  Bell 01998 InviTV 02437  Bell Aliant 01998 Kaon 04409  Bell ExpressVu 01998 kbro 03139  Bell Fibe TV 01998 Kiss 02132  02271  Bluewin 02271 KPN 02952  02437  Bouygues Telecom 03007 Linksys 02271  British Telecom 02294 Lumos Networks 01998  BT 02294 Magio Sat 02132  BT Vision 02294 Magnet 01615  Cabovisao 02436 Meo 02401  Canal Digital 02030 MetroNet 01998                   En 89       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                 Telekom Deutschland   02132  TELUS 03028  T Home 02132  Thomson 03007  U verse 00858  Verizon 02378  Vodafone 02401  WNC 03118  Youview 02994  Zinwell 03139                   B SAT PVR Combination                                                                                                                                                       Minerva Networks 03118   Mitsubishi Electric 03274   MOD 03647   Motorola 01998  02437   02378  02952   00858  03916   01585  02030   02401   Movistar 01585   MTS 01998  01615   01481  01898   NTT 03237  03274   Numericable 02436   Oi TV 03452  03454   04165   Orange 02407   Pace 00858  01998   03454  02294   02401   Philips 02378   Portugal Telecom 02401   PrimeTel 02437   PT 02401   Qwerty 01898   Sagem 02407  03288   Sagemcom 02436  03007   02407   Samsung 02407   SaskTel 01998    Scientific Atlanta    
102. 037   10037  11667             Salora    Sampo    12197  12676   12239  12125   13067  10208  11755  10898   13419  10093   10171  10178   10650                                              Samsung    12051  10812   11632  10618   11458  11630   12953  10037   10556  10650   10178  10208   11150                                                    Sandstrom    12197  13047                   Sansui    13540  11670   13564  10037   10898  10171   10714  13559                                     Quelle 10037  10512   11037  10195   10668   Radiola 10037  10556   Radiomarelli 10037   Radionette 10714   RadioShack 10178  10037   Radiotone 10037  10668   11037   RCA 12746  12434   12932  11447   12247  13577   11781  10625   12187  13382   10679  13332   13717  10093   13793  12183   12855  13419   10000  10178   10618  11454   13426  13636   Realistic 10178   Recco 10898  13183   Reconnect 13183   Recor 10037   Rectiligne 10037   Red Star 10037   Reflex 10037  10668   11037   RefleXion 12239   Relisys 11585   Relon 11826   Remotec 10037  10093   10171  11150   Reoc 10714  12197   Revox 10037   RFT 10037   R Line 10037   Roadstar 11037  10037        10714  10668    Sanyo    11142  10208   11585  12676   12461  12994   10735  11974   12881  12769   13488  11498   11365  10508   11037  11150   11667  13861                      Sanyuan       10093                                gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Save 10037 Shinelco 12104  SBR 10037  10556 Shintoshi 100
103. 04  through 1 4 0  January 3  2010  are Copyright  c  2004  2006 2007 Glenn Randers   Pehrson  and are distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng 1 2 5 with the following individual added to  the list of Contributing Authors   Cosmin Truta  libpng versions 1 0 7  July 1  2000  through 1 2 5   October 3  2002  are Copyright  c  2000 2002 Glenn Randers Pehrson  and  are distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng 1 0 6 with the following individuals added to the list of  Contributing Authors   Simon Pierre Cadieux  Eric S  Raymond  Gilles Vollant  and with the following additions to the disclaimer   There is no warranty against interference with your enjoyment of the library or against infringement  There is no warranty that  our efforts or the library will fulfill any of your particular purposes or needs  This library is provided with all faults  and the entire  risk of satisfactory quality  performance  accuracy  and effort is with the user   libpng versions 0 97  January 1998  through 1 0 6  March 20  2000  are Copyright  c  1998  1999 Glenn Randers Pehrson  and  are distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng 0 96  with the following individuals added to the list of  Contributing Authors   Tom Lane  Glenn Randers Pehrson  Willem van Schaik  libpng versions 0 89  June 1996  through 0 96  May 1997  are Copyright  c  1996  1997 Andreas Dilger Distributed according to  the same disclaimer and license as libpn
104. 0625  12676  Topline 10668  11037  12414  10698  Toshiba 11508  11524   12239  11585  11656  13323   11667  10037  12676  12598   10714 10508  12724   Telefusion 10037 13570  11743   Telegazi 10037 10650  10618   Telemagic 10735 12108  11037   Telemeister 10037 10093  10195     11150  11169  Telesonic 10037 Tosonic 11508  Telest 10037  10556    estar TRANS continents 10037  10556   Teletech 10037  10668   11037 10668  11037  Transonic 10037  10698   Teleview 10037 10512  s   e 11037 ane Len  SE EH Trio 11498  11687  ae EE Triumph 10037  10556  A 11037  10037 PI LA   d 10556  10714 E E    i TVTEXT 95 10556  Tevion 10714  12426   10668  11037  Uher 10037  12125  10037  Ultravox 10037  10556  11498  UMC 12106  12426  11585  11667  Unic Line 10037  11687  12197  Uniden 12122  12676   12289 11667  ThemeScene 12796 United 10714  11037   Thomas 10625 10037  10556   Thomas America 10625 11523  11983   Thomson 10625  13047  12125  13434  12675  11447  Universal 10037  10714  10037 Universum 10037  11037   Thorn 10037  10512 10512  10668   Tiane 10093 10618  10195  TMK 10178 Univox 10037  TNCi 10017 V7 Videoseven 11755  Tokai 10037  10668  Vanguard 10037  44037 VD Tech 13067  13332                                                                               50       Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back              gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller                                              Watson 11037  10037   10668  10714   WeCube 11860   Wega 1
105. 11  00887   00856  01356                 gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Skylink 02957  01545  Sun Box 03571  02443  02928  Sun Direct 02525  01195  01197  Sunny 01300  ymaster 7  01611  02728  Supernova 0088  02932  01545  Supratech 01413  Skymax 01413 SES EE  Sk 00740  Sg S ZWO 03374  Skyplus 01334  02026   SkySat 01100 TBoston 02418  Skytec 02928 TDS Telecom 00775  Skyvision 02797  01334 Teac s 01322   SkyWay 02928 SE SC  Skyworth 01631  02835  uiis  02836 Technicolor 03469  03790  SL 00740  02026  Technika 01284  01672   00299  01672   02034  SM Electronic 01409 TechniSat 01197  01195   01100  01099   Smart 01631  01413   01351  03440   e 02813  01322  00740  00299 Technoit 02278  Sogo 02842 XU TE  Sonera 01780  01957 a  Technotrend 01429  01672   Sony 01558  00847  02263  ae Tech d 01284  02034  Spiderbox 03562 ee ion re E  Star 00887 i  Star Choi 00869 Tecsat 01986  aa TEKCOMM 02738  Starmax 02638  Steinner 02738 joue e  TELE Syst 02750  01611   Stream System 01300 enn                            Sencor 02813  Servimat 01611  Set One 03240  02728  Shark 01631  Sharp 01935  02034  Shaw Direct 00869  Sherwood 01409  Shinelco 02738  02278        02938       SKY PerfecTV  03099  02616   03049   Sky UK 01175  01662   00847   SkyCable 01631  01957   SkyLife 03321  01255             Strong       01409  02235   01626  02278   02418  02813   00879  03424   00853  01300   03374  01284   01682    01409  02739   03726  02813                Tele2 01195  01197  Tele
106. 12414  13183  Asberg 10037 Celebrity 10000  10178  10556 BGH 14070  14029   i i Astra 10037 10898  12414 cello 12673  12197 s      See e Atlantic 10037 Black Diamond 11037 Centurion 10037  Ape TT Atvio 13636 Blaupunkt 10195  12426 Changhong 13434  12769   EE Audiosonic 10714  12104  Blue Sky 10714  10037  e 10508   10668  11585  10037  13067  11037  10668          10171  11037  T1989 10556  10625 Ge 10810  i i Audio Technica 10000  10093  BlueDiamond 12426 Chimei 12769  11498  11687  EE EE    Audiovox 11769 bogo 12561 Chung Hsin 11150  Alba 12676  11037    Se RETTIG  10037  10668  Audioworld 10698 BPL 10208  10037 unyun  10714  11585  Auria 12087  12014 Brandt 10625  11585    Hoo  13005  13067  Autovox 12676 10714 sinema 10672  13790  11667  Aventura 10171 Brinkmann 10037  10668 Clarivox 10037  12104  12561 Axxon 10714 Brionvega 10037 Clatronic 10037  10714  Alfide 10672 Azuki 12239 Britania 12414 Clayton 11037  Alien 11037 B amp O 10620 BuBuGao 12098  11523 CME 10037  10512  Allstar 10037 Baier 12239 CMX 13332  13067  Baird 10208  En 66                   Connections    Initial Setup                               Coby 13478  12315   13627   Commercial Solutions   11447   Condor 10037   Conia 11498  11523   11687   Conrowa 10698   Contec 10037   Cosmel 10037   CPTEC 10625   Crosley 10000   Crown 10037  10714     10208  10672   11037  10668       Crown Mustang    10672  10898       Crypton    11667       Currys Essentials    12486       Curtis    12055  13577   12466  12352   1
107. 16  01255    Technology 03321   ibox 01652   IceCrypt 04197  02838   02928   ID Digital 01176   ID Sat 02289  01334   01631   i Joy 02938   Illusion 01631   Imagin 01195  01197   Imperial 01195  01197   01334  01429   01672   InDigital 01416   Indovision 01989  00856   01887  02108   00887  01255   INETBOX 01652  01237   Inno Hit 01626  02728   Innova 00099   Intv 04348   Inverto 03095   inVion 02418   iotronic 01413   IP Vision 02455   IPM 03567   IQ 02813   IQ Prism 02813   ISkyB 00887   ITT 02418        gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller   Jaeger 02797  01334 Logik 02034  01284   Jameson 02813 01906  02842   Jerrold 00869 01803  03652  Jiuzhou 03140 LogiSat 02797  02026   JVC 00775  01284 02813  02458  Kabel Deutschland 01195  01197  Lorenzen 00299   01672  01882  Lowry 02938   01915 Luxor 01935  02034  KabelBW 01882  01915  M vision 03562   01195  01197  M7 02631   01429 Macab 00853  KabelNoord 00253  02443 Magic TV 02982  Kamosonic 02738 Majestic 03012  02738   Kaon 01300  02231 02842  Kathrein 01561  02569  Manhattan 01300   00658  00173  Maplin 02034   03658  01416  Marusys 02799  03543   02263 Mascom 02738  EE E    Maspro 00173  03099  SONG Keri Sch Matsui E 00173   GT me  Maximum 01334  02813      01672  01986   Kreiling 00658  01626 Mediabox 00853  MESES LM 03351 MediaSat 00853  KT  L amp S Electronic 01334 Mediascape EE 02835   ogee an Mediaset 02750  02278   LaSAT 00740  00299 0142752220  Lava 01631 02739 i  EE E Medion 00299  00740   Leiker 02728
108. 2030   Dom ru TV 02493   Dream Satellite TV 02493   DSD 03340   DST 03389   Du 02401   DV 02979          Eagle Communications    01376  02187          EastLink    01376  00476    Google 03666  Gospell 04205  Grande 01877  03560   Communications 01376  Great Plains 01376    Communications  Guangdong Cable    02980  03131   03132                Guangxi Broadcasting    02897  03407   03961                   Guangxi Broadcasting  Network    02897  03407   03961       Guangzhou Cable    02945                CMBTV 03498   CNS 02980  02350   Cogeco 01376  01982   00476   Com Hem 00660  02447   02832  02015   Comcast 01982  01376   00476  01877   03560  02187   En 78    Echostar 02955  03452  Elion 03916  Entertain 02132  Entone 02302  03048  ER Telecom 02493  eTb 04281  Evolution 02479  02746        04079    Guizhou Broadcasting  Network  Hana TV       03946    02681  03442          Hawaiian Telcom    03028       HBC    01376  01877   01982  02979   03322  03340   03849             HCN 02979  03340  HD  03607  HDT 03465       Hebei Broadcasting    04026  03967       Hebei Broadcasting  Network    04026  03967                            Hebei Digital TV 04205   Hello TV 03322   HelloD 02979   Henan Cable 04034   Hickory Tech 01898  02302   Hikari TV 03237   Himawari TV 01760   Homecast 02977  02979   03389   Hong Kong Cable 01374    Hrvatski Telekom    02132             HSHONG 03965  03937   04026   Huashu 04034   Huawei 02994  03278   03937  01991   02913  04281   01982   Humax 0360
109. 213 ITT 31233  G HanzS 32213 Jamo 32358  Go Video 31044  30741 JDB 30730  GoGen 32139 JMB 32966  GoldStar 30741  30591 JVC 30623  31602   Goodmans 30713  30730  32365  32612        32966       32855  32966             60       Connections    Initial Setup       Kansas Technologies    31233      Playing Back                                                                                                                   Medion 30831  32966   30741  30630   Memorex 30831  32213   33153   Metz 30713  30571   Micromedia 30503  30539   Micromega 30539   Microsoft 31708  32083   32202  30522   Microstar 30831   Minax 30713   Minoka 30770          Mitsubishi Electric    31521  34004   30713                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Kendo 30713  30831   Kennex 30713  30770   Kenwood 30534  30490   KeyPlug 31643   Kiiro 30770   KingVision 31643   Kuppersbusch 32966   Leiker 30872   Lenco 30713  30770   Lenoxx 32213   Lexicon 32545   LG 30741  32811   31602  30591   31233   Lifetec 30831   Linetech 32966   Linsar 32966   LM 31643   Lodos 30719   Loewe 30741  30539   Logik 30713   Lumatron 30713  30741   Lunatron 30741   Luxman 30573   Luxor 32966  30713   Magnavox 30675  31354   30503  30539   30646  31506   33488  30713   Manhattan 30713   Marantz 30539  32481   32414  33444   Mark 30713   Marquant 307
110. 32   Panasonic 70303  70029    Philips 70157 SE EE  Pioneer 70032  Polk Audio 70157 ll Cassette Deck   Aiwa 40029             En 87       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           Onkyo 81993  82990   82351  82352   82353   Polk Audio 82228   B IPTV   ADB 02586  01585   01481  01998   02254  02302   02437  03028   Aland 02030  02437   Alands 02030  02437   Datakommunikation   Alcom 02030  02437   Altibox 02437  02030   Amino 01615  01898   01481  02482   01998  02302   03028   Arcadyan 02952   Arkwest 02482  01481   01998  02302   Arris 01998  02378   Arvig Communication   01998  02345   Systems   AT amp T 00858   AT amp T U verse 00858   ATMC 03028   B tv 02681  03442   BBTV 02980   BEK Communications   02254  02302   Belgacom TV 02047  02132   Bell 01998   Bell Aliant 01998   Bell ExpressVu 01998   Bell Fibe TV 01998   BesIV 04196   Bluewin 02271   Bouygues Telecom 03007   British Telecom 02294                      Arcam 40076  Audiolab 40029  40229  Carver 40029   Denon 40076  Epworth 40029  Grundig 40029  Harman Kardon 40029   Inkel 40070   JVC 40244  Kenwood 40070  Magnavox 40029  Marantz 40029  Myryad 40029   Onkyo 42157  Optimus 40027  Panasonic 40229   Philips 40029  4022
111. 3265   T Home 02132 00276  Visionetics 01374  Vivo 03288                         50                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             Connections Initial Setup  gt  Playing Back  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Vodafone 02401 E Satellite Set top Box Atevio 02928 Boxer 02443  01692   Volia 02493  sat 01300 Atlanta 02418  03320 01957  04024  Volia Cable 02493  Sky 01334 Atom 02289 Brainwave 00658  01672  Voo 02742 1 Sky 03538 Audiola 03012  02418 BSkyB 01175  01662   VTR 01376 Acoustic Solutions 01284 Audioline 01672 00847  wasu 04034 ADB 02553  00887  Aurora 00879 Bulltech 02738  Wave Broadband 01376  00476  01887 Austar 00879 Bush 01935  02376   Wavevision 01376  01877  Agora 01284 02957  03374  01672  03346   01982 Airis 02813  03012 01561  01631  03439  02034   Wbox 02832 Airtel 02248 02631 03652  01291   WEHCO Video 01376 Akai 02938 Auvisio 02932  02738  ie 02418   Welho 02832 Akira 02738 02813      WellAV 03479 Akta 01986 Avanit 00299  01631 Cablecom 01195  01197  Westman 01376  00476  Akura 01626 Awa 02418 Calway   02443  00253  Communications 02187 Alba 01284  02024  Axil 02418  01413  Canal Digitaal ucc EE  WideOpenWest 01376  01877  02568 01777  02738    
112. 37  Sceptre 13899  12528  Shivaki 12197  10178   12337 10037  Schaub Lorenz 10714  12676  Siam 10037  12125  12197  Siemens 10195  10037  11667  12289 Siera 10556  10037  Schneider 10037  10714  Silva 10037  E ciel Silva Schneider 12197  10037   10668  11585  12125  12676 SilverCrest 12676  11037  Schontech 11037 Sinudvne 10037  y  Scotch 10178 SKY 10037  Scott 10178  11983 Sky Brasil 10037  Sears 10171  10178 Skyworth 12899  12963   Seaway 10634 12889  12769   Seelver 10556  11037 10037  10698  SEG 12673  11037  SLX 10668  10037  10668   12125  11523   e 13067  10634  13434 Solavox 10037  Soniko 10037  SEI 10037 l  Seiki 13953  12964  Suik aaa  13559  10178 Sonitron   10208  Seiko Epson 11379 Sonneclair 10037  Sei Sinudyne 10037 BOOK 10057  Semp 11743  13793 Sonolor 10208  Semp Toshiba 11743  13793 Sontec ues  Sencor 13067  12197  one  uer  10744 Sony 12778  10810   Senzu 12493 or eius    11651  11551   Serie Dorada 10178 11625  11505   Serino 10093 11317  10150   Shanghai 10208 11150  10093   Sharp 12360  11659  11167  10818  10093  Soundesign 10178  12951  11393  Soundwave 10037  11037   12676  13867  12673  DE EE T   owa 18  5  Sheng Chia 10093  11150 Soyea 10698  11743          En 71       50       Connections       EESO         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                              Soyo 11826   Spectroniq 11498  11687   Squar
113. 3895  12397   13636  13382   14035                                              Curtis Mathes 10093   Cyberpix 11667   Daenyx 10672   Daewoo 10634  10037   10672  10556   12098  10178   11150  12125   Dansai 10037  10208   Dantax 11037  12670   10714  11667   Datsura 10208   DAWA 10037   Daytek 10672   Daytron 10037   De Graaf 10208   Decca 10037   Dell 11863   Denver 12197  13067   10037  12239   Desmet 10037            Playing Back           gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller             B Television  F to J                                                                                                                                                                                            F amp U 12676   FairTec 11585   Favi 13382   Fedders Lloyd 13639   Ferguson 10625  11037   13005  10037   12426  10195   11585  12676   Fidelity 10037  10512   10171   Finlandia 10208   Finlux 11667  12676   10714  10037   10556   Firstline 10714  10037   10668  11037   10208  10556   Fisher 11585  10208   Flint 10037   Fluid 12964  13907   Formenti 10037   Fortress 10093   Fraba 10037   Friac 10037   Frigidaire 11826   Fujimaro 11498  11687   Fujimaru 11687   Fujitsu 10809   Fujitsu Siemens 10809                   Funai    13817  10171   11394  10000   11037  10714   10668  11864                                                       Devant 12098   DGM 12239   Diamant 10037   Diamond 10698  10672   Dick Smith 10698   Electronics   Digatron 10037   Digihome 12676  11
114. 432  13005   12486  11037   10698  11585   11687   Logix 10668   Luma 10037  11037   Lumatron 10037  10668   Lumenio 10037   Lux May 10037   Luxor 12676  11037   10208   LXI 10178  10017   Madison 10037   MAG 11687  11498   Magnavox 13623  11866   12372  11454   11506  10171   11365  11755   11867   Magnum 10714  10037   Manesth 10037   Manhattan 10037  11037   10668   Marantz 10037  10556   11454   Mark 10037  10714   Marks  amp  Spencer 12673   Mascom 12197  12125   Masters 10037   Mastro 10698   Masuda 10037   Matsui 10037  10195   10208  12486   11037  10714   11667  12676   10556  12561   Matsushita 10650   Maxent 11755                   Mivar 10609   Moree 10037   Morgan s 10037   Moserbaer 11585   Motorola 10093   MTC 10512   MTlogic 10714  12104   Mudan 10208   Multitec 11037  10037   10668   Multitech 10037   Murphy 12673   Mx Onda 11983  11498   11687   Myryad 10556   Mystery 13047   NAD 10037  10178   Naiko 10037   Nakimura 10037   National 10208  10508   Naxa 12104  13382   NEC 11797  13257   12293  12461   11585  10037   10178  10508   10653  11150   Neckermann 10037  10556   NEI 10037  11037   Neoka 11826   Neon 12673   Netsat 10037   NetTV 11755   Neufunk 10037  10556   10714   Nevir 12676       En 69       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                     
115. 631  02813   02034  02738   Meo 02466   Mercury 03422   Micro 02797  02813   Micro electronic 02308   Miraclebox 02928   Motorola 00869   Movistar 02527   Multichoice 02059  02060   Mysat 02738   MySky Italia 02467   MySky New Zealand   01356  02211   NEOTION 01334   Nova 02475   NTV Plus 01307  01692        02443          Octagon 02928   Openbox 02928   Opensat 02957  02719   Opticum 02957  02797   02932   Orbitech 01195  01197   Orton 02957   Pace 01682  01175   02754  02475   02231  01356   02467  02631   02657  03790   01662  02097   02211  02059   02060  02466   02895   Panasonic 03099   Philips 01442  02466   00099  02631   Polsat 02527   Portugal Telecom 02466   PT 02466   Qwest 01377   Raduga TV 02957   RCA 01442   Rebox 02928   Ross 02540   SAB 04197   Sagem 01692  02553   01307   Sagemcom 03789  01692   Samsung 03063  01442   01682  01989   02467  01377   03266  01662   03784  03838   01693   Sansui 01545   Sat Control 01300   Schwaiger 02308  00740        02957                 gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  SEG 02034 TechniSat 01197  01195   Set One 03240 03440  Sharp 02034  01935 Technotrend 01429  Shaw Direct 00869 Techwood 02034  Siemens 01657 Telasat 02466  SilverCrest 02308  02932 Telefonica 01692  02527  Sky Austria 02754  02443 TeleSAT 02631  02466  Sky Brasil 01377 Telestar 02540  01195   Sky Deutschland 02754  02443   01197  Sky Ireland 01175  01662 TelkomVision 04310  Sky Italia 02467  01693 TelSKY 02540  Sky New Zealand 02211  01356
116. 667   Digiline 10037  10668   Digimate 12239   Digisonic 11826   Digitor 10698  10037   Digitrex 13067   Dikom 12561   diVision 12197  12239   Dixi 10037   DNS 13434   Domeos 10668   Donghai 10037  10668   11037   Drean 10037   DSE 10698   Dual 12197  11037   12676  11667   10037  11585   10714   Dumont 10017   Durabrand 10171  10178   10714  11037   Dux 10037   D Vision 12197  10037   10556   DX Antenna 13817   Dynatron 10037   Dynex 12049   ES 10037   Easy Living 12104   ECE 10037   ECG 12197  12125   Eiki 10735       Elbe 10037  10556   Electroband 10000   Electrograph 11755   Electrohome 11670   Electrolux 11585   Electron 12466  12855   Elektra 10017   Element 13559  11687   12183  12964   13907  11886   12256   Elfunk 11037   ELG 10037   Elin 10037   Elite 13867  10037   Emerson 11864  11394   10171  11886   10178  10037   13623  12183   10668  10714   13559   e motion 12426   Enox  12673   Envision 11589  11365   12087  12014   11506   Epson 11379   EQD 12014  12087   EQD Auria 12014  12087   Erisson 13193   Erres 10037   ESA 10812  10171   Essentials 12486   Euroman 10037   Europa 10037   Europhon 10037   Evesham Technology   11667   Evotel 12561   Excello 11037   Exquisit 10037          Funai United 12676  Furrion 13332  Gaba 11037  Galaxi 10037  Galaxis 10037  Gateway 11755             En 67       50       Connections       EESO         Playing Back                   GE 11447  10178   10735  10625   10093  11454  GEC 10037       General Electric    11447  10178   10
117. 7  02762     02043  02447   00660  01981   01983  02620   02832  03560   02165  02683   02701  02889   02715  02962   03051  03053   03075  03319   03849             Hunan Cable Net 04205  HYA 02989  Hyroad 02979          50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                  gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Mega 02683 Numericable 02436  Mega TV 02683  Megacable 01376  00476  SC 02404 Bl Cable Set Top Box  O to S           MetroCast Cablevision    01376  01982   00476                   Mi Connection    01877                      HyTV 02979  03340  Hyundai Digital 03465  Technology   HZRTV 02960  Il Cable 01374   i CAN 01585  02437  I Digital 03319  02979  IMBTVN 04106   INESA 03865  Innovative Systems 01898   Inotel 02437       Inter Mountain Cable    01877  02479   04079       Midcontinent  Communications    01376  00476   01982          Mid Hudson Cable    00476  01376          Minerva Networks    03118          MIO    02275  02802                                                                                                    Invitel 02437   InviTV 02437   iTSCOM 02703   ITV 02979  03389   04196  03498   J COM 01760  02703   03925  01782   02701  02700   02715  02752   03051  03053   Jambox 02030   JBC 02979  03322   03340  03849   JCN North 02703  01760   03474   Jerrold 00276  00476    Jiangsu Cable Network    04022                                                 KabelBW 02889  01981   01983   Ka
118. 70   Matsui 30713  32966   Maxim 30713  30872   MBO 30730   McIntosh 31273   MDS 30713   Mecotek 30770                Mizuda 30770   Mustek 30730   Muvid 31643   Mystral 30831   NAD 30741   Naiko 30770   NEC 30741  31602   Neom 31643   Nevir 30831  30770   New Acoustic 30741   Dimension   Nisato 31233   Noblex 31239   Norcent 30872   Nordmende 30831   Nortek 31643   OK  32966   OKI 32966   Omni 32139   One For All 92555   Onkyo 30627  32147   30503  31769   31612  30571   31634   Oppo 32545  30575   Optimus 30571   Orava 30713   Orbit 31643  30872                       gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Orion 30713  31233 RE BL 32555  Ormond 30713 REC 30490  Pacific 30831  30713 Red 32213  Packard Bell 30831 Red Star 30770  Palladium 30713 Richmond 31233  Panasonic 31641  30490  Roadstar 30713  30730  33641  31579  Ronin 30872  33580  33862  Rotel 30623  32710  32859  Rowa 30872  32523  30503 Saba 30551  31643   Philco 30675 32966  Philips 32056  30539  Saivod 30831  31354  32789  remm 32966  30741  30646  32434  Samsung 30199  30573   31506  32334  33195  32069  31340  30503  31635  32942   33488  30675  32369  32329   32084  30713 32489  31044   Pioneer 31571  30571  30490  32107  30631  31531  Sanyo 32966  30713   32442  32847  31233  Zeen TS 32054 ScanMagic 30730    Se 7     Schaub Lorenz 30770  31643  E Schneider 30539  30646   Polk Audio 30539 30831  30713  Portland   30770 Schontech 30713  Powerpoint 30872 Scott 31233  Presidian 30675 Seeltech 31643  
119. 735  10625   10093  11454                                                                                                                                                                                                                      GVA 12098  13067   Haier 12876  11749   12309  13382   11753  13620   13613  13429   10698  11983   12293  13790   13987  10037   10508   Hallmark 10178   Handic 12676   Hankook 10178   Hannspree 11826   Hanseatic 10037  10634   10714  10625   10556   Hantarex 12197  10037   Hantor 10037   Harwood 10037   Hauppauge 10037   Havermy 10093   HB 10714   HB Ingelen 10714   H Buster 13620  13419   HCM 10037   Heran 11826   Herosonic 11826   Highline 10037   Hikona 11983   Hinari 10037  10208   HiPlus 11826   Hisawa 10714   Hisense 12846  12098        13519  12183   10556  13123   10508  14029   10208  13382                                           Genesis 10037   Genexxa 10037   GFM 10171  11864   11886   Gibralter 10017   Gibson 11826   Gintai 11150   Godrej 11585   GoGen 12676  11585   Goldfunk 10668   GoldStar 10178  10037   10714  13183   11150   Goodmans 10037  11037   10634  11667   10668  11523   11585  11687   11983  10714   10556  10625   12426  12676   Gorenje 11585  12676   Gradiente 10037   Graetz 10714   Gran Prix 12197   Granada 10037  10208   Grandin 10037  10714   10668  11037   10556  12125   Grundig 10195  11223   12125  12239   10556  10037   11523  11667   13067  10672   12561  12676   Grunkel 11523   En 68                 gt 
120. 9  Pioneer 40027   Polk Audio 40029  Radiola 40029   RCA 40027   Revox 40029  Sansui 40029   Sony 40243  40170  Tascam 13095  Technics 40229  Thorens 40029  Universum 40029   Victor 40244   Wards 40027  40029  Yamaha 40097   B Receiver   Integra 52503   Onkyo 92503   Bl Audio   Accessory   Apple 81115   Jamo 02228  En 88                                                                                                     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  BT 02294 Guangxi 02897  BT Vision 02294 Broadcasting  Cabovisao 02436 Guangxi 02897  CalTel Connections   02586 Broadcasting  Canal Digital 02030 Network  Canby Telcom 01481  02302 Hana TV 02681  Celrun 03442 Hathw y 02043  CenturyLink 01998 Hikari TV 03237  Channel Master 03118 HSHONG 03937  China Telecom 04196  02913  Huawei 02994  03937   03937 02913  04281  China Unicom 04366  04196 CAN 02437  CHT 03647  01917 Innovative Systems   01898  Chunghwa 03647  01917 Inotel 02437  Cisco 00858  03028  Invitel 02437  02132  02345  InviTV 02437  02047  02378  ITV 04196  01998  02271  Jambox 02030  03452 JP PTT 01615  ClubInternet 02132 Kaon 04409  02682  CNS 02980 kbro 03139  Consolidated 01998  02302  Kiss 02132  02271  Communications 03048 KoolConnect 01481  Coship 04196 KPN 02952  02437  Deutsche Telekom 02132 Kreatel 02030  DNA 02030 KT 02683  Du 02401 LG 02682  Echostar 03452 LG U  02682  Elion 03916 Linksys 02271  Entertain 02132 Lumos Networks 01998  03028  Entone 02302  03048 Magio Sat 02132  eTb 04281 Magne
121. AMAGE     This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young  eay cryptsoft com   This product includes software written  by Tim Hudson  tjh cryptsoft com    Original SSLeay License  Copyright  C  1995 1998 Eric Young  eay cryptsoft com  All rights reserved   This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young  eay cryptsoft com    The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL   This library is free for commercial and non commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to  The following  conditions apply to all code found in this distribution  be it the RC4  RSA  Ihash  DES  etc   code  not just the SSL code  The  SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson   tjh cryptsoft com    Copyright remains Eric Young s  and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed   If this package is used in a product  Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used   This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation  online or textual  provided with the  package   Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer   Redistributions in binary form must repro
122. ARE DISCLAIMED  INNO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT  NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR  BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT  LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     14  zlib   zlib h    interface of the  zlib  general purpose compression library version 1 1 4  March 11th  2002   Copyright  C  1995 2002 Jean loup Gailly and Mark Adler   This software is provided    as is     without any express or implied warranty  In no event will the authors be held liable for any  damages arising from the use of this software    Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose  including commercial applications  and to alter it and  redistribute it freely  subject to the following restrictions    The origin of this software must not be misrepresented  you must not claim that you wrote the original  software  If you use this software in a product  an acknowledgment in the product documentation would be appreciated but is not  required    Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such  and must not be misrepresented as being the original software   This notice may not be removed or altered from any source dis
123. Australian and Asian models  or Direct     AccuEQ Room Calibration  Enable or disable the   settings made by automatic speaker setting  To enable   them  you should normally select  On  All Ch    and to   disable just the front speakers  you should select  On    ex  L R    The setting can be separately set to each   input selector    e This setting cannot be selected if the automatic  speaker setting has not been performed    e  t cannot be set if headphones are connected or the  listening mode is Pure Audio  European  Australian  and Asian models  or Direct     Equalizer  Assign the equalizer settings adjusted in   Setup   2  Speaker   Equalizer Settings  to  Preset1  to   Preset3   The same sound field setting is applied to all    En 19    50           Connections   Initial Setup    ranges when set to  Off    e  t cannot be set if the listening mode is Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models  or Direct     Music Optimizer  Improve the quality of the  compressed audio  Playback sound of lossy  compressed files such as MP3 will be improved  The  setting can be separately set to each input selector    e The setting is effective in the signals of 48 kHz or  less  The setting is not effective in the bitstream  signals    It cannot be set if the listening mode is Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models  or Direct     Late Night  Make small sounds to be easily heard  It  is useful when you need to reduce the volume while  watching a movie late night  You can 
124. Blue   pc W UJ LS  category of the component  Operation may be incorrect or 42  Number 1 to 9  0   10      6  C Gite e impossible depending on the product    CLR  DISPLAY   6  PLAYLIST  5 J me   Not CEC compatible   e IAL  gt  Oe  HOME lee     REMOTE MODE INPUT SELECTOR             7  a  Game  GE  raw gor   ec      EN wv AS l i   n DiS S   S      GUIDE                as     lt   gt   ENTER  sco   omg  D HOME  A FR    PREV CH    i E      9 RETURN CO ES  _      REMOTE MODE       OSOURCE   3  MUTING   4  CH      DISC     En 48             Connections Initial Setup Playing Back prchifclniesciel Wretpitte   gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller                                                                                                                                                                                               VCR PVR ration d a Bo zm d       LJ tJ LJ  binis NA at B dQ      2 E  amp     Den pen 3    Press the REMOTE MODE button programmed with   em   e au 9 cube j C  the remote control code for the relevant AV component C CO C9 C9     are ES  to switch the remote controller mode to that for the AV   SR eo  3    OX  9   component  Then  operate by using the corresponding      oe   EU  buttons  Available buttons vary depending on the product D EE            D Ss S  category of the component  Operation may be incorrect or    7   9     Geff  impossible depending on the product    NO  sj   e D 6  GUIDE  J MOD NEM uc    sA     lt     gt   ENTER  SOURCE D
125. Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed              En 20          Connections Initial Setup       Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller                                                                      Input Format Listening Mode Input Format Listening Mode  DTS HD HR Direct DTS ES Direct  Mono Mono  DTS HD HR       DTS    Dolby Surround ES Matrix     Neo 6 Cinema   ES Discrete    DTS Neural X Dolby Surround    TV Logic   DTS Neural X  AllCh Stereo    TV Logic    Full Mono   AllCh Stereo     T D Full Mono    1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch  T D       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed            1 Can only be selected when the back speakers are not installed      Back speakers need to be installed     3 Height speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed      3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be                                                       installed     Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be
126. D ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY  WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE    9  ntp  This file is automatically generated from html copyright html  Copyright Notice  jpg  Clone me   says Dolly sheepishly  Last update  20 31 UTC Saturday  January 06  2007  The following copyright notice applies to all files collectively called the Network Time Protocol Version 4 Distribution  Unless  specifically declared otherwise in an individual file  this notice applies as if the text was explicitly included in the file   Copyright  c  David L  Mills 1992 2007  Permission to use  copy  modify  and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose with or without fee is hereby  granted  provided that the above copyright notice appears in all copies and that both the copyright notice and this permission  notice appear in supporting documentation  and that the name University of Delaware not be used in advertising or publicity  pertaining to distribution of the software without specific  written prior permission  The University of Delaware makes no  representations about the suitability this software for any purpose  It is provided  as is  without express or implied warranty   The following individuals contributed in part to the Network Time Protocol Distribution Version 4 and are acknowledged as  authors of this work     nn               
127. D recorder  Presetting an AM FM Radio Station 2 Remote Controller Buttons 15 operation 48  Using RDS  European  Australian and Asian models  3 Icons Displayed during Playback 15 VCR PVR operation 49  Playing Music Files on a USB Storage Device 4 Using the Listening Modes 16 p eeler Cable receiver operation 2  isteni i Selecting Listening Mode 16 payer apte  namng ee RANO   Listeni   M e 16 Cassette tape deck operation 90  About Internet Radio 5 istening Mode Types      Tuneln Radio 5 Selectable Listening Modes 19 To operate CEC compatible components 50  Pandora     Getting Started  U S   Australia and Checking the Input Format 28 Advanced speaker connections 51  New Zealand only  6 A Advanced Settings  Setup Menu  29 Connecting Bi amp Speakers 51  Spotify 7 How to Set 29 Connecting and Operating Onkyo RI Components 52  SiriusXM Internet Radio  North American only  T 1  Input Output Assign 30 About RI Function 52  Slacker Personal Radio  North American only  8 2  Speaker dz RI Connection and Setting 52  Registering Other Internet Radios 9 3  Audio Adjust 36 iPod   iPhone   Operation E  Playing Music with DLNA 11 4  Source J  Firmware Update 54  About DLNA 11 5  Listening Mode Preset 38 About Firmware Update 54  Configuring the Windows Media   Player 11 6  Hardware 39 Updating the Firmware via Network 54  DLNA Playback 11 7  Remote Controller 45 Updating the Firmware via USB 55  Controlling Remote Playback from a PC 12 8  Miscellaneous 45 Troubleshooting 57  Playing Music Files
128. DIGITAL IN jack to the PC button    GAME     j      COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired DIGITAL IN jack to the GAME button    AUX    The setting cannot be changed    CD OPTICAL 1  COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired DIGITAL IN jack to the CD button    PHONO          COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired DIGITAL IN jack to the PHONO button    TV OPTICAL 2  COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a       desired DIGITAL IN jack to the TV button        e Sampling rates for PCM signals  stereo  mono  from a digital input are 32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   88 2 kHz  96 kHz 16 bit  20 bit  and 24 bit     En 32     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       2  Speaker    Allows you to change the speaker configuration such as presence or not of subwoofer   crossover frequency  and so on  Settings are automatically configured if you use the   Automatic Speaker Setup   This setting cannot be selected if headphones are connected or audio is output from the    speakers of the TV     Configuration    You can change the number of speaker channels connected  the type of front speaker  connection  the height speaker type  and other speaker settings        Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Speaker Channels    7 1 ch    Select  2 1 ch    3 1 ch    4 1 ch    5 1 ch    6 1 ch     7 1 ch    2 1 2 ch    3 1 2 ch    4 1 2 ch   or    5 1 2 ch  to suit the number of speaker channels  connected        Subwoofer    
129. DMI 2  HDCP  2 2      HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2   to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the BD DVD button  If  you do not assign a jack  select          To select  an HDMI IN jack already assigned to another  input selector  change its setting to         first      HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2   to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the CBL SAT button  If  you do not assign a jack  select          To select  an HDMI IN jack already assigned to another  input selector  change its setting to         first           OSD Language    English    Select the on screen display language    Select from English  German  French  Spanish   Italian  Dutch  Swedish  Russian  European   Australian and Asian models   or Chinese   European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian  models      STRM BOX    HDMI 3  HDCP  2 2      HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2   to  HDMI 7   Assign a  desired HDMI IN jack to the STRM BOX button   If you do not assign a jack  select          To select  an HDMI IN jack already assigned to another  input selector  change its setting to         first           Impose OSD    Set whether or not to display the information on  the TV when the volume is adjusted or input is  changed  for example     On   OSD will be displayed on the TV     Off   OSD will not be displayed on the TV    e  he OSD may not be displayed depending  on the input signal even if  On  is selected  If  the operation screen is not displayed  change  the resolution of the connected device     PC    HDMI 4     HDMI 1  HDCP 2 2  
130. ED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF  THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS   EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN  ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES    END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS   How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs   If you develop a new program  and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public  the best way to achieve this is to  make it free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms    To do so  attach the following notices to the program  It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively  convey the exclusion of warranty  and each file should have at least the  copyright  line and a pointer to where the full notice   is found      one line to give the program s name and an idea of what it does      Copyright  C    year     name of author     This program is free software  you can redistribute it and or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as  published by the Free Software Foundation  either version 2 of the License  or  at your option  any later version    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful  but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY  without even the implied warranty  of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  See the GNU General Public License for more details   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this program  if not  write to the Free Software  Foundation  Inc   59
131. ENT   MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  PURPOSE    Company makes no representation or warranty of any kind  express  or implied  about the completeness  accuracy  validity  legality   reliability  suitability or availability with respect to the information   content or services available through this device  Company shall not  be liable  whether in contract or tort  including negligence and strict  liability  for any direct  indirect  special  incidental or consequential  damages or any other damages arising out of  or in connection with   any information contained in  or as a result of the use of any content  or service by you or any third party  even if Company has been  advised of the possibility of such damages  nor shall Company be  liable for any third party claims against users of this device or any    third party    In no event shall Company be responsible nor liable for  without limiting the  generality of the foregoing  any interruption or suspension of any information   content or service available through this device  Company is neither  responsible nor liable for customer service related to the information  content  and services available through this device  Any question or request for service  relating to the information  content or services should be made directly to the  appropriate content owners and services providers              Connections   Initial Setup   Playing Back   Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller    
132. ENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF  USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY  WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     22  CURL   http   curl haxx se   COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE   Copyright  c  1996   2011  Daniel Stenberg   lt daniel haxx se gt   All rights reserved    Permission to use  copy  modify  and distribute this software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby granted  provided that  the above copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies    THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  AS IS   WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND  NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS   BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM  DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY  WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT  TORT OR  OTHERWISE  ARISING FROM  OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS  IN THE SOFTWARE    Except as contained in this notice  the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the  sale  use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of t
133. F THIS CODE PROJECT OPEN LICENSE    LICENSE    THE WORK IS PROTECTED BY COPYRIGHT AND OR OTHER APPLICABLE LAW  ANY USE OF THE WORK  OTHER THAN AS AUTHORIZED UNDER THIS LICENSE OR COPYRIGHT LAW IS PROHIBITED    BY EXERCISING ANY RIGHTS TO THE WORK PROVIDED HEREIN  YOU ACCEPT AND AGREE TO BE BOUND BY THE  TERMS OF THIS LICENSE  THE AUTHOR GRANTS YOU THE RIGHTS CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONSIDERATION OF  YOUR ACCEPTANCE OF SUCH TERMS AND CONDITIONS  IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO ACCEPT AND BE BOUND BY THE  TERMS OF THIS LICENSE  YOU CANNOT MAKE ANY USE OF THE WORK     Definitions    a   Articles  means  collectively  all articles written by Author which describes how the Source Code and  Executable Files for the Work may be used by a user    b   Author  means the individual or entity that offers the Work under the terms of this License    C   Derivative Work  means a work based upon the Work or upon the Work and other pre existing works    d   Executable Files  refer to the executables  binary files  configuration and any required data files included  in the Work    e   Publisher  means the provider of the website  magazine  CD ROM  DVD or other medium from or by  which the Work is obtained by You    f   Source Code  refers to the collection of source code and configuration files used to create the Executable  Files    g   Standard Version  refers to such a Work if it has not been modified  or has been modified in accordance  with the consent of the Author  such consent being in the full dis
134. FC 1119   18 John Hay  lt jhay icomtek csir co za gt  IPv6 support and testing    19 Glenn Hollinger  lt glenn herald usask ca gt  GOES clock driver    20 Mike Iglesias  lt iglesias uci edu gt  DEC Alpha port    21 Jim Jagielski  lt jim jagubox gsfc nasa gov gt  A UX port    22 Jeff Johnson  lt jbj chatham usdesign com gt  massive prototyping overhaul    23 Hans Lambermont  lt Hans Lambermont nl origin it com gt  or  24  lt H Lambermont chello nl gt  ntpsweep   25 Poul Henning Kamp  lt phk FreeBSD ORG gt  Oncore driver  Original author     26 Frank Kardel  27   kardel  at  ntp  dot  org   PARSE   GENERIC  driver   gt 14 reference clocks   STREAMS modules for  PARSE  support scripts  syslog cleanup  dynamic interface handling    28 William L  Jones  lt jones hermes chpc utexas edu gt  RS 6000 AIX modifications  HPUX modifications   29 Dave Katz  lt dkatz cisco com gt  RS 6000 AIX port    30 Craig Leres  lt leres ee Ibl gov gt  4 4BSD port  ppsclock  MagnavoxGPS clock driver    31 George Lindholm  lt lindholm ucs ubc ca gt  SunOS 5 1 port    32 Louis A  Mamakos  lt louie ni umd edu gt  MD5 based authentication    33 Lars H  Mathiesen  lt thorinn diku dk gt  adaptation of foundation code for Version 3 as specified in RFC 1305   34 Danny Mayer  lt mayer ntp org gt Network I O  Windows Port  Code Maintenance    35 David L  Mills  lt mills udel edu gt  Version 4 foundation  clock discipline  authentication  precision kernel  clock drivers   Spectracom  Austron  Arbiter  Heath  ATOM
135. FROM  OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS  IN THE SOFTWARE    Except as contained in this notice  the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the  sale  use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder     4  libFLAC   Copyright  C  2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 Josh Coalson   Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer      Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution      Neither the name of the Xiph org Foundation nor the names of itsy be us contributors may be used to  endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS AND ANY EXPRESS   OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDIN
136. Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  Hitachi 11643  12676  IRT 10698  11576  11585  Isis 12676  11037  11691  Isukai 10037  eer Wee iSymphony 13429  13382   13118  10037  10679   eee   ios 12125  10150  10178       10508  11150 12676  10208          i 11523  Hitachi F 10150  T ae 10698 ITT Nokia 10208  Hiteker 13118 Ge 10037  Hoher 10714  13434 eee  Hongmei 10093 Jay tech 13067  Hornyphon 10037  e TT   A  Hua Tun 11150 ee E  Hypson 10037  10714     10556  10668  Jinfeng 10208  11037 Jinxing 10556  10037   Hyundai 10698  12414  10698  12676  11037  JMB 12676  10634   11523 10556  12426  Iberia 10037 JIC 13067  ICE 10037 Jubilee 10556  TES 11394 IVC 11774  11653   Ee ek m  E E 12271  11428   EE IS 13650  11670   Ingo Devices 12239 12676  14070   Inno Hit 11585  11037 10650  10093   Innova 10037 10508  Insignia 12049  11423   10171 o  Integra 11807  13100  D EEN  K to N   13500 Kaisul 10037  Inteq 10017 Karcher 12125  10714  Interbuy 10037 Kathrein 10556  Interfunk 10037  10512 KDS 11498  11687  Intemal 10556 Kendo 11037  11585   Intervision 10037   Mos 10037  Irradio 10037 SS                   50       Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back              gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel     gt Remote Controller                                                 Mitsubishi Electric    11250  12313   10150  10178   10512  11797   10093  10556   10037  11150   11037  11171                                                                                          
137. G  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF  USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY  WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     5  libjpeg   The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation  either express or implied  with respect to this software  its quality   accuracy  merchantability  or fitness for a particular purpose  This software is provided  AS IS   and you its user  assume the  entire risk as to its quality and accuracy    This software is copyright  C  1991 1998  Thomas G  Lane    All Rights Reserved except as specified below    Permission is hereby granted to use  copy  modify  and distribute this software  or portions thereof  for any purpose  without fee   subject to these conditions    If any part of the source code for this software is distributed  then this README file must be included  with this copyright   and no warranty notice unaltered  and any additions  deletions  or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in  accompanying documentation    If only executable code is distributed  then the accompanying documentation must state that  this software is based in part on the  work of the Independent JPEG Group     Permission for use of this software is granted only if the user accepts full responsibility for any 
138. I   m   new to Pandora  and then press ENTER   If you are new to Pandora select  I   m new to Pandora    You will see an activation code on your TV screen   Please write down this code  Go to an Internet  connected computer and point your browser to www   pandora com onkyo  Enter your activation code and then  follow the instructions to create your Pandora account  and your personalized Pandora stations  You can create  your stations by entering your favorite tracks and artists  when prompted  After you have created your account  and stations you can return to your Onkyo receiver and  press ENTER to begin listening to your personalized  Pandora   If you have an existing Pandora account  you can  add your Pandora account to your Onkyo receiver by  selecting    have a Pandora Account  and logging in with  your email and password    e  f you want to use multiple user accounts  see  Using   Multiple Accounts   Login can be made from the   Users  screen     4  To play a station  use A V to select the station from your  station list  and then press ENTER  Playback starts and  the playback screen appears     E Create a New Station    Enter the name of a track  artist  or genre and Pandora will  create a unique radio station for you based on the musical  qualities of that track  artist  or genre     l like this track  Give a track  thumbs up  and Pandora  will play more music like it       don t like this track  Give a track  thumbs down  and  Pandora will ban that track from the cur
139. ND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING  DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION   This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may   be distributed under the terms of this General Public License  The  Program   below  refers to any such program or work    and a  work based on the Program  means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law  that is to say  a  work containing the Program or a portion of it  either verbatim or with modifications and or translated into another language    Hereinafter  translation is included without limitation in the term  modification    Each licensee is addressed as  you     Activities other than copying  distribution and modification are not covered by this License  they are outside its scope  The   act of running the Program is not restricted  and the output from the Program is covered only if its contents constitute a work  based on the Program  independent of having been made by running the Program   Whether that is true depends on what the  Program does    You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program s source code as you receive it  in any  medium  provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer  of warranty  keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty  and give any other recipients  of the Program a copy of this License along with the Program    Yo
140. NTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY  WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     20  Tremor   http   wiki xiph org index php Tremor      Playing Back      Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel    Copyright  c  2002  Xiph org Foundation   Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer      Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution      Neither the name of the Xiph org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS   OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO
141. Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller    GNU License    Important Notice Regarding Software  The software package installed in this product includes software licensed to Onkyo Corporation  hereinafter  called  Onkyo    directly or indirectly by third party developers  Please be sure to read this notice regarding such software     Notice Regarding GNU GPL LGPL applicable Software   This product includes the following software that is covered by GNU General Public License  hereinafter  called  GPL   or by  GNU Lesser General Public License  hereinafter  called  LGPL      Onkyo notifies you that  according to the attached GPL LGPL  you have right to obtain  modify  and redistribute software source  code for the listed software     Package List    linux uClibc busybox  libgcc libstdc   libmms  compat wireless wpa_supplicant dnsmasq  libiconv bluez dbus  iperf faad       GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE   Version 2 1  February 1999   Copyright  C  1991  1999 Free Software Foundation  Inc  59 Temple Place  Suite 330  Boston  MA 02111 1307 USA Everyone  is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document  but changing it is not allowed     This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL  It also counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License  version  2  hence the version number 2 1      Preamble   The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it  By contrast  the GNU General  Public Licenses 
142. Playing Back    Connections       Speaker layout                   Important  The power cord must be connected only after all other connections are    completed     Q O Front speakers     Center speaker        Surround speakers  Q Subwoofer  D Back speakers   9  Height speakers  Front High      d  Height speakers  Rear High   e 5 1 ch  909000  e 7 1 ch  90909Q 790 or  000000 9 or  000006  1    8 speakers   910 speakers and  M speakers share the same speaker  terminals  Select either of the groups     To enjoy the Dolby Atmos listening  mode  height speakers or back  speakers need to be installed  There  are a variety of height speakers apart  from this type  see the next section  for details    To use the multi zone function  see   Multi zone  in  Step 3  Playing  Back          Advanced Manual    Characteristics of speaker types  QO output front stereo sound and     output center sound such as dialogs and  vocals  OG create back sound field     reproduces bass sounds and creates rich  sound field    Connecting  2 8 speakers   910 speakers  or 1002 speakers enables playback in 7 1  ch configuration         back  speakers  improve sense of envelopment created by  back sound field as well as seamlessness  of back sounds  providing more natural  sound experiences in the sound field    d or M  height  speakers produce  surround effects on a height plane  This  unit can perform optimal sound field  processing for the type of height speakers  actually installed and registered in  In
143. Prinz 30831 SEG 30713  30872  Prism 30831 Semp 30503  Pro Vision 30730 Semp Toshiba 30503  ProLine 31643  32966 Sharp 32250  30630  Proscan 30522 32966  30675   Proson 30713 33313  30713  Prosonic 32966 Sherwood 30741  30770   Pye 30539  30646  32820  33837  30675 Shinsonic 30533  Radionette 30741 Sigmatek 32139  Radiotone 30713 Silva Schneider 30831  30741  RCA 30522  32213  SilverCrest 31643  30571  31769  Skantic 30713  30539  32532 Skymaster 30730          En 75       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                               Teletech 30713   Tensai 30770   Theta Digital 30571   Thomson 30551  30522   30831   Thule Audio 30551   Tokai 31233   Tosaki 32006   Toshiba 30503  33157     33857  32006   32277  32705   31769  32966   32551                   TRANS continents    30831  30872   31233                                                                                                                                                                                              Transonic 30730   Trent 31643   Trevi 30831   TruTech 30675   TVE 30713   United 30713  30675   30730  31233   31643   Universum 30713  30741   30591   Urban Concepts 30503   Venturer 31769   Vestel 30713   Vitek 30831   VIZIO 32563   Voxson 30730  30831   Waitec 30730  31233   Walker 32966   Waltham 30713   WB Electronics 32555   Welkin 30831   Wellington 30713   Weltstar 30713   Wharfedale 30713   Wilson 31233  30831   
144. Program into other free programs whose distribution conditions are different  write to the  author to ask for permission  For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation  write to the Free Software  Foundation  we sometimes make exceptions for this  Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of  all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally    NO WARRANTY   BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE  THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM  TO   THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW  EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT  HOLDERS AND OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM  AS IS  WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EITHER  EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY   AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE  PROGRAM IS WITH YOU  SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE  YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY  SERVICING  REPAIR OR CORRECTION    IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER   OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE  BE  LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES  INCLUDING ANY GENERAL  SPECIAL  INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM  INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA  OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAIN
145. Radio  To play  select the program from  My  Presets      Remove from My Presets  Deletes a radio station or  program from your  My Presets  within Tuneln Radio     Report a problem  Reports a problem or interactively  solves a problem related to Tuneln Radio     View Schedule  Displays the radio station or program  schedule     Clear recents  Clears all radio stations and programs  from the  Recents  within Tuneln Radio   This menu is  displayed only when a radio station or program inside  the  Recents  is being played      Add to My Favorites  Registers the radio station  or program being broadcast in  My Favorites    My  Favorites  are displayed in the level under the one  displayed when you press NET  To play  select the  program from  My Favorites      E Regarding the Tuneln Radio Account    Creating an account on the Tuneln Radio website   tunein com  and logging in it from the unit allows you to  automatically add radio stations and programs to your  My  Presets  on the unit as you save them on the website   My  Presets  are displayed in the level under Tuneln Radio    To display a radio station registered in  My Presets   you  must log into Tuneln Radio from the unit  To log in  select   Login       have a Tuneln account  in the  Tuneln Radio   top list on the unit  and then enter your user name and  password    e  f you associate the device on My Page within the  Tuneln Radio website using the registration code  obtained by selecting  Login     Login with a registrat
146. S  o  3  E    I   I   I  at       zm  m  8  EI  m     o       m  1  I  i   I  1  I  l  I  l  I  i   1                         x The RECEIVER and ZONE2 buttons cannot be programmed     En 46       Operating Other Components with the Remote Controller          Programming Remote Control Codes e Program a remote control code in accordance  Si eS SO CU with the input since each button also works as the   TUM input selector   For example  when the CD player  EECH l l is connected to the CD jack  program the remote  You can search a remote control code and register it to a control code for the CD player to CD   desired REMOTE MODE button in the unit s Setup menu  e If the component cannot be operated  select  Try  1  After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller  Next Code  with the cursors and press ENTER to   press SETUP  display another code    200                C 00 2            REMOTE MODE    ee   5C             CN  CN  Mew JS kat  CAN ZS  S Ico                            2  With the cursors  select  7  Remote Controller      Remote Mode  and press ENTER     3  With the cursors  select the REMOTE MODE button  for which you want to register a remote control code  and press ENTER to display the subcategory selection  Screen     4  With the cursors  select the target subcategory  and then  press ENTER to display the brand name input screen     5  Select a character with the cursors and press ENTER   Repeat it to enter the first three characters of the brand  name     6  Selec
147. SETUP    2  With the cursors  select  2  Speaker      Configuration     Bi Amp     3  Select  Yes  with the cursors     En 51                Connections    Initial Setup       Connecting and Operating    Onkyo RI Components    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller                       About RI Function    Connecting an Onkyo component with RI jack such as  the separately sold RI Dock to the unit by using an RI  cable and an analog audio cable enables the following RI  functions     System On   Auto Power On  Starting playback on a  component connected via RI when the unit is on standby  mode  automatically turns on the unit to select the relevant  component as its input source     Direct Change  When playback is started on a component  connected via RI  the unit selects that component as the  input source     Remote Controller Operation  Allows you to operate  Rl compatible Onkyo components using the AV receiver s  remote controller  Point the remote controller at remote  control sensor of the unit  This operation is possible only  when the RI remote control code is programmed     e Some components may not support all RI functions    e These functions do not work when Zone 2 is turned on    e For information on the RI functions  also refer to each  component s instruction manual     En 52    Connect an Onkyo component with RI jack to this unit using  an RI cable and an analog audio cable  For details  refer   to the instruction manual of the c
148. Sogetel 01998  02482   Sonaecom 02437   Sonera 00660   Source Cable 01376  00476   Starcat 02703  01782        gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  StarHub 01927  00276 Thomson 01582  01981   Stipte 01898 01982  01983   Stofa 02015 03007  02407  Suddenlink 01877  01376  T Hrvatski Telekom 02132  01982  03560  Tianjin Broadcast  amp    04010  00476 TV Network  Supercable 00276 Tianjin Broadcasting   04010   Supercand       01376 00476     Time Warner 01877  01376   Suwon Cable 03319 00476  02187  Suzhou Cable Network   04022 TiVo 03560  03265  SVA 03865 ToongTV 03322  Swisscom 02271 Top 03766  SXBCTV 03965 TopTV 01994  TP 02407  E Cable Set Top Box  T to Z  Trans PX 00276  TalkTalk 02994 True Visions 03075  02762  Tbaytel 03028 TVB 01615  Tbroad 03319 TVS Cable 013706  01877   TCC 04409  04408 01982  TCN 03340  02703 Ut 02682  T Com 02132 U  tvG 02682  TDC 02271 UCATV 02703  01760  TDS Telecom 03028 Unitymedia 02955  02610   Technicolor 01982  02994  03451  03477  03288 UPC 01582  03451   TechniSat 03316 03477  00660   Tele2 00660  02447 01060  Telecentro 00476  01376 UPC Cablecom 01582  03451   TeleColumbus 02889 03477  Telefonica 01585  03028  US Electronics 00276  03288  02586 U verse 00858  Telekom Deutschland   02132 Vector 02030  Telenet 01920  03451  VeeTV 03231  03477 Verizon 02378  Telewest 01987 Viasat 02030  Telia 02030 Videotron 01877  02947  Telmex 01376 Viken Fibernett 02030  02437  TELUS 03028 Virgin Media 01987  02563   TFN 03127  03139 01060  0
149. Source Last Valid Set the listening mode for playing Dolby Digital  and other digital signals recorded in 2 channels    Dolby D Dolby D   Last Valid Set the listening mode for playing Dolby Digital     TrueHD          Dolby Digital Plus and Dolby TrueHD signals        En 38    Available listening modes vary depending on the input signal   Setting  Last Valid  will always select the last selected mode   Only  Analog  can be set to the  TUNER  input     Digital  and  TrueHD  can be set to the  NET  input    Only  Digital  can be set to the  BLUETOOTH  input              Connections       Initial Setup    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          Default Value    Setting Details          6  Hardware HDMI   Tuner Setting Item  HDMI CEC  RIHD    Setting Item Default Value Setting Details       AM FM Frequency 10kHz 0 2MHz Select a frequency step depending on your   Step  North American area of residence    and Taiwanese Select  10kHz 0 2MHzZ  or  9kHz 0 05MHZz     models  e When this setting is changed  all radio  presets are deleted    AM Frequency 9kHz Select a frequency step depending on your    Step  European   Australian and Asian  models           area of residence    Select  10kHz  or  9kHz     e When this setting is changed  all radio  presets are deleted           Off       Setting to  On  enables the input selection link  and other link functions with HDMI connected  CEC compliant device     On   Use this function    Off   Do not us
150. Symphonic 30675  Technica 30713  Technical 32966  Techwood 32966  Telefunken 32966  Teletech 30713  Thomson 30551  Toshiba 32966  United 30713  Universum 30713  Walker 32966  Waltham 30713  Weltstar 30713  Xiron 30713  BH DVD   3D LAB 30539  Accurian 30675             Acoustic Solutions    30730  30713                      Westwood 11585   Wharfedale 11983  11667   10037  10556   White Westinghouse   10037   Wilson 10556   Windsor 11037  10668   Windy Sam 10556   Wintel 10714   Wyse 11365   Xenius 11667  10634   11585  12676   Xiahua 11753  10037   11749  12461   10698   Xiron 11983  11037   XLogic 10698   Xoceco 11753  10037   11749  12461   10698   Xogego 11753  10037   11749  12461   10698   Xoro 13067   Xpeer 12051   XRYPTON 10037   Yamaha 11576  10650   Yamishi 10037   Yokan 10037   Yoko 10037   YU MA TU 10037          Akai 32966  Alba 32966  Black Diamond 30713  Blue Sky 30713  Bush 30713  32966  Celcus 32966  Centrum 30713  Crown 30713  Dantax 32966  Digihome 32966  Dual 32966  30713  Elfunk 30713  Emerson 30675  Ferguson 30713  32966  Finlux 32966  Funai 30675  Goodmans 30713  32966  Grandin 30713  Grundig 30539  32966  Hitachi 32966  30713  Hyundai 32966  Insignia 32095  JMB 32966  JVC 32966  Kuppersbusch 32966  Linetech 32966  Linsar 32966  Logik 30713  Luxor 32966  30713  Matsui 30713  32966  Medion 32966       AEG    30675  31643   30770  31233          Aitro       32095       En 73       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back               
151. T U verse 00858 Cablecom Mexico 00476  01376  Atlantic Broadband 01877  01376 Cablemas 01376  01877  ATMC 01376  01982  Cablevision 01877  01376   03028 03336  00476  Austar 00276 Cabovisao 02436  02493  B tv 02681  03442 Caiway 02015  03607   Baja Broadband 00476  01376 02762  00660   BBTV 02980 02447  Beijing 04010 Caiyun Digital 03961  Belgacom TV 02047  02132 CalTel Connections 02254  02586  Bell 01998 Canal Digital 02030  Bell Aliant 01998 Canby Telcom 01481  02302  Bell ExpressVu 01998 Cass Cable 00476  01376  Bell Fibe TV 01998 CC9 02703  02752   Bend Broadband 01376  00476  03474  02187 CCAP 01877  BesTV 04196 CCS 03322  Bevcomm 01898  00476 Celrun 03442  02682  BGCTV 03278  00476 CenturyLink 01998  BIG BOX 03465 Channel Master 03118  Blue Ridge 01877 Charter 01877  01376   Communications 00476  02187   Bluewin 02271 03560  Bouygues Telecom 03007 Chengde Guangtong _   03936  Boxer 03607 Chengdu Cable 03953  Bright ClouDigital 03961 Chengdu Telecom 04196             En 77       50          Connections       Initial Setup       China Telecom    China Unicom    04196  02913   03937  04366  04196      Playing Back          Chongqing Cable    03954       Comporium    Consolidated  Communications    01877  03560   02187  01877  01376   01998  02302   03048     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel     gt Remote Controller          Extra TV       02132       Hathw y    02043  02726       Bl Cable Set Top Box  F to J                    Chongqing Cable 03954  Networks   CHT 03647  
152. TC 13067 Philips 13614  12800   JVC 12271  11670  10556  11454    11774  12676  11394  12372   11601 PHOENIX Apollo 12239  Kuppersbusch 12676 Polaroid 11769  11523   Lenco 12676  11983 12676  LG 11860  11423 Powerpoint 10698  Linetech 12676 Prima 11753  Linsar 12676 Pro Vision 12197  Logik 13432  13005  ProLine 12676   12486  11037  Proscan 12256  13895    11687 13636  Luxor 12676  11037 Prosonic 12676  12197  Magnavox 12372  11866  QuantumFX 12337   11454 RCA 12187  12746   Marks  amp  Spencer 12673 12932  11447   Mascom 12197 12247  13382  Matsui 12486  12676  RefleXion 12239   11037 Reoc 12197  Medion 12676  12239  Saba 12676   13067 Saga 12197  Memorex 11670 Salora 12197  12676   Memory 11983 12239  MT logic 12104 Sandstrom 12197  Murphy 12673 Sansui 11670  13564  Mx Onda 11983 Sanyo 12676  13488  Naxa 12104  13382 Sceptre 125298  12337  Neon 12673 Schaub Lorenz 12197  12289  Nikkei 12197 Scott 11983  Nimbro 12104 SEG 12673  11037                         50       Connections       Initial Setup    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller                                                                                              Viore 13429  12352   12104  13382   13118   VisionPlus 12426   Walker 12676   Waltham 11037   Weltstar 11037   Westinghouse 11712   Wharfedale 11983   Xiahua 11753   Xiron 11983  11037   Xoceco 11753   Xogego 11753   Xoro 13067   Zenith 10000  10178   Xogego 11753   Xoro 13067   Zenith 10000  10178                  
153. TER   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen    press RETURN    e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the main unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks   gt k                                                E Registration Procedure    Before Performing any Operation  The name and URL  of the radio station that you want to add are required for  registration  Check the specifications before use     1  Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen        KNOCK  NU LA  mm a  VA NA  SN ZX  oi Nu       f  E  Nu Xe       d  B  R  J    E                n  AN  NS  f Xx  Iu  ZC 3  YY                            J  J   J  J       Q Network    Tuneln Radio   Pandora   Spoti    tunein  SiriusXM Internet Radio   Slacker Personal Radio          2  Select  My Favorites  with the cursors and press  ENTER to display the  My Favorites  list screen     3  With the cursors  select a blank area of  My Favorites   and press MENU to display the menu screen     En 9       50      Remote Controller          Connections   Initial Setup       I LJ CJ LJ    MENU                   4  Select  Create new station  with the cursors and press  ENTER to display the keyboard screen   5  Enter the name 
154. TRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR  IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL INTEL OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller    NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR  BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT  LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     3  libcurl   COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE   Copyright  c  1996   2007  Daniel Stenberg   lt daniel haxx se gt     All rights reserved    Permission to use  copy  modify  and distribute this software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby granted  provided that  the above copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies    THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  AS IS   WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND  NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS   BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM  DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY  WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT  TORT OR  OTHERWISE  ARISING 
155. There also  may be an improvement if you change the screen mode  on the TV     Linked operation    E There is no HDMI linked operation with CEC    compliant equipment such as a television   e Set the HDMI CEC  RIHD  setting of the unit to  On    Press RECEIVER and then SETUP on the remote  controller  select  Setup     6  Hardware     HDMI      HDMI CEC  RIHD   and set to  Yes     e  t is also necessary to make the HDMI linked system  settings on the CEC compliant equipment  Check the  operating instructions     E The RI functions do not work   e To use RI  you must make an RI connection and an  analog audio connection  RCA  between the component  and AV receiver    e While Zone 2 is selected  the RI functions do not work        Playing Back    repeatedly until  Deep Color Off  appears on the display      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Tuner    ll Reception is noisy  FM stereo reception is noisy  or  the  FM STEREO  indicator does not stay lit   e Re check the antenna connection    Relocate your antenna    Move the unit away from your TV or PC    Passing cars and airplanes can cause interference   Concrete walls weaken radio signals    Listen to the station in mono    When listening to an AM station  operating the remote  controller may cause noise     Bluetooth    e Try plugging unplugging the power of the unit and try  turning on off the Bluetooth enabled device  Re startup  of the Bluetooth enabled device may be effective    e The Bluetooth en
156. VEN IF THE AUTHOR OR THE PUBLISHER HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES   Termination    a  This License and the rights granted hereunder will terminate automatically upon any breach by You of any  term of this License  Individuals or entities who have received Derivative Works from You under this License  however  will not  have their licenses terminated provided such individuals or entities remain in full compliance with those licenses  Sections 1  2  6   7  8  9  10 and 11 will survive any termination of this License     b  If You bring a copyright  trademark  patent or any other infringement claim against any contributor over  infringements You claim are made by the Work  your License from such contributor to the Work ends automatically   6 Subject to the above terms and conditions  this License is perpetual  for the duration of the applicable    copyright in the Work   Notwithstanding the above  the Author reserves the right to release the Work under different license terms  or to stop distributing the Work at any time  provided  however that any such election will not serve to withdraw this License  or  any other license that has been  or is required to be  granted under the terms of this License   and this License will continue in  full force and effect unless terminated as stated above    Publisher  The parties hereby confirm that the Publisher shall not  under any circumstances  be responsible for and shall not  have any liability in respect of the sub
157. WARE BE  LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY  WHETHER IN CONTRACT  TORT OR OTHERWISE  ARISING FROM   OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE     17  Expat   http   www jclark com xml expat html   Expat License  Copyright  c  1998  1999  2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd   Permission is hereby granted  free of charge  to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files   the  Software    to deal in the Software without restriction  including without limitation the rights to use  copy  modify  merge   publish  distribute  sublicense  and or sell copies of the Software  and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do  so  subject to the following conditions    The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software    THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  AS IS   WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND  NONINFRINGEMENT  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM   DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY  WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT  TORT OR OTHERWISE  ARISING FROM  OUT  OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE     18  FastDelegate   http   www codeproject com KB cpp FastDelegate aspx   THE WORK  AS DEFINED BELOW  IS PROVIDED UNDER THE TERMS O
158. Yes    Set whether a subwoofer is connected or not    Yes   When subwoofer is connected   No   When subwoofer is not connected       Height Speaker    Front High    Set the speaker type if height speakers are  connected to the BACK or HEIGHT terminals   Select  Front High    Top Front    Top Middle    Top  Rear    Rear High    Dolby Speaker  Front    or   Dolby Speaker  Surr   according to the connected  speaker type and location   e  f an item cannot be selected even though  connection is correct  check that the settings  in  Speaker Channels  matches the number of  connected channels        Bi Amp       No       Set whether your front speaker connection is bi    amp     No   When front speakers are connected in a   normal manner    Yes   When front speakers are bi amp connected   e  f an item cannot be selected even though  connection is correct  check that the settings  in  Speaker Channels  matches the number of  connected channels           50          Connections       Initial Setup      Playing Back       Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller             Powered Zone 2    No    Set the connection of speakers to Zone 2 speaker   terminals     Yes   When speakers are connected to ZONE2   speaker terminals    No   When speakers are not connected to ZONE2   speaker terminals   e This item will be set to  No  when  Bi Amp  is set  to  Yes      Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details          Spea
159. able     Bl Network server  When PC etc  network server is  used    Component that stores music files and provides the unit  with those files at the time of playback     e Requirements for use with this unit depend on the  component that is used as a network server    e Conditions for pleasant playback of music files on  the unit depend on the using network server  PC  performance   See instruction manuals of using  components     E Modem  when Internet radio is used    Device that connects home network  LAN  and Internet  There are many kinds of modems depending on the forms  of Internet connection    In addition  when connecting to the Internet  it is required  to conclude an agreement with a company that provides  Internet connection service  called ISP  Internet Service  Provider     Use a modem that is recommended by your ISP company  for the Internet connection    There are some devices that have both router and modem  functions    Within above network components  prepare a router   Ethernet cable  and network server when the NET function   network server  is used    For enjoying the NET function  Internet radio   it is  necessary to use the router  Ethernet cable  and modem   and agreement with ISP      Server Requirements    Bl Server playback   This unit can play digital music files stored on a PC or  media server and supports the following technologies    e Windows Media  Player 11   e Windows Media  Player 12   e DLNA certified media server   The network server mus
160. abled devices must support the A2DP  profile    e Near components such as microwave oven or cordless  phone  which use the radio wave in the 2 4 GHz range   a radio wave interference may occur  which disables the  use of this unit    e  f there is a metallic object near the unit  Bluetooth  connection may not be possible as the metal can effect  on the radio wave     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     ll Cannot connect with this unit   e The Bluetooth function of the Bluetooth enabled  device is not enabled  Refer to the user manual of  the Bluetooth enabled device for how to enable the  Bluetooth function    e When building a Bluetooth connection between this unit  and your Bluetooth enabled device for the first time  if  the connection fails  select  6 Hardware     Bluetooth    execute  Clear  in  Pairing Information   turn off and  then on again your Bluetooth enabled device to clear the  device name  and build the Bluetooth connection again    e  f the wireless LAN and Bluetooth connections are  used at the same time  try connecting the ETHERNET  port and router with the Ethernet cable after selecting   6  Hardware     Network  and changing  Wi Fi  to   Off Wired   for a better connection     Bl Music playback is unavailable on the unit even after   successful Bluetooth connection   e When the audio volume of your Bluetooth enabled  device is set low  the playback of audio may be  unavailable  Increase the volume of the Bluetooth   enabled d
161. ack of the TV and the DIGITAL IN OPTICAL  jack of the unit or an analog audio cable connection  between the audio output jack of the TV and the AUDIO IN  TV jack of the unit       Audio connection with a TV not supporting ARC    zk Select an appropriate  connection for your TV              DIGITAL IN   ASSIGNABLE     The unit supports the HDMI Standby Through function  that allows video and audio signal transmission from  players to the TV even if the unit is in standby  You have to    60           Initial Setup Playing Back Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                               modify the settings to enable the input selection link with  D A player with a digital audio out jack can be connected   CEC  Consumer Electronics Control  compliant device  SCH   Video upconversion function         i Digital optical cable  OPTICAL  connection WMARE ae EE ARA zh m        As  i digital in ba jack of the si has a Video signals input to the composite video input  Through function  See  2 Source Connection  of  Step 2  cover push inthe cable adsinstle caver asi jack or the COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks will be  Initial Setup   timed hade  upconverted to HDMI signals and then output from  e Another TV can be connected to the HDMI OUT SUB XL II2       Digital coaxial cable  COAXIAL  the HDMI output jack   jack   to one of the HDMI IN1 to IN3 jacks and connect the Er De   d   ps tilium Su  La     unit and the TV via HDMI  You will be unable to view Com 
162. ain black until the update is complete  and the power is turned on again    e During the update  do not turn off  or disconnect and  reconnect the USB storage device    e  Completed   is displayed when the update is  complete     8  Disconnect the USB storage device from the unit     9  Press OON STANDBY on the main unit to turn the unit  into standby mode  The process is completed and your  firmware is updated to the latest version    e Do not use  ORECEIVER on the remote controller     En 56       Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel      Remote Controller           D ON STANDBY       If an Error Message is Displayed   When an error occurs        Error   is displayed on the unit        represents an alphanumeric character   Check the  following     Error Code   e   01    10   USB storage device not found  Check whether the USB  storage device or USB cable is correctly inserted to the  USB port of the unit   Connect the USB storage device to an external power  source if it has its own power supply    e   05    13    20    21   The firmware file is not present in the root folder of the  USB storage device  or the firmware file is for another  model  Retry from the download of the firmware file    e Others  First disconnect then reconnect the AC power cord  and  then retry from the beginning           Connections Initial Setup za Playing Back       your preferences will be reset to the defaults  Note them  down before starting reset     1  While holding down CBL SAT on
163. akers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed        Input Format Listening Mode                Dolby TrueHD Pure Audio  European     Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       Dolby TrueHD            Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music         DTS Neural X       Orchestra         Unplugged 4       Studio Mix         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono          DTS 96 24 Pure Audio  European     Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       DTS 96 24            Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music        DTS Neural X       Orchestra         Unplugged          Studio Mix         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono         DTS HD HR Pure Audio  European     Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo   DTS HD HR       Dolby Surround  Neo 6 Music   DTS Neural X  Orchestra                        Unplugged     Studio Mix    AllCh Stereo     Full Mono                          Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or sur
164. and URL of the radio station to add   e Select  A a  and press ENTER to toggle between  upper and lower case  Select   lt      or       and press    ENTER to move the cursor to the selected direction     Select   lt xI  and press ENTER to delete one  character to the left of the cursor position     ll Registering a Station with PC    Before Performing any Operation  The name and URL  of the radio station that you want to add are required for  registration  Check the specifications before use  Also   Make sure this unit and a computer are connected to the  same router     1  Press RECEIVER on the remote controller    e Always press RECEIVER first to change the remote  controller to Receiver mode  the mode to operate  this unit  since its mode may be changed to operate  another component     COCOCOCO  GOOG  CO CO CO CO  e C CO CO    ONNI   2  Press SETUP to display the SETUP menu     y  e     Q    Eu cu                                                             3  With the cursors  select  6  Hardware     Network    IP  Address  to display the IP address   e Take note of the IP address since you will need it  later     En 10    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel         Open the Internet browser on your PC or smartphone    and enter the IP address of the unit in the URL field    e When using Internet Explorer  you can alternatively  select  Open  in the  File  menu to enter the IP  address    e Information of the unit is displayed on the browser     WEB Setup   
165. are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software  to make sure the software is free  for all its users    This license  the Lesser General Public License  applies to some specially designated software packages  typically libraries  of  the Free Software Foundation and other authors who decide to use it  You can use it too  but we suggest you first think carefully  about whether this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy to use in any particular case  based on  the explanations below    When we speak of free software  we are referring to freedom of use  not price  Our General Public Licenses are designed to  make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software  and charge for this service if you wish   that you  receive source code or can get it if you want it  that you can change the software and use pieces of it in new free programs  and  that you are informed that you can do these things    To protect your rights  we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender  these rights  These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it   For example  if you distribute copies of the library  whether gratis or for a fee  you must give the recipients all the rights that we  gave you  You must make sure that they  too  receive or can get the source code  If you link other code with 
166. audio   compression technology developed by Microsoft   Corporation  Audio can be encoded in WMA format by   using Windows Media   Player    e Supported sampling rates  8 kHz  11 025 kHz  16 kHz   22 05 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   e Supported bitrates  Between 5 kbps and 320 kbps   Incompatible files cannot be played    e WMA Pro Voice formats are not supported     E WMA Lossless   wma or  WMA    e Supported sampling rates  44 1 kHz  48 kHz  88 2 kHz   96 kHz   e Quantization bit  16 bit  24 bit    B WAV   wav or  WAV    WAV files contain uncompressed PCM digital audio    e Supported sampling rates  8 kHz  11 025 kHz  12 kHz   16 kHz  22 05 kHz  24 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   64 kHz  88 2 kHz  96 kHz  176 4 kHz  192 kHz   e Quantization bit  8 bit  16 bit  24 bit  x For playback from a USB storage device  sampling rates of 176 4 kHz   and 192 kHz are not supported   x For playback from a USB storage device  5 1 ch is not supported     E AAC     aac  m4a  mp4  3gp  3g2  AAC  M4A  MP4  3GP or    3G2    e Supported formats  MPEG 2 MPEG 4 Audio   e Supported sampling rates  8 kHz  11 025 kHz  12 kHz   16 kHz  22 05 kHz  24 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz   64 kHz  88 2 kHz  96 kHz   e Supported bitrates  Between 8 kbps and 320 kbps     Incompatible files cannot be played   FLAC   flac or  FLAC     FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data  compression     Supported sampling rates  8 kHz  11 025 kHz  12 kHz    16 kHz  22 05 kHz  24 kHz  32 kHz  44 1 kHz  48 kHz    64 kHz
167. ay be interrupted     USB storage device    Bl USB storage device is not displayed   e Check whether the USB storage device or USB cable is  correctly inserted to the USB port of the unit    e Remove the USB storage device from the AV receiver  once  and then try re connecting    e Performance of the hard disk that receive power from  the USB port of the unit is not guaranteed    e Depending on the type of format  the playback may  not be performed normally  Check the type of the file  formats that is supported    e USB storage devices with security functions may not be  played     En 60    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       Wi Fi  Wireless LAN  Network    e Try plugging unplugging the power supply of wireless  LAN router and the unit  check the wireless LAN router  power on status  and try reboot of the wireless LAN  router     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     E Cannot access to Wi Fi  Wireless LAN  network   e  he wireless LAN router setting may be switched to  Manual  Return the setting to Auto    e Try the manual set up  The connection may succeed    e When the wireless LAN router setting is at stealth mode   mode to hide the SSID key  or when ANY connection  is off  the SSID is not displayed  Change the setting and  try again    e Check if SSID and encryption settings  WEP  etc   are  correct  Make sure the network settings of the unit is  properly set    e Connection to an SSID that includes multi byte  characters is
168. ayback only in a separate room    e With external players  it is possible to play the same  source or different sources in the main room and  separate room    e With  NET  and  BLUETOOTH   you cannot select  different inputs for the main room and separate room   For example  if  NET  has been selected in the main  room and then  BLUETOOTH  is selected as playback  source in the separate room  the input in the main room    Advanced Manual    played in the other room   To play the same source in the  main room and separate room  press ZONE2 twice      To turn off the function  After pressing ZONE2 on the remote controller  press  ORECEIVER  Alternatively press OFF on the main unit     e If ZONE 2 is on  power consumption during standby  becomes larger than normal    e If ZONE 2 is turned on when the listening mode of the   main room is Pure Audio  it will automatically switch to   the Direct listening mode   European  Australian and   Asian models    While ZONE 2 is on  the RI linked system function    interlink between Onkyo components  is disabled    Pressing INPUT SELECTOR on the remote controller     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       E Listening Mode  Select the listening mode from the  categories of  MOVIE TV    MUSIC  and  GAME   After  selecting the Listening Mode  press ENTER button to  confirm   e  t cannot be set when audio is played from the TV s  speakers     ll Audio  You can perform various audio settings including  audio quality and speake
169. ayed  Furthermore  by registering a  particular remote control code to a button  you can  switch the remote control mode to operate other  equipment by pressing that button     3 RECEIVER button  Switches the remote controller to  the mode for operating this unit     4  Cursor buttons and ENTER button  Move the cursor  and confirms the selection       SETUP button  Displays the screen for making various  settings for this unit       Listening mode buttons  Allow you to select the  listening mode    MOVIE TV button  You can select a listening mode   suitable for movies and TV programs    MUSIC button  You can select a listening mode suitable   for music    GAME button  You can select a listening mode suitable   for games    STEREO button  You can select a listening mode for   stereo and all channel stereo sources    e For details on the listening modes  see the Advanced  Manual     D DIMMER button  Switches the brightness of the display    ZONE2 button  For use when the unit is connected with  a pre main amplifier or speakers in a separate room and  sound is played there     9 MUSIC OPT button  Turns on off the MUSIC  OPTIMIZER function that improves the quality of the  compressed audio    MUTING button  Temporarily mutes audio  Press again  to cancel muting    d0 VOLUME buttons  Allow you to adjust the volume  This  button also cancels the muting    42 RETURN button  Returns the display to the previous  state    43  Q button  Displays the Quick Setup menu that allows  you to 
170. belNoord 02015   Kaon 02493  02889   02746  03407   04409  02682   02979  03389   kbro 02350  03139   KCN TV 02703   KCT 01760  02703   02752  03474   KCTV 02979  03340   03389  03849   03322   KCTV JEJU 02979  03340   03389  03849   KCTV KJ 02979  03340   03389  03849   KDMC 03319  02979   Kiryung 03498   Kiss 02132  02271   KoolConnect 01481   KPN 02952  02437   Kreatel 02030   KT 02683  03478   Lattelecom 02030   LG 03340  02682   03407  02979   03389  03319   LG U  02682   Linksys 02271   Lishui Huashu 04034   Longyan Broadcasting   04195    Cable  amp  Tv             Lumos Networks    01998  03028              02 02586   OCN 03865   Oi TV 03452  03454   04165   Olleh TV 02683  03478   Olleh Skylife 02683  03478   Ono 01562   Open IPTV 01615   Optimum 01877   Optimus Clix 02437   Optus 00276  01060   Orange 02407   Oriental Cable 03865   Networks   Pace 01376  01060   02620  01982   01877  01998   00858  01582   01883  03454   02294  02401   Panasonic 02703  02752   03474  01760   01782  01982   Parasat 03479   Paul Bunyan 02254  02586   Communications   PCCW 02009  02057   Philips 01582  02378   03560  02294   Pioneer 01782  01877     03925  02700                Pioneer Telephone    02254  02302                   Jilin Broadcasting 04009  Jilin Cable 04009  Jinan Radio and 04206  Television Network   Jishi Media 04009  Jiuzhou 01991  JP PTT 01615  JXCN 03948    Magio Sat 02132  Magnet 01615  Maige TV 03937                M Cable Set Top Box  K to N     Massillon Cable   
171. ben  Ue  E Women Initial Setup       and the other type is designed to be integrated with normal  speakers  Dolby Enabled Speakers placed with their  diaphragms facing toward the ceiling create higher effect   in the Dolby Atmos and Dolby Surround listening modes   by providing sounds echoing off the ceiling  You can select         or  OXO  on the unit  For connection with the unit   use the SPEAKERS BACK or HEIGHT terminals     When playing Dolby Atmos  the speakers required depend  on how you have setup your back speakers or height  speakers  The following shows combinations of speakers  for reproducing Dolby Atmos                                Connection D e o  d CLE  pattern Back or Height AES IA  1 Back IO TI     2 Front High 9J0  O0  3 Rear High    O   0  4 Top Front   1010  5 Top Middle   1010  6 Top Rear    O   O  7 Dolby Enabled Speaker  Front  Geet  8 Dolby Enabled Speaker  Surround  D IO                    9  Required  O  Optional    Connection of a subwoofer is optional     Important   North American and Taiwanese models   Connect speakers with 6 O to 16 O impedance  Using a  speaker with less impedance than the supported value  may result in failure     Important   European  Australian and Asian models   Connect speakers with 4 O to 16 O impedance  You  have to change the setting if any of the speakers  have 4 Q or more to less than 6 O impedance  Using  a speaker with less impedance than the setting   may result in failure  You can set up by viewing the  guidan
172. ble for games       Playing Back     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller             Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format    Listening Mode             Input Format Listening Mode       Analog Direct       Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG         Game Action         Game Rock      Game Sports         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono      Multich PCM Direct  Multich       Dolby Atmos  e  he listening mode       Dolby Surround    of Dolby Digital Plus  or Dolby TrueHD can       DTS Neural X    be selected if back       Game RPG      speakers or height  speakers are not       Game Action      connected        Game Rock 2       Game Sports          AllCh Stereo      Direct       Dolby Atmos       Game RPG       Game Action       Game Rock       Game Sports       AllCh Stereo       Full Mono       T D          Full Mono   T D          Input Format    Listening Mode             T D           1 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed      Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode    Dolby D          PCM Direct       Dolby Surround  DTS Neural  X       Game RPG         Game Action         Game Rock         Game Sports         AllC
173. c License       gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel    To apply these terms  attach the following notices to the library  It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most  effectively convey the exclusion of warranty  and each file should have at least the  copyright  line and a pointer to where the  full notice is found     lt one line to give the library s name and an idea of what it does  gt    Copyright  C   lt year gt   lt name of author gt    This library is free software  you can redistribute it and or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as  published by the Free Software Foundation  either version 2 1 of the License  or  at your option  any later version    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful  but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY  without even the implied warranty  of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  See the GNU Lesser General Public License for more  details    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License along with this library  if not  write to the Free  Software Foundation  Inc   59 Temple Place  Suite 330  Boston  MA 02111 1307 USA   Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail    You should also get your employer  if you work as a programmer  or your school  if any  to sign a  copyright disclaimer  for the  library  if necessary  Here is a sample  alter the names    Yoyodyne  Inc   hereby disclaims all copyright interest in th
174. ce displayed on the TV screen  Select the item  with the cursor buttons of the remote controller and  press ENTER to confirm your selection  To return   to the previous screen  press RETURN  Press  RECEIVER and then SETUP on the remote controller   Select  2  Speaker     Configuration     Speaker  Impedance  and change the default value from  6ohms   to  4ohms      En 6    Playing Back    SDW  Right back  Or right height          Q0          Subwoofer with built in            SEH  VK END A  Wu 9    LINE OUT  PRE OUT    Advanced Manual    e    Front R          en      power amplifier V     gt Front Panel    Surround R     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       DOD  Q Left back  Front L Or left height    A speaker configuration  where only one back  speaker is connected is  not supported                 SPEAKERS          Surround L       ao Initial Setup Playing Back Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Instructions on how to connect speakers When using commercially available banana plugs   Oe c                                   tighten the speaker terminals to the end and then insert  12 15mm  1 2  5 8   the banana plugs  Do not insert the core of speaker cable  EN directly into the hole for banana plug of speaker terminal       E  North American models              Cut and remove the plastic coating from the end of the ZA  speaker cable  twist the core and connect it to the terminal    S  Be sure to make correct connection between the 
175. ce no sound    e Depending on the source and current listening mode   not much sound may be produced by the surround  speakers  Try selecting another listening mode     E The center speaker produces no sound  e When the Stereo or Mono listening mode is selected   the center speaker produces no sound     E No sound from the back speakers and height   speakers   e Depending on the source and current listening mode   not much sound may be produced by the speakers  Try  selecting another listening mode     B The subwoofer produces no sound   e When the input signal does not include a subwoofer  audio element  LFE   the subwoofer may not produce  sound     E Volume is low   e Check the volume  The volume level is adjustable  between Min  1 to 79  Max  80   A level of around 40 is  normal in a domestic environment     E There is no sound from a connected turntable    e  f your turntable uses an MC cartridge  you must  connect an audio equalizer and either an MC head amp  or an MC transformer     En 58    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       B  Noise can be heard   e Using cable ties to bundle audio cables with power  cords  speaker cables  etc  may degrade the audio  performance  so refrain from doing it    e An audio cable may be picking up interference  Try  repositioning your cables     B The sound changes when   connect my headphones   e When a listening mode other than Direct  Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models   or Mono
176. ces  To play such content  connect an HDCP  Rev 2 2 compatible TV or player to the HDMI OUT MAIN SUB  jack or HDMI IN1 to 3 jacks of the unit    e The HDMI video stream  i e   video signal  is compatible with  DVI  Digital Visual Interface   so TVs and displays with a DVI  input can be connected by using an HDMI to DVI adapter cable    Note that DVI connections only carry video  so you will need  to make a separate connection for audio   However  reliable  operation with such an adapter is not guaranteed  In addition   video signals from a PC are not supported    e The HDMI audio signal  sampling rate  bit length  etc   may be  restricted by the connected source component  If the picture  is poor or there is no sound from a component connected via  HDMI  check its setup  Refer to the connected component s  instruction manual for details     Home network  LAN     The connection of several components via cables enabling  the mutual communication is called a network    At households  many families create  generally  the term   build  is used  a network to connect PC and gaming  machines to the Internet and to exchange data between  PC    The network established in a relatively narrow area such as  one household is called a LAN  Local Area Network     In this manual  a term  home network   network for a  family  is used instead of  LAN   so this LAN becomes  more familiar    By connecting this unit with the network server such as a  PC  playing music files in the network server  
177. ch  such Contribution s  was submitted  If You institute patent litigation against any entity  including a cross claim or counterclaim   in a lawsuit  alleging that the Work or a Contribution incorporated within the Work constitutes direct or contributory patent  infringement  then any patent licenses granted to You under this License for that Work shall terminate as of the date such  litigation is filed     Redistribution     You may reproduce and distribute copies of the Work or Derivative Works thereof in any medium  with or without modifications   and in Source or Object form  provided that You meet the following conditions     You must give any other recipients of the Work or Derivative Works a copy of this License  and  You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices stating that You changed the files  and    You must retain  in the Source form of any Derivative Works that You distribute  all copyright  patent  trademark  and attribution  notices from the Source form of the Work  excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works  and   If the Work includes a  NOTICE  text file as part of its distribution  then any Derivative Works that You distribute must include   a readable copy of the attribution notices contained within such NOTICE file  excluding those notices that do not pertain to any  part of the Derivative Works  in at least one of the following places  within a NOTICE text file distributed as part of the Derivative  W
178. channels       Dolby    Make the settings for Dolby listening mode                 Setting Item Default Value Setting Details  Loudness On Enable the Late Night function that allows  Management you to enjoy surround sound of Dolby TrueHD  playback even in low volume    On   Use this function   Off   Do not use this function  En 36     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Theater Dimensional    Make the settings for Theater Dimensional listening mode        Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Listening Angle       Wide    To enhance the effect of Theater Dimensional   select the actual angle of the left and right  front speakers as it appears from the listening  position     Narrow   Less than 30     Wide   Greater than 30           e Position the front speakers 20   to the listening position if you have selected  Narrow  in  Listening    Angle  and 40  if you have selected  Wide      Volume    Make the detailed volume setting of the unit        Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Maximum Volume    Off    Set the maximum value to avoid too high volume   Select a value from  Off    30  to  79         Power On Volume    Last    Set the volume level of when the power is turned   on  Select a value from  Last   Volume level   before entering standby mode    Min    1  to  79    and  Max     e You cannot set a higher value than that of   Maximum Volume         Headphone Level       0 dB       Adjust the output level of th
179. creen  OSD   Select the item with the  cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER JCP   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen  GE See 7 ae  ll Listening to Traffic Information  TP  n didi             dus S cum CO  1  Press RT PTY TP on the main unit three times     man Gg e e Ee Fi e ee   eae   ITP   will be displayed if traffic information is ee ee alae Ann  T E Sd UI diosa uredi in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by Of  a e e E a Se S SE hu a looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  il   Jeep nere HES display on the main unit does not support the display  visse of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be Qe         cL displayed are replaced with asterisks        GAME RT PTY TP MEMORY eege  WE   Pandora e    pou _ J Spotiy s  tunein     SiriusXM Internet Rode  2  Press ENTER to search a radio station distributing traffic   Ara  information  z  Y  SETUP ENTER RETURN                            3  Select  USB  with the cursors and press ENTER     e If the  USB  indicator on the display flashes  check  whether the USB storage device is plugged in  properly    e Do not unplug the USB storage device while   Connecting     is on the display  This may cause  data corruption or malfunction     3  When a radio station is found  searching stops and  traffic information is received   e  Not Found  is displayed if no radio station  distributing traffic information is found         PLAYLIST    4  Press ENTER again in
180. cretion of the Author    h   Work  refers to the collection of files distributed by the Publisher  including the Source Code  Executable    Files  binaries  data files  documentation  whitepapers and the Articles    i   You  is you  an individual or entity wishing to use the Work and exercise your rights under this License   Fair Use Fair Use Rights  Nothing in this License is intended to reduce  limit  or restrict any rights arising from fair use  fair  dealing  first sale or other limitations on the exclusive rights of the copyright owner under copyright law or other applicable laws   License Grant  Subject to the terms and conditions of this License  the Author hereby grants You a worldwide  royalty free  non   exclusive  perpetual  for the duration of the applicable copyright  license to exercise the rights in the Work as stated below     a  You may use the standard version of the Source Code or Executable Files in Your own applications    b  You may apply bug fixes  portability fixes and other modifications obtained from the Public Domain or from  the Author  A Work modified in such a way shall still be considered the standard version and will be subject to this License    C  You may otherwise modify Your copy of this Work  excluding the Articles  in any way to create a Derivative  Work  provided that You insert a prominent notice in each changed file stating how  when and where You changed that file    d  You may distribute the standard version of the Executable Files a
181. cted    e Set  TV Out     Impose OSD  to  On     e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   The guidance displayed on the TV screen  OSD  are not  displayed when the OSD language is set to Chinese if  the input selector is  NET  or  BLUETOOTH   Operate  by confirming the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the main unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks         RI Dock    e Make sure the unit is turned on  the correct input source    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       is selected  and the volume is turned up     e Make sure cord and cable plugs are properly plugged in     e Make sure your iPod iPhone is properly inserted in  the Dock  If your iPod iPhone is in a case  it may not  connect properly to the Dock  Always remove your iPod   iPhone from the case before inserting it into the Dock   Try reconnecting your iPod iPhone    e Make sure your iPod iPhone is actually playing     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     BI There is no sound  e Try resetting your iPod iPhone     B There is no video   e Make sure the correct input is selected on your TV or  the unit    e Make sure that your iPod iPhone model s TV OUT  setting is set to On    e Some versions of the iPod iPhone do not output video     E The AV receiver s remote controller does not control   your iPod iPhone   e The iPod iPhone cannot be operated while it is  d
182. ctions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the  rights  These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software  or if you modify it   For example  if you distribute copies of such a program  whether gratis or for a fee  you must give the recipients all the rights  that you have  You must make sure that they  too  receive or can get the source code  And you must show them these terms so  they know their rights    We protect your rights with two steps   1  copyright the software  and  2  offer you this license which gives you legal permission  to copy  distribute and or modify the software    Also  for each author s protection and ours  we want to make certain that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this  free software  If the software is modified by someone else and passed on  we want its recipients to know that what they have is  not the original  so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original authors  reputations    Finally  any free program is threatened constantly by software patents  We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free  program will individually obtain patent licenses  in effect making the program proprietary  To prevent this  we have made it clear  that any patent must be licensed for everyone s free use or not licensed at all    The precise terms and conditions for copying  distribution and modification follow    TERMS A
183. d of   transmitting data in FM radio signals    e RDS works only in areas where RDS broadcasts are  available    e  n some cases  the text information appeared on the  display is not identical to the content transmitted by  the RDS station  Furthermore  unexpected characters  may be displayed when the unit receives unsupported  characters  However  this is not a malfunction    e  f the signal from an RDS station is weak  the RDS data  may be displayed continuously or not at all     PS  Program Service   Tuning into a radio station  distributing Program Service information displays the  radio station name  Pressing DISPLAY displays the  frequency for 3 seconds     RT  Radio Text   Tuning into a radio station transmitting  Radio Text information displays text on the display of the  unit     PTY  Program Type   Allows you to search for RDS  stations by program type     TP  Traffic Program   Allows you to search for radio  stations transmitting traffic information     E Displaying Radio Text  RT   1  Press RT PTY TP on the main unit once   e The Radio Text  RT  is displayed scrolling across  the display   No Text Data  is displayed when no text  information is available        r    CLI  GAME RT PTY TP MEMORY    Slt tC                   E Searching by Type  PTY   1  Press RT PTY TP on the main unit twice   e The current program type appears on the display        r    CL  GAME RT PTY TP MEMORY    Slt 1 1                    2  Press  lt PRESET   to select the type of program to  sea
184. d output   Rated Output Power  Others    7 ch x 160 W at 6 ohms  1 kHz  1 ch driven of 1   IEC   Maximum Effective Output Power   7 ch x 175 W at 6 ohms  1 kHz  1 ch driven  JEITA   Asian   Dynamic Power   gt      x IEC60268 Short term maximum output power  240 W  3 Q  Front   210 W  4 Q  Front   120 W  8 Q  Front   THD N  Total Harmonic Distortion Noise   0 08   20 Hz   20 kHz  half power   Input Sensitivity and Impedance  200 mV 47 kQ  LINE  1 kHz 100 W 8 Q   3 5 mV 47 kO  PHONO MM   Rated RCA Output Level and Impedance  100 mV 2 3 kO  ZONE2 LINE OUT   1 V 470 O  SUBWOOFER PRE OUT   Phono Overload  70 mV  MM 1 kHz 0 596 Direct   Frequency Response  10 Hz   100 kHz  1 dB     3 dB  Direct mode   Tone Control Characteristics   10 dB  20 Hz  BASS    10 dB  20 kHz  TREBLE   Signal to Noise Ratio  100 dB  LINE  IHF A   80 dB  PHONO MM  IHF A   Speaker Impedance  6 QO   16 Q  North American and Taiwanese   4 Q   16 O 6 Q   16 Q  Others     Video Section    Signal level  1 0 Vp p 75 Q  Component Y   0 7 Vp p 75 Q  Component Pb Cb  Pr Cr   1 0 Vp p 75 Q  Composite   Maximum resolution supported by component video  480i 576i    Tuner Section    FM Tuning Frequency Range  87 5 MHz   107 9 MHz   North American and Taiwanese   87 5 MHz   108 0 MHz  RDS  Others   AM Tuning Frequency Range  522 530 kHz   1611 1710 kHz  Preset Channel  40    En 22      Playing Back      Advanced Manual    Network Section    Ethernet LAN  10BASE T 100BASE TX  Wireless LAN  IEEE 802 11 b g n standard   Wi Fi
185. dd  ponent video cable  images protected by HDCP2 2 if your TV does not have iu   Its transmitted video has higher quality than  a HDCP2 2 compatible input jack  that of composite video cable   e To play 4K or 1080p video  use a high speed HDMI  cable or high speed HDMI with Ethernet cable   3  A player with a composite video output jack can be  connected        d Um Composite video cable     4  A player with analog audio out jacks can be connected        Connecting Components without HDMI                  If your AV component does not have HDMI jack  use an When using jacks   and  9  for video input  connect AV Receiver  available jack of your component for cable connection with to the audio input jacks corresponding to the jacks  this unit  connected at    and  3   For example  when video input   Ure veu EEN SEET  connection is to the    BD DVD jack  the audio input the COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks and output   D D    connection should also be to the    BD DVD jacks   them from the HDMI OUT jack  set the output   k It is possible to change assignment of the input jacks and input resolution of the player to 480i or 576i  If the input  selector buttons  For how to make settings  see the Advanced has 480p 576p or higher resolution  a message  Manual  prompting you to change the resolution setting    To enjoy multi zone playback with a player  connect player to either will appear  If your player does not support 480i or   D or   jacks  576i output  use the composite video jack   zk
186. dniczymi wymaganiami i innymi w  a  ciwymi postanowieniami  Dyrektywy 1999 5 EC        Eu  Onkyo Corporation  declaro que o TX NR646 cumpre os requisitos    En 24      Playing Back      Advanced Manual    essenciais e outras provis  es relevantes da Directiva 1999 5 EC    Prin prezenta  Onkyo Corporation  declar   c   aparatul TX NR646 este  in conformitate cu cerintele esentiale si cu alte prevederi pertinente ale  Directivei 1999 5 CE    Onkyo Corporation t  mto vyhlasuje  Ze TX NR646 a sp    a z  kladn    po  iadavky a v  etky pr  slu  n   ustanovenia Smernice 1999 5 ES    Onkyo Corporation izjavlja  da je ta TX NR646 v skladu z bistvenimi  zahtevami in drugimi relevantnimi dolo  ili direktive 1999 5 ES    Onkyo Corporation vakuuttaa t  ten ett   TX NR646 tyyppinen laite on  direktiivin 1999 5 EY oleellisten vaatimusten ja sit   koskevien direktiivin  muiden ehtojen mukainen    H  rmed f  rklarar Onkyo Corporation att denna TX NR646 f  ljer de  v  sentliga kraven och andra relevanta stadgar i Direktiv 1999 5 EC    H  r me   l  sir Onkyo Corporation   v   yfir a   varan TX NR646 er i samr  mi  vi   grunnkr  fur og a  rar kr  fur sem ger  ar eru    tilskipun 1999 5 EC   Onkyo Corporation erkl  rer herved at denne TX NR646 er i  overensstemmelse med vesentlige krav og andre relevante bestemmelser  i direktiv 1999 5 EC    Ovime Onkyo Corporation  potvr  uje da je TX NR646 u suglasnosti sa  osnovnim zahtjevima i ostalim relevantnim odredbama Direktive 1999 5   EC      gt Front 
187. duce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution   All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement   Eric Young   eay cryptsoft com    The word    cryptographic    can be left out if the rouines from the library being used are not cryptographic related       If you include any Windows specific code  or a derivative thereof  from the apps directory  application code  you must include an  acknowledgement   This product includes software written by Tim Hudson  tjh cryptsoft com    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT   INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED  TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY   OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE   EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     En 27      Remote Controller               Connections      Initial Setup       Copyright  c  1998 Red Hat Soft
188. e    Setting Details       Front    100 Hz    Select the crossover frequency from  40Hz  to   200Hz  to start outputting frequencies for each  channel     Full Band   Full band will be output    e  f  Configuration     Subwoofer  is set to  No     Front  will be fixed to  Full Band  and the low  pitched range of the other channels will be output  from the front speakers  Refer to the instruction  manual of your speakers to make the setting        Center       100 Hz       Select the crossover frequency from  40Hz  to   200Hz  to start outputting frequencies for each  channel     Full Band   Full band will be output    e  Full Band  can be selected only when  Front  is  set to  Full Band     e  f an item cannot be selected even though  connection is correct  check that the settings in   Configuration     Speaker Channels  matches  the number of connected channels     Back    100 Hz    Select the crossover frequency from  40Hz  to   200Hz  to start outputting frequencies for each  channel     Full Band   Full band will be output    e This cannot be selected in the following  conditions        The setting for  Configuration     Bi Amp  is   Yes         Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to   Yes  and ZONE 2 is on   e  Full Band  can be selected only when   Surround  is set to  Full Band     e  f an item cannot be selected even though  connection is correct  check that the settings in   Configuration     Speaker Channels  matches  the number of connected channels        LPF
189. e   If a newer version than version 2 of  the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared  then you can specify that version instead if you wish    Do not make any other change in these notices   Once this change is made in a given copy  it is irreversible for that copy  so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to  all subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy   This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a program that is not a library   4  You may copy and distribute the Library  or a portion or derivative of it  under Section 2  in object code or  executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with the complete  corresponding machine readable source code  which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2  above on a medium customarily used for software interchange   If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place  then offering  equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the  Source code  even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code   5  A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library  but is designed to work with the Library by  being compiled or linked with it  is called a  work that uses the Library   Such a work  in isolation  is not a  derivative work of the Library  and therefore fal
190. e  unit     Specifications and features are subject to change without notice            Connections    Initial Setup EV EOK   Advanced Manual  gt Remote Controller     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel       Table of image resolutions Resolutions supported by HDMI                                                                                                                                            Refer to the following table for information about the image formats and resolutions output by this unit in Content  response to input signals WE protection Diay Color Depth  Remarks  support technolo  resolution  Output HDMI  Input 4K   t1080p 24  1080p   1080i   720p   480p 576p   480i 576i  4K v  1080p 24 v  1080p v RGB YCbCr4 4 4     HDMI 1080i v 1280x720p 24 25 30 50 60 Hz   YCbCr4 2 2 BESSER  720p v 1680x720p 24 25 30 50 60 Hz  480p 576p v 1920x1080p       24 25 30 50 60 Hz  Lan  v   560x1080p  24 29 80 Hz  I  eps mns  Component  720p 24 25 30 Hz um 8 10 12 16 bit  US P 7 OR RGB YCbCr4 4 4  8 bit    a YCbCr4 2 2 12 bit  Composite 4801 5761 v YCbCr4 2 0 8 10 12 16 bit  RGB YCbCr4 4 4    24 25 30 Hz YCbCr4 2 2 Geh  4K SMPTE RGB YCbCr4 4 4  8 bit   409  160p  YCbCr4 2 2 12 bit   YCbCr4 2 0 8 10 12 16 bit  720x480i  720x576i  HDMI input  INA toIN7      HDCP1 4  un adii  50 60 Hz Dee 8 10 12 bit  RGB YCbCr4 4 4  8 bit  2 iia YCbCr4 2 2 12 bit   3840x2160p    50 60 Hz YCbCr4 2 0 8 bit  mue PEN RGB YCbCr4 4 4  8 bit  sees YCbCr4 2 2 12 bit   50 60 Hz YCbCr4 2 0 8 bit               x W
191. e Licensor   except as required for reasonable and customary use in describing the origin of the Work and reproducing the content of the  NOTICE file     Disclaimer of Warranty     Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing  Licensor provides the Work  and each Contributor provides its  Contributions  on an  AS IS  BASIS  WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND  either express or implied   including  without limitation  any warranties or conditions of TITLE  NON INFRINGEMENT  MERCHANTABILITY  or FITNESS  FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  You are solely responsible for determining the appropriateness of using or redistributing the  Work and assume any risks associated with Your exercise of permissions under this License     Limitation of Liability     In no event and under no legal theory  whether in tort  including negligence   contract  or otherwise  unless required by applicable  law  such as deliberate and grossly negligent acts  or agreed to in writing  shall any Contributor be liable to You for damages   including any direct  indirect  special  incidental  or consequential damages of any character arising as a result of this License   or out of the use or inability to use the Work  including but not limited to damages for loss of goodwill  work stoppage  computer  failure or malfunction  or any and all other commercial damages or losses   even if such Contributor has been advised of the  possibility of such damages     Accepting Warranty or Additional Liabili
192. e cursor buttons and press  ENTER     2 Hold down the automatic setting button of the access  point for the necessary seconds  select  OK  with the  cursor buttons and press ENTER     PIN code  Select this method when the automatic setting  button of the access point is beyond the reach  Select  PIN  code  with the cursor buttons and press ENTER to display  the 8 digit PIN code  Register the displayed PIN code to the  access point  select  OK  with the cursor buttons and press  ENTER  For how to register the PIN code to the access  point  refer to its instruction manual     En 13           Connections EN Playing Back Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          When the access point is not displayed T ovco revor steer Audio output of connected players   Select  Other     with the cursor on the remote Ee To enjoy digital surround sound including Dolby Digital and   controller and press ENTER to display the keyboard Eiere DTS  audio output should be set to  Bitstream output  on the   screen  Input the SSID and password  Make the oe connected Blu ray Disc Player or other device    following settings according to the router setting  EE Depending on the settings on the Blu ray Disc Player  there  Ihave read Onkyo s Privacy Policy and agre to its terms  may be cases when Dolby TrueHD  Dolby Atmos  and DTS    E WPA WPA2 method   l ME S S S S HD Master Audio is not output according to the format of the   Select  WPA  or  WPA2  in  Security Method     
193. e displayed     consumption is kept to a minimum by  SSID   SSID of the connected access point   automatically entering the HYBRID  Signal   Signal strength of the connected access  STANDBY mode  where only the essential point   circuit is operating   Status   Status of the connected access point   e  his setting is fixed to  Off  if  Bluetooth      Auto pune ange is set to  Off   MAC Address   This is the MAC address of the AV receiver   This value is specific to the component and  e Wait for a while if  Network Standby  or  Bluetooth Wakeup  cannot be selected  It will appear when cannot be changed   the network function is started up  DHCP Enable  Enable   Auto configuration by DHCP   Disable   Manual configuration without DHCP  e  f selecting  Disable   you must set  IP  Address    Subnet Mask    Gateway   and   DNS Server  manually   IP Address     Displays Sets the IP address   Subnet Mask     Displays Sets the subnet mask   Gateway     Displays Sets the gateway   DNS Server     Displays Sets the primary DNS server   Proxy URL     Displays Sets the proxy server URL   Proxy Port     Displays Sets the proxy server port number when  you enter  Proxy URL      En 42                   Connections       Initial Setup    Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel      Remote Controller             Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details    Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details          Friendly Name    AirPlay Password       TX NR646       Change the name for 
194. e for audio source with much reverberation     B Mono    Use this mode when watching an old movie with a mono  soundtrack  or use it to separately reproduce soundtracks  in two different languages recorded in the left and right  channels of some movies  It is also suitable for DVDs or  other sources containing multiplexed audio     Bi Multich  Multichannel     Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in PCM  multichannel     B Orchestra    Suitable for classical or operatic music  This mode  emphasizes the surround channels in order to widen the  stereo image  and simulates the natural reverberation of a  large hall     ll Pure Audio  European  Australian and Asian  models     This mode reproduces the original sound accurately  Since  the audio from the input source is output without surround  sound processing and the display and video circuitry are  turned off  possible noise sources are minimized for a  realistic audio reproduction   e This mode cannot be selected when Zone 2 is  active  Activating Zone 2 when this mode is selected  automatically switches to the Direct listening mode     B Stereo    In this mode  sound is output from the front left and right  speakers and subwoofer     B Studio Mix    Suitable for rock or pop music  Listening to music in this  mode creates a lively sound field with a powerful acoustic  image  like being at a club or rock concert     E T D  Theater Dimensional     In this mode  you can enjoy a virtual playback of  multichannel surround sou
195. e headphones   Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB                  Connections Initial Setup    Playing Back       4  Source    Make settings for input sources  such as volume difference adjustments for each input  selector for the connected equipment  Select the input selector to configure     IntelliVolume       Setting Item Default Value Setting Details       IntelliVolume 0 dB Adjust the volume level difference between the  devices connected to the unit  Select a value  between   12 dB  and   12 dB   Set a negative  value if the volume of the target device is larger  than the others and a positive value if smaller   When you select a desired input to check the  audio  start playback of the connected device   e  his function is not effective in Zone 2              Name Edit    Set an easy name to each input  The set name will be shown on the main unit display   Select the input selector to configure        Setting Item Default Value Setting Details       Name Input name 1  Select a character or symbol with the  cursors and press ENTER   Repeat it to input 10 or less characters    Ala   Switches between upper and lower  cases   Pressing  10 on the remote  controller also toggles between upper and  lower cases      lt      _    Moves the cursor to the arrow  direction    OT Removes a character on the left of the  cursor    Space   Puts a space   e Pressing CLR on the remote controller   will remove all the input characters    2  After inputting  select  OK  with the
196. e library  Frob   a library for tweaking knobs  written by James  Random Hacker    signature of Ty Coon  1 April 1990   Ty Coon  President of Vice   That s all there is to it    GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE   Version 2  June 1991   Copyright  C  1989  1991 Free Software Foundation  Inc 59 Temple Place   Suite 330  Boston  MA 02111 1307  USA  Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document  but changing it is not allowed    Preamble   The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it  By contrast  the GNU General  Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software  to make sure the software is free for  all its users  This General Public License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation s software and to any other program  whose authors commit to using it   Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public  License instead   You can apply it to your programs  too    When we speak of free software  we are referring to freedom  not price  Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure  that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software  and charge for this service if you wish   that you receive source  code or can get it if you want it  that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs  and that you know  you can do these things    To protect your rights  we need to make restri
197. e pre main amplifier in a separate room   with an RCA cable        Main room    e The volume should be adjusted with the pre main  amplifier used in the separate room      gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       ll b  Connecting with speakers in a separate  room   Connect the speakers in another room to the SPEAKERS  ZONE2 jacks of the unit using speaker cables  Note that  5 1 ch will be the maximum     in the main room during  Zone 2 playback  No sound will be output from the back  speakers and height speakers    zk In this case  the Dolby Atmos listening mode cannot be selected     ZONE 2     9   9        OXO        Main room    These settings are required  After connecting the   speakers  press  amp  RECEIVER and then SETUP   on the remote controller  select  2  Speaker       Configuration  and set  Powered Zone   to  Yes     e Adjust the volume on this unit  To adjust the   volume  press ZONE2 on the remote controller  and then adjust with VOLA     To control on the  main unit  press ZONE 2 and within 8 seconds   adjust with the MASTER VOLUME control  You  can mute the sound by pressing MUTING on the  remote controller            Connections   Initial Setup    Performing Multi zone Playback    It is possible to perform playback in the main room and a  separate room at the same time  for example by playing  the Blu ray Disc player in the main room where the unit is  placed while playing Internet radio in a separate room  It is  also possible to perform pl
198. e protection circuit may have been activated  If this is the HDMI control does not function correctly  RECEIVER Remote  case  when you turn the unit on again   AMP Diag Mode  will e Set the CEC link function of the unit to on  It is also necessary SE  EE indicator  appear on the main unit s display  The unit will then enter a to make the HDMI linked system setting on the TV  See the TV s    mode that detects abnormal conditions  If no problems are E EE E diss   detected   AMP Diag Mode  will disappear and the unit will  return to a normal state  If  CHECK SP WIRE  appears on the Cannot access to network   display  the speaker cables may be short circuited  Turn the e Try plugging unplugging the unit or the wireless LAN router or  unit off  and check to see if the cable core of any of the speaker check their power on status  This will work well in many cases   cables is in contact with that of another speaker cable or with e  f the desired wireless LAN router is not in the access point list   the rear panel  After that  turn the unit on again  If  NG  appears  it may be set to hide SSID or the ANY connection may be off   unplug the power cord immediately and contact your Onkyo Change the setting and try again   dealer     There s no sound  or it s very quiet   e Awrong input selector button has been selected  Select a    ll Resetting the unit    correct input for the player  Also check that muting is not on  Resetting the unit to the status at the time of shipment may solve  e
199. e radio station   e Select  Back  to return to the previous screen   e Radio stations can be deleted also from  WEB  Setup           Remote Controller          Connections Initial Setup       Playing Music with DLNA       About DLNA    Digital Living Network Alliance  DLNA  can be referred   to as a technology standard or the industry group to  develop the technology standard to interconnect and use  AV components  computers and other devices in a home  network  This unit allows you to use DLNA to play music  files stored on a computer or a hard disk connected to your  home network  NAS device   Make sure this unit and a  computer or NAS device are connected to the same router     O 9       ooo  Oo o  L T L T          Internet radio                                                                                              Router       NAS    e To stream a music file  you need a NAS device with  DLNA server functions or a PC where a player  e g    Windows Media   Player 11 or Windows Media Player  12  with DLNA server functions is installed  To enable  streaming with Windows Media   Player 11 or Windows  Media Player 12  you must first configure the settings     Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       Configuring the Windows Media  Player    E Windows Media  Player 11  1  Turn on your PC and start Windows Media  Player 11     2  In the  Library  menu  select  Media Sharing  to display  a dialog box     3  Select the  Share my media  check box  and then click 
200. e remote controller at the seconds    unit  e MODE allows you to use the Resume function        D    g   GIS  a    ION a e    r            REMOTE MODE INPUT SELECTOR    BD DVD CBL SAT STRM BOX  GAME    AUX   cD       0  9     v  T  o  z  o                   T           REMOTE MODE                          8   Deal  ZONE2      Mura                                                      C 2 en     DER in  4     ES GS     D REMOTE MODE       OSOURCE   3 MUTING   4  VOL A   5 ALBUM        I LJ UJ UL JI      ex  Qa     TOP MENU     D Atlas  ENTER  PLAYLIST lt   gt     En 53             Connections   Initial Setup       Firmware Update    About Firmware Update    There are two methods for updating the firmware  via  network and via USB   Use the one that best suits your environment   e For the latest information on updates  visit the Onkyo  website   e Before updating  make sure that the speaker setup  microphone is not connected   e During an update  do not      Disconnect and reconnect any cable  USB storage  device  speaker setup microphone or headphones   or perform any operation on the component such as  turn off its power      Access to this unit from a PC or smartphone using  Android application  e  he update may take about 30 minutes to complete for  either method  via network or via USB   Furthermore  existing settings are guaranteed  regardless of the method used for update     Disclaimer  The program and accompanying online  documentation are furnished to you for use at yo
201. e this function   When changing this setting  turn off and then on  again the power of all connected components    e Depending on the TV set  a link may need to  be configured on the TV    e  his function is effective only when the  device is connected to the HDMI OUT MAIN  terminal    e When this setting is  On   the names of the  CEC compatible components and  CEC On   are displayed after this operation screen is  closed    e Power consumption in standby mode may  increase if this setting is  On    Depending on  the TV status  the unit will enter the normal  standby mode     e  f you operate the MASTER VOLUME  control on the unit when this setting is  On   and audio is output from the TV speakers   audio will be output also from the speakers  connected to the unit  If you want to output  from only either of them  change the unit or  TV settings  or reduce the volume of the unit    e  f abnormal operation occurs when you set  the setting to  On   set it to  Off     e When connecting a non CEC compatible  component  or when you are not sure  whether it is compatible  set the setting to   Off         En 39             Connections         Initial Setup    Playing Back       Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller             HDMI Standby  Through       Off       When this is set to anything other than  Off    you can play the video and audio of an HDMI  connected player on the TV even if the unit is in  standby
202. e used for output   B Information     Audio  Displays the audio input source  format  number  of channels  sampling frequency  listening mode  and  number of output channels     Video  Displays information such as the video input  source  resolution  color space  color depth  3D  information  Aspect and output     Tuner  Displays information such as the band   frequency  and preset number  This is displayed only  when  TUNER  is selected as the input source     8 Other useful functions       To adjust the sound quality   It is possible to enhance or moderate the bass and treble  of front speakers  Press TONE on the main unit several  times to select the desired setting from  Bass    Treble  and   Phase Matching Bass   and adjust with        e  t cannot be set if the listening mode is Pure Audio    European  Australian and Asian models  or Direct     Bass   Allows you to enhance or moderate the bass    Treble   Allows you to enhance or moderate the treble    Phase Matching Bass   Allows you to keep the clear  midrange and effectively enhance the bass      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Checking the Input Format  Press DISPLAY on the remote controller several times to  switch the display of the main unit in order of     Input source  amp  volume EEN pipe    Listening mode eU    Signal format Pie ios PY ELO 4    Sampling frequency    Input signal resolution bof deg  we zia    e  f  Dolby D 5 1  is displayed in Signal format  the  Dolby Digital 5 1 c
203. ect  Yes  Continue  with the cursors  and press ENTER        CR Initial Setup B E H e  Source Conneci tion  This step will start to check if the LJ  connections were made correctly   Would you like to continue  2  A  Ee    Yes  Continue    No  Skip       2  Select the desired input to check the connection and     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller    press ENTER    Start playback of the selected device  If connection is  correct  video audio of the input source selected on the  unit will be played     3  After checking the connection  select  Yes  with the    cursors and press ENTER    e  f you select  No  and press ENTER  the error cause  will be displayed  Follow the guidance to remove the  error cause and check the connection again     4  Select  Yes  with the cursors and press ENTER    on the remote controller to check the connection  of other inputs or select  No  Done Checking  and  press ENTER to skip    If you select  Yes   you will return to the screen of step  2    If you select  No  Done Checking   you will proceed to  step 5     5  Set the CEC link function     Select  Yes  to enable the HDMI link function with CEC   compliant equipment  then select  Yes  again in the next  screen        CX Source Connection    The following CEC compatible devices are found     Do you wish to turn on the CEC link     XXXXXXXXXXX          If you select  Yes   the connection with ARC compatible    TV and HDMI Standby Through function will be set to   On  and enabled  
204. ecurity  Inc  MD5 Message   Digest Algorithm  in all material mentioning or referencing this software or this function    License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided that such works are identified as  derived from the RSA Data  Security  Inc  MD5 Message Digest Algorithm    in all material mentioning or referencing the derived work    RSA Data Security  Inc  makes no representations concerning either the merchantability of this software or the suitability of this  software for any particular purpose  It is provided  as is  without express or implied warranty of any kind    These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this documentation and or software     13  thttpd 2 25b   Copyright c 2000 by Jef Poskanzer  lt jef mail acme com gt   All rights reserved    Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer    Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS  FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE 
205. eed in the following order     1 AccuEQ Room Calibration    e Automatic calibration for optimum speaker settings    2 Source Connection    e Checking that each input source is connected correctly  e HDMI link function settings    3 Remote Mode Setup    e Settings required to operate other AV Components with  the Remote Controller    4 Network Connection    e Checking network connections  e Wi Fi settings          x Firmware update notification  If the unit is connected via LAN and there  is firmware update available  the  Firmware Update Available  message will  appear  To execute updating  select  Update Now  with the cursor buttons of  the remote controller and press ENTER   The unit automatically turns itself into standby mode about 3 minutes after   Completed   appears on the display  and updating will be complete     Before Start   Setup is performed as a series of responses to questions  asked by the unit  Select the item with the cursors of   the remote controller and press ENTER to confirm your    selection  To return to the previous screen  press RETURN     e You need to use HDMI connection between the unit and  TV   e Switch the input on the TV to that assigned to the unit                                      Select the language first  Next  a summary of the initial  settings is displayed  Select  Yes  in this screen and press  ENTER on the remote controller     CH Initial Setup    Welcome to initial setup        Have you connected all the speakers and devices   Bef
206. emon co uk  mailto  d hd org   mailto  Rainer Pruy informatik uni erlangen de  mailto  dirce zk3 dec com   mailto  wsanchez apple com   mailto  mrapple quack kfu com   mailto  jack innovativeinternet com  mailto  schnitz unipress com   mailto  shields tembel org   mailto  pebbles jpl nasa gov   mailto  harlan pfcs com   mailto  ken sdd hp com   mailto  ajit ee udel edu   mailto  tsuruoka nc fukuoka u ac jp  mailto  vixie vix com   mailto  Ulrich  Windl gyrz uni regensburg de   10  OpenSSL   LICENSE ISSUES    The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license  i e  both the conditions of the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay license  apply to the toolkit  See below for the actual license texts  Actually both licenses are BSD style Open Source licenses  In case of  any license issues related to OpenSSL please contact openssl core openssl org    OpenSSL License       Copyright  c  1998 2007 The OpenSSL Project  All rights reserved   Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer   Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution   All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must d
207. employ inceiling speakers or products with Dolby speaker  technology     E Dolby TrueHD    Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in Dolby   TrueHD    e  his listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream     E DSD    Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in DSD    e This unit supports DSD signals input through HDMI IN   However  depending on the connected player  better  sound is possible when output from the PCM output of  the player    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player s output setting is DSD     E DTS    Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in DTS    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream         gt Remote Controller          Initial Setup    Connections       i DTS 96 24    Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in DTS 96 24    With 96 kHz sampling rate and 24 bit resolution  it provides   superior fidelity    e Depending on the settings  this listening mode becomes  DTS    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream     B DTS Express    Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in DTS   Express    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally
208. enjoy the effect  only with Dolby Digital  Dolby Digital Plus  Dolby  TrueHD  and DTS sources   e Turning the unit to standby mode will set the setting  to  Off   In case of Dolby TrueHD  the setting will be  set to  Auto    The setting cannot be used in the following cases       If  Loudness Management  is set to  Off  when  playing Dolby Digital Plus or Dolby TrueHD       When the input signal is DTS and  Dialog  Control  is other than 0 dB     Cinema Filter  Adjust the soundtrack that was  processed to enhance its treble  in order to make it  suitable for home theater    e This function can be used in the following listening  modes  Dolby Digital  Dolby Digital Plus  Dolby  TrueHD  Multichannel  DTS  DTS ES  DTS 96 24   DTS HD High Resolution Audio  DTS HD Master  Audio  DTS Express  DSD     Center Spread  Adjust the width of the sound field of  the front channel when playing in the Dolby Surround  listening mode   To spread the width of the sound field to the left and  right  set to  On   To concentrate sound in the center  set  to  Off    e This setting may be  Off  depending on the settings   in speakers     En 20        Advanced Manual    Dialog Control  You can increase the dialog portion of   the audio in 1 dB steps up to 6 dB so that you can make   dialog easier to hear over background noise    e  his setting is unavailable for content other than  DTS X    e This setting may not be available for selection with  some content     ll HDMI  Select the HDMI OUT jack to b
209. eople to use a large  body of free software  For example  permission to use the GNU C Library in non free programs enables many more people to  use the whole GNU operating system  as well as its variant  the GNU Linux operating system    Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users  freedom  it does ensure that the user of a program  that is linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library   The precise terms and conditions for copying  distribution and modification follow  Pay close attention to the difference between  a  work based on the library  and a  work that uses the library   The former contains code derived from the library  whereas the  latter must be combined with the library in order to run     TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING  DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION  0  This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which contains a notice placed by the   copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General   Public License  also called  this License    Each licensee is addressed as  you    A  library  means a collection of software functions and or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application  programs  which use some of those functions and data  to form executables   The  Library   below  refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed under these t
210. equency of the speaker from   25 Hz  to  16 kHz  with the ap cursors  then  use Alf to adjust the volume of the frequency  between   6dB  to   6dB            Subwoofer       0 dB       Select a value between   15 dB  and   12 dB    A test tone will be output each time you change  the value  Select the desired level     Back 0 dB First select the frequency of the speaker from    25 Hz  to  16 kHz  with the  lt     cursors  then   use A F to adjust the volume of the frequency   between   6dB  to   6dB     e  his cannot be selected if  Configuration      Powered Zone 2  is set to  Yes  and Zone2  is set to on           e The speaker  Level Calibration  may be unable to be changed depending on the settings in     Configuration     Speaker Channels     Subwoofer    e  Level Calibration  cannot be changed while muting is on     Equalizer Settings    Adjust the output volume of each range of each connected speaker  You can adjust the    volume of each range of each speaker  You can set three types of equalizer settings in the    Presets 1  2  and 3     e You can adjust the bass in the low range frequencies  63 Hz  etc    and the treble in the high range  frequencies  16 kHz  etc     e You can select up to five frequency bands for each speaker     Subwoofer 0 dB First select the frequency of the speaker from    25 Hz  to  160Hz  with the  lt   gt  cursors  then   use A F to adjust the volume of the frequency   between   6dB  to   6dB     e  his cannot be selected if  Configuration   
211. er          E STEREO button Checking the Input Format    You can select a listening mode for stereo and all channel    stereo sources  While audio from the player is being input  press DISPLAY    on the remote controller several times to switch the  information shown on the main unit display  For example  if                Input Format Listening Mode    s  Dolby D 5 1  is displayed  the Dolby Digital 5 1 ch signals  AllCh Stereo   e The number of channels is not displayed when the input        1 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be signal IS Dolby Atmos  format     installed        ll PURE AUDIO button  on the main unit only    European  Australian and Asian models     The display and analog video circuit are turned off to  switch the unit to Pure Audio mode  European  Australian  and Asian models  which provides purer sound  Selecting  this mode lights the PURE AUDIO indicator on the unit   Pressing the button again reselects the previous listening  mode        PURE AUDIO TONE    e o    PHONES AUX INPUT  HDMI       XK       e Selecting Pure Audio for listening mode turns off the  display and analog video circuitry  but the video signals  input through HDMI input are output from HDMI output     En 28                Connections Initial Setup       Advanced Settings  Setup Menu        How to Set    The unit allows you to configure advanced settings in order  to provide even better experience     e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance  dis
212. er and  the listening position   Distance Subwoofer 12 0ft 3 60m Specify the distance between each speaker and  the listening position              Set the distance from each speaker to the listening position  Settings are automatically    configured if you use the automatic speaker setup  s pa inae EE                                                    Setting Item Default Value Setting Details e  he speaker  Distance  may be unable to be changed depending on the settings in  Configuration     UN  Speaker Channels     Subwoofer    Unit feet meters Specify the unit of distance for configuring  settings    feet   When setting in feet  0 1 ft to 30 0 ft  in Level Calibration  increments of 0 1 ft  Adi      h 7 ith th ilt  Setti     meters   When setting in meters  0 03 m to ege   ove O SS EV er wit E e   Gi test tone  Settings are automatically  9 00 m  in increments of 0 03 m  configured if you use the Automatic Speaker Setup   Front Left 12 0ft 3 60m Specify the distance between each speaker and Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details  ie stoning POSON  Front Left 0 dB Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB    Center 12 0ft 3 60m Specify the distance between each speaker and A test tone will be output each time you change  the listening position  the value  Select the desired level   Front Right 12 0ft 3 60m Specify the distance between each speaker and Center 0 dB Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB    the listening position  A test tone will be output each 
213. er to the RI Dock s instruction  manual     To operate Onkyo components directly or Onkyo   components that are not connected via RI  use the   following remote control codes    Onkyo DVD player  30627   Onkyo CD player  71817   RI Dock  82990   e With some models  operation may be not possible in  part or not possible at all           Connections Initial Setup Playing Back prchifclniesciel bleu  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                iPod   iPhone   Operation MENU   The RI Dock allows you to use the AV receiver s remote 90 cO   controller to operate and play music on your iPod iPhone     Ti D eme   Moreover  it also allows you to view videos on your iPod  eee S REPEAT RANDOM   MODE      iPhone on the screen of your TV  as well as perform RI C2  A KD  operations if connected via RI  This operation is possible C  C     only when the RI remote control code is programmed        Before performing any operation  Make sure the OS for             your iPod iPhone is updated to the latest version  Certain   D   buttons may not work for some iPod iPhone models and   generations  or RI Dock  For details on the operation  refer CON TIR RON SR een   to the RI Dock s instruction manual  REPEAT  RANDOM   Switch the remote controller mode by pressing the db MODE   REMOTE MODE button programmed with the remote    DISPLAY   control code for the iPod iPhone  and operate by using the e Pressing DISPLAY turns on the backlight for a few  corresponding buttons  Point th
214. erms  A  work based  on the Library  means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law  that is to say  a work containing the Library  or a portion of it  either verbatim or with modifications and or translated straightforwardly into another language   Hereinafter                Connections      Initial Setup       translation is included without limitation in the term  modification      Source code  for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it  For a library  complete source code  means all the source code for all modules it contains  plus any associated interface definition files  plus the scripts used to control  compilation and installation of the library   Activities other than copying  distribution and modification are not covered by this License  they are outside its scope  The act of  running a program using the Library is not restricted  and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a  work based on the Library  independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it   Whether that is true depends on what the  Library does and what the program that uses the Library does   1  You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library s complete source code as you receive it  in any  medium  provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright  notice and disclaimer of warranty  keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to t
215. ersion    e Do not use ORECEIVER on the remote controller        50          Connections Initial Setup           5 ON STANDBY       B if an Error Message is Displayed    When an error occurs        Error   is displayed on the unit        represents an alphanumeric character   Check the  following     Error Code   e   01    10    Ethernet cable not found  Connect the Ethernet cable   properly      02    03    04      18    20    21    Internet connection error  Check the following        Whether the router is turned on       Whether this unit and router are connected to the  network   Try to disconnect and then connect again the power   to the unit and router  This may solve the problem  If   you are still unable to connect to the Internet  the DNS   server or proxy server may be temporarily down  Check   the service status with your ISP provider    Others   First disconnect then reconnect the AC power cord  and   then retry from the beginning       05    06    11    13    14    16    17     Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Updating the Firmware via USB    Before Starting  e Prepare a 64MB or larger USB storage device       Media inserted in a USB card reader may not be  used for this function       USB storage devices with security function are not  supported         USB hubs and USB devices with hub function are not    supported  Do not connect these devices to the unit   Delete any data stored on the USB storage device     the network
216. es   e For registration of the remote control code   refer to  Operating Other Components with  the Remote Controller               8  Miscellaneous    Firmware Update          Setting Item Default Value Setting Details  Update Notice Enable Availability of a firmware update will be notified  via network      Enable   Notify updates   Disable   Do not notify updates       Version     The current firmware version will be displayed        Update via NET     Press ENTER to select when you want to   update the firmware via network    e You will not be able to select this setting if  you do not have Internet access or there is  nothing to update     Update via USB     Press ENTER to select when you want to   update the firmware via USB    e You will not be able to select this setting if  a USB storage device is not connected or  there is nothing to update in the USB storage  device                 En 45                EN  Connections Initial Setup    Playing Back    gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       Operating Other Components with    the Remote Controller       Functions of REMOTE MODE Buttons    You can control any other device than this unit by  programming a specified remote control code to a  REMOTE MODE button of the remote controller  Register  a remote control code to a desired REMOTE MODE button  and press it to enter the remote mode that allows you to  operate the corresponding device                1        i   I  a   m  2  9i  m     Si  EI  m  Si  
217. es  including  but not limited to communication on electronic mailing lists  source code control systems  and issue tracking systems that are  managed by  or on behalf of  the Licensor for the purpose of discussing and improving the Work  but excluding communication  that is conspicuously marked or otherwise designated in writing by the copyright owner as  Not a Contribution       Contributor  shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution has been received by  Licensor and subsequently incorporated within the Work     Grant of Copyright License     Subject to the terms and conditions of this License  each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual  worldwide  non exclusive   no charge  royalty free  irrevocable copyright license to reproduce  prepare Derivative Works of  publicly display  publicly  perform  sublicense  and distribute the Work and such Derivative Works in Source or Object form     Grant of Patent License     Subject to the terms and conditions of this License  each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual  worldwide  non exclusive   no charge  royalty free  irrevocable  except as stated in this section  patent license to make  have made  use  offer to sell  sell   import  and otherwise transfer the Work  where such license applies only to those patent claims licensable by such Contributor  that are necessarily infringed by their Contribution s  alone or by combination of their Contribution s  with the Work to whi
218. ess phones  e Cordless facsimiles  e Microwave ovens       50       Connections   Initial Setup       Wireless LAN devices  IEEE802 11b g n   Wireless AV equipment   Wireless controllers for game systems  Microwave oven based health aids   Video transmitter   Specific type of external monitor and LCD display    2  Less common devices which use a 2 4 GHz radio wave  frequency  e Anti theft systems  e Amateur radio stations  HAM   e Warehouse logistic management systems  e Discrimination systems for train or emergency  vehicles  If these devices and the AV receiver are used at the same  time  the audio may be undesirably stopped or disturbed  due to a radio wave interference   Suggestions for improvement  e Switch off the devices which emit the radio wave   e Place the interfering devices away from the AV  receiver    e The AV receiver uses radio wave  and a third person can  receive the wave on purpose or accidentally  Do not use  the communication for important or fatal matters    e We assume no responsibility whatsoever for any error  or damage of network environment or access device  resulting from the use of this apparatus    Confirm with the provider or access device maker for  more information     Scope of Operation    Use of the AV receiver is limited to home use    Transmission distances may be reduced depending on  communication environment     In the following locations  poor condition or inability to   receive radio waves may cause the audio to be interrupted   or s
219. evice    e Depending on the Bluetooth enabled device  Send   Receive selector switch may be provided  Select Send  mode    e Depending on the characteristics or specifications of  your Bluetooth enabled device  playback on the unit is  not guaranteed     B Sound is interrupted  e Problem may be occurring at the Bluetooth enabled  device  Check the information on a web page     WE The audio quality is poor after connection with a   Bluetooth enabled device   e The Bluetooth reception is poor  Move the Bluetooth   enabled device closer to the unit or remove any obstacle  between the Bluetooth enabled device and this unit     E  Bluetooth     Auto Reconnect  does not work  e  his may not work with some Bluetooth enabled  devices   In that case  pair the unit and the Bluetooth enabled  device and then play again     Network function    e  Network Setup  becomes selectable after the network  starts up even if it cannot be selected first  It may take  about a minute to start up    e When NET is blinking  the AV receiver is not properly  connected to the home network    e Try unplugging the power supply of this unit and the  router  and then plugging in again  Try rebooting the  router     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     ll Cannot access the Internet radio   e Certain network service or contents available through  the unit may not be accessible in case the service  provider terminates its service    e Make sure that your modem and router are properl
220. eview 10171   SR Standard 10037  11037   Starion 11037   Starlite 10037   STI 13793   Strato 10037   SunBriteTV 12337  12528   11610   Sunic Line 10037   Sunkai 10037  11523   Sunny 10037   Sunstar 10037   Sunstech 12676   Sunwood 10037   Superior 11585   Superscan 10093  10171   Supersonic 10208  11753   12104   SuperTech 10037  10556   Supra 10178   Supreme 10000   SVA 11498   Svasa 10208   Swisstec 12106  12104   Sylvania 10171  11864   11886  11394   Symphonic 10171  11394   Synco 11755  11826   10000  10093   10178   Syntax 11610   Sysline 10037       B Television  T to Z                    Tacico    10178  11150                            Tai Yi 11150  Talent 10178  En 72       Tandy 10093  Tashiko 10650  11150  Tatung 10037  11150   11687  Tauras 12197  TCL 13047  13183   12434  13001   10898  11038   12414  13426   12675  10698  TCM 10714  Teac 10037  11037   10698  10714   11755  10898   10178  10668   10171  10512   11983  13005  Tec 10037  Tech Line 10037  10668   11585  Technica 11037  12106   12426  Technical 12676  11667  Technics 10017  10556   10650  Technika 12426  12106   12197  11667   11983  12676   13005  12125   13067  TechniSat 10556  Technisson 10714  Techno 11585  Technosonic 10556  10625  Techwood 12676  11667   11037  Tecnimagen 10556  Teco 10093  10178   10653  11523   11687  Tedelex 10208  Teknika 10150     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller  TELE System 11585  12125 Tokaido 11037  Telecor 10037 Tophouse 10672  10698  Telefunken 1
221. f that system  it is up to the author donor to decide if he or  she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice    This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License    If the distribution and or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces  the  original copyright holder who places the Program under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation  excluding those countries  so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded  In such case  this  License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License    The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and or new versions of the General Public License from time to time  Such  new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version  but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns    Each version is given a distinguishing version number  If the Program specifies a version number of this License which applies  to it and  any later version   you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version  published by the Free Software Foundation  If the Program does not specify a version number of this License  you may choose  any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation    If you wish to incorporate parts of the 
222. fonica 01692  02262    02527  02263  TeleSAT 02631  02466          En 85       50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Telestar 01100  01099   01334  01197   02540  01195   01351  01626   01672   Televes 01300  01334   Televisa 00887   TelkomVision 04310   Telsey 02738   TelSKY 02540   Telstra 01356   TELUS 00775   Tesla 01626   Tevion 02205  01409   01672  02026   02813   Thai 03573  03539   Thomson 01291  01935   01662  00847   00853  01175   02278  01307   02160  02619   03110  03469   Tiny 01672   Titan 02205   Tividi 01429   TiVo 01377  01442   TivuSat 02750   T Mobile 02631  02443   01545   TNT SAT 01692  01195   01197  01986   Tokai 02938   Tonna 01611  02458   Topfield 01545  01986   01208  02838   Toshiba 01803  01284   01429   TPS 01307                   Transparent Video  Systems       01780  01957          TrekStor 02738   Triax 01291  01626   00853  01099   01611  01631   Tricolor TV 02622  03064   True Visions 03140  01208   02408  03784   T T micro 01429   TV Cabo 02160   TV Star 03012   TV Vlaanderen 02631  00853   02466   TVA Digital 02895  01692   02262   TVB 01989   TVonics 01906  01803   Twinner 01611   UEC 00879  01356   UfaNet 01986   UNE 01692   United 02842  02278   03012  01626   02418   Unitymedia 01429  01882   01915  
223. from a music CD is input  the  output will be stereo  or if Dolby Digital signal is input  the  sound field will be controlled in accordance with the number  of channels present     E Dolby Atmos    Introduced first in the cinema  Dolby Atmos brings a  revolutionary sense of dimension and immersion to the  Home Theater experience  Dolby Atmos is an adaptable  and scalable object based format that reproduces   audio as independent sounds  or objects  that can be  accurately positioned and move dynamically throughout  the 3 dimensional listening space during playback  A key  ingredient of Dolby Atmos is the introduction of a height  plane of sound above the listener     ll Dolby D  Dolby Digital     Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in Dolby Digital   e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the    player s output setting is bitstream     E Dolby D   Dolby Digital Plus     Mode suitable for playing sources recorded in Dolby Digital   Plus    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream     E Dolby Surround    Dolby surround is a next generation surround technology  that intelligently up mixes stereo  5 1 and 7 1 content for  playback through your surround speaker system  Dolby  surround is compatible with traditional speaker layouts   as well as Dolby Atmos enabled playback systems that  
224. g 0 88  with the following individuals added to the list of Contributing Authors   John Bowler  Kevin Bracey  Sam Bushell  Magnus Holmgren  Greg Roelofs  Tom Tanner  libpng versions 0 5  May 1995  through 0 88  January 1996  are Copyright  c  1995  1996 Guy Eric Schalnat  Group 42  Inc   For the purposes of this copyright and license   Contributing Authors  is defined as the following set of individuals   Andreas Dilger  Dave Martindale  Guy Eric Schalnat  Paul Schmidt  Tim Wegner  The PNG Reference Library is supplied  AS IS   The Contributing Authors and Group 42  Inc  disclaim all warranties  expressed  or implied  including  without limitation  the warranties of merchantability and of fitness for any purpose  The Contributing Authors  and Group 42  Inc  assume no liability for direct  indirect  incidental  special  exemplary  or consequential damages  which may  result from the use of the PNG Reference Library  even if advised of the possibility of such damage   Permission is hereby granted to use  copy  modify  and distribute this source code  or portions hereof  for any purpose  without  fee  subject to the following restrictions    The origin of this source code must not be misrepresented    Altered versions must be plainly marked as such and must not be misrepresented as being the original  source   This Copyright notice may not be removed or altered from any source or altered source distribution   The Contributing Authors and Group 42  Inc  specifically permit  witho
225. h   Another support  script  install sh  is copyright by M I T  but is also freely distributable    It appears that the arithmetic coding option of the JPEG spec is covered by patents owned by IBM  AT amp T  and Mitsubishi  Hence  arithmetic coding cannot legally be used without obtaining one or more licenses  For this reason  support for arithmetic coding  has been removed from the free JPEG software     Since arithmetic coding provides only a marginal gain over the unpatented Huffman mode  it is unlikely that very many  implementations will support it   So far as we are aware  there are no patent restrictions on the remaining code    The IJG distribution formerly included code to read and write GIF files  To avoid entanglement with the Unisys LZW patent  GIF  reading support has been removed altogether  and the GIF writer has been simplified to produce  uncompressed GIFs   This  technique does not use the LZW algorithm  the resulting GIF files are larger than usual  but are readable by all standard GIF  decoders    We are required to state that    The Graphics Interchange Format c  is the Copyright property of ompuServe Incorporated  GlF sm  is a Service Mark property  of CompuServe Incorporated      6  libogg   Copyright  c  2002  Xiph org Foundation   Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this 
226. h  American and Taiwanese models  or  AM  Frequency Step   European  Australian and  Asian models  with the cursor and select the  frequency step for your area    For Taiwanese models only   The setting is  10 kHz   0 2 MHz  at the time  of purchase  Please change it to  9 kHz    0 05 MHz      En 17              Connections Initial Setup       You can listen to audio in a room  called Zone 2  other than  the one where this unit is located  called the main room      ll Sources you can playback  e External players    1   e NET  2   e Bluetooth  e AM FM Radio   k 1 Only analog and 2ch PCM audio signals can be output to Zone 2   x2 DSD and Dolby TrueHD audio signals cannot be output to Zone 2     Important  Connection with external players   To listen to a player in Zone 2  you must connect using an  RCA cable  a digital optical cable  OPTICAL   or a digital  coaxial cable  COAXIAL   Some players may require audio  output setting                                   OPTICAL    DIGITAL IN     ASSIGNABLE        AUDIO IN    En 18    Advanced Manual    Making Multi zone Connection    There are the following two methods of connection   a  Connecting with a pre main amplifier in a separate room  b  Connecting with speakers in a separate room    Wa Connecting with a pre main amplifier in a  separate room   It is possible to play 2 ch source in a separate room while   7 1 ch source is being played in the main room    Connect the LINE OUT ZONE2 jacks of the unit and the   line in jacks of th
227. h Stereo        Full Mono        T D             Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed      Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     DSD Direct       DSD      Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG         Game Action         Game Rock         Game Sports      Direct       Dolby D            Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG 9       Game Action         Game Rock         Game Sports         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono         T D        1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch        AllCh Stereo       2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed        Full Mono       3 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed      4 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be          T D    installed                 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch     2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     4 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed        En 25          Connections Initial Setup          Input Format Listening Mode      Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                Dolby D  Direct  Dolby D           Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format Listening Mode             Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG         Game Action         Game R
228. h signals are being input  When  listening to AM FM radio  the band  frequency and  preset number are displayed     Playing Audio and Video from Separate Sources  It is possible to play audio and video from different sources   For example  you can play audio from the CD player and  video from the BD DVD player  In this case  press BD DVD  and then CD  Then start playback on the BD DVD player  and CD player  This function is effective when an input with  audio only has been selected  CD  NET  BLUETOOTH     TUNER or PHONO in the initial setting    gt    x When NET or BLUETOOTH is selected  press MODE on the remote  controller after pressing NET or BLUETOOTH on the remote controller              Connections   Initial Setup   Playing Back   Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller    Others       Troubleshooting keep distance between TV antenna cable and cables of the unit  e Do not unplug the power cord until  Clear  disappears from  e  f you connect a player supporting HDCP2 2  be sure to connect the display   it to one of the HDMI IN1 to IN3 jacks of the unit     Before starting the procedure   Video and audio are out of synch   Problems may be solved by simply turning the e Video may be delayed relative to audio depending on the    ower on off or disconnecting connecting the i i   AORE  Geer EE E Fees Hosen the settings and connections with your TV  Adjust in  Step 3     connection  setting and operating procedure  Try Playing Back    7 Quick Setup
229. he absence of any  warranty  and distribute a copy of this License along with the Library   You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy  and you may at your option offer warranty protection in  exchange for a fee   2  You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it  thus forming a work based on the  Library  and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above  provided that  you also meet all of these conditions   8  The modified work must itself be a software library   b  You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date  of any change   C  You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this  License  d  If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be supplied by an application  program that uses the facility  other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked  then you must  make a good faith effort to ensure that  in the event an application does not supply such function or table  the  facility still operates  and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful    For example  a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is entirely well defined  independent of the application  Therefore  Subsection 2d requires that any application supplied function or table  used by this function must be optional  if the
230. he connected  component  On some game consoles  such as those  that support DVD  the default setting is off    e After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller   repeatedly press DISPLAY to switch the display on the  main unit  You can see the input format     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     E Cannot select a desired listening mode   e Depending on the connecting status of the speaker   some listening modes may not be selected  Check the  details in  Selectable Listening Modes  section     B  There is no sound with Dolby Atmos   e You need to have either back speakers or height  speakers connected  After connecting each of the  speakers  make sure the connection settings in   Configuration     Speaker Channels  are correct    e Dolby Atmos play is only possible when the input signal  is Dolby Atmos     E Cannot select the Pure Audio listening mode    European  Australian and Asian models    e  he Pure Audio listening mode cannot be selected while  Zone 2 is on     Video    e Check that the output jack of the connected equipment  and the input jack of this unit are connected correctly    e Make sure that none of the connecting cables are bent   twisted  or damaged    e Make sure the switching of input screens is proper at the  monitor side such asa TV     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     B  There is no picture from a source connected to an   HDMI IN   e The input selector of this unit needs to be in the  posi
231. he copyright holder     23  c ares   http   c ares haxx se   Copyright 1998 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology    Permission to use  copy  modify  and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby  granted  provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission  notice appear in supporting documentation  and that the name of M I T  not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to  distribution of the software without specific  written prior permission  M I T  makes no representations about the suitability of this  software for any purpose  It is provided  as is  without express or implied warranty     24 LZ4   Copyright  c  2011 2014  Yann Collet All rights reserved    Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer      Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in  the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS   OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
232. he digital audio out optical  jack of the TV and the DIGITAL IN OPTICAL jack of the  unit or an analog audio cable connection between the  audio output jack of the TV and the AUDIO IN TV jack of  the unit     E There is no sound from the connected player   The input selector of this unit needs to be in the   position that corresponds to the jack where the player is   connected    e Check the digital audio output setting on the connected  component  On some game consoles  such as those    En 57       50          Connections      Initial Setup       that support DVD  the default setting is off   e With some DVD Video discs  you need to select an  audio output format from a menu     Bl One of the speakers produces no sound   e Make sure that the polarity of the speaker cables is  correct  and that no bare wires are in contact with the  metal part of speaker terminals    e Make sure that the speaker cables are not shorting    e Make sure the speakers are configured correctly     Only the front speakers produce sound  When the Stereo or Mono listening mode is selected   only the front speakers and subwoofer produce sound     Only the center speaker produces sound   If you use the Dolby Surround listening mode with a  mono source  such as an AM radio station or mono  TV program  the sound is concentrated in the center  speaker     B The surround speakers produce no sound   e When the T D  Theater Dimensional   Stereo or Mono  listening mode is selected  the surround speakers  produ
233. his License    If  as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason  not limited to patent  issues   conditions are imposed on you  whether by court order  agreement or otherwise  that contradict the conditions of this  License  they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License  If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your  obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations  then as a consequence you may not distribute the Program  at all  For example  if a patent license would not permit royalty free redistribution of the Program by all those who receive copies  directly or indirectly through you  then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from  distribution of the Program    If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance  the balance of the section is  intended to apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances    It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of  any such claims  this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system  which   is implemented by public license practices  Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software  distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application o
234. hrough     Audio Formats Supported by The Unit    e 2 channel linear PCM  32   192 kHz  16 20 24 bit    e Multichannel linear PCM  up to 7 1 ch  32   192 kHz   16 20 24 bit    e Bitstream  Dolby Atmos  Dolby Digital  Dolby Digital  Plus  Dolby TrueHD  DTS  DTS HD High Resolution  Audio  DTS HD Master Audio    e DSD   Your Blu ray Disc DVD player must also support HDMI  output of the above audio formats     About Copyright Protection    The unit supports Revision 1 4 and Revision 2 2  HDMI  OUT MAIN SUB and HDMI IN1 to 3 only  of the HDCP   High bandwidth Digital Content Protection    2   a copy   protection system for digital video signals  Other devices  connected to the unit must also support HDCP      4 DVI  Digital Visual Interface   The digital display interface standard set  by the DDWG   3  in 1999     2 HDCP  High bandwidth Digital Content Protection   The video  encryption technology developed by Intel for HDMI DVI  It is designed  to protect video content and requires a HDCP compatible HDMI DVI  receiver to display the encrypted video     3 DDWG  Digital Display Working Group   Lead by Intel  Compaq  Fujitsu   Hewlett Packard  IBM  NEC  and Silicon Image  this open industry  group s objective is to address the industry s requirements for a digital  connectivity specification for high performance PC and digital displays        AN          Initial Setup    Connections       Caution    e  here are some content that can be played only with HDCP Rev   2 2 compatible devi
235. iOS device are both connected to the router  correctly     Play music files from an iPhone  iPod touch  or iPad     ll Playing music files from a computer    1   2   3     4     AirPlay is compatible with iTunes 10 2 or later     Press NET on the remote controller   Turn on your computer and start iTunes     Click the AirPlay icon of iTunes and select this unit  from the list of devices displayed     Play iTunes music files     If  6  Hardware   Power Management   Network  Standby  is set to on in the Setup menu  then once  AirPlay starts  this unit turns on automatically and the   NET  input source is selected  Even if this setting   is  Off   if the unit is already on then the  NET  input  source can be selected    Due to the characteristics of AirPlay wireless technology   the sound produced on this unit may slightly be behind  the sound played on the AirPlay enabled device   Information such as the name of the track is displayed  on the unit s display during AirPlay playback    There may be some differences in how operations are  performed depending on the iOS or iTunes version   The on screen displays are not displayed when the  OSD language is set to Chinese  Operate by confirming  the display on the main unit   European  Australian   Taiwanese and Asian models     Volume  The volume of this unit and the AirPlay   enabled device are linked  Take care that the  volume does not become too loud when you adjust  the volume on the AirPlay enabled device  You may  damage the 
236. in the PC  is  possible  Moreover  by connecting to the Internet  listening  to the Internet radio is also possible    This unit  PC  and Internet are not directly connected   When connecting with a PC and or Internet  several  components  network components  are necessary     Components necessary for establishing a home  network  LAN     Components necessary for the home network  LAN  for  using the NET function of this unit are as follows     B Router   A router is a device that controls information  data  flow  between the unit  PC  and the Internet    As a network term  the flow of information  data  is called    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller        traffic   The router has a role to control the information flow  as the traffic control  between connected components    e Arouter with a built in 100Base TX switch is  recommended    e In addition  if your router has the DHCP function   facilitating the network setting becomes possible    e Some routers have a built in modem  and some Internet  Service Providers  ISP  require you to use specific  routers    Please consult your ISP or PC dealer if you are unsure     E CAT5 Ethernet cable   The Ethernet cable is a cable that actually connects   components that comprise the network  There are straight   type and cross type Ethernet cables    e Use a shielded CAT5 Ethernet cable  straight type  to  connect the unit to your home network    Consult your cable store for details of Ethernet c
237. in unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks                                           PLAYLIST       E Playing Back    1  Start the server  Windows Media  Player 11  Windows  Media  Player 12  or NAS device  containing the music  files to play     2  Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen   e If the  NET  indicator on the display flashes  the unit  is not properly connected to the network  Check the  connection     En 11         Remote Controller          Connections   Initial Setup       C  21 24 J amp  Jj  CIOS  CO CO 68 CO  C336    5  ONMM                                                   tunein       3  Select  DLNA  with the cursors and press ENTER     4  Select the target server with the cursors and press  ENTER to display the items list screen    e Searching does not work in servers that do not  support search functions    e The unit cannot access pictures and videos stored  on Servers    e Contents stored on the server may not be displayed  depending on the server sharing settings     5  With the cursors  select the music file to play  and then  press ENTER or B to start playback   e  f  No Item  is displayed  check whether the network  is properly connected                 En 12    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       Controlling Remote Playback from a PC    You can use this unit to play music files stored on your PC  by 
238. ion  code  on the unit  you can log in without entering the  user name and password     Pandora  Getting Started  U S   Australia and  En 6    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       New Zealand only     Pandora is a free  personalized Internet radio service that  plays the music you know and helps you discover music  you ll love     e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance   displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the   cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen    press RETURN    e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the main unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks   k                                                       PLAYLIST    E Playing Back    1  Press NET on the remote controller to display NET TOP  screen        m  V ki  ry EN  V E  EN E  M       CN   gt   NA NA          E  L  L           j  Nes  CN  e  y   K    N  V                            J  J     J    Spoti  gt     tunein  SiriusXM Internet Radio    Slacker Personal Radio          2  With the cursors on the remote controller  select   Pandora   and then press ENTER     3  Use A Y to select  I have a Pandora Account  or  
239. ion of the Library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly  through you  then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from  distribution of the Library    If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance  the balance of the section is   intended to apply  and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances    It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of   any such claims  this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which   is implemented by public license practices  Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software   distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system  it is up to the author donor to decide if he or  she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice    This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License    12  If the distribution and or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by  copyrighted interfaces  the original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add an  explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries  so that distribution is pe
240. ions                            RECEIVER                     When using the remote controller to operate  the AV receiver  The remote controller of this unit  has the remote mode function for controlling other  devices  You cannot control this unit when the  remote controller is in the remote mode other than  RECEIVER mode  for controlling this unit   Be sure  to press 3  RECEIVER to select the RECEIVER  mode before starting operation       Turning the power on    Press  D    RECEIVER on the remote controller to turn   the power on    e Switch the input on the TV to that assigned to the  unit  Use the TV s remote controller       Select the input on the unit    Press the 2  INPUT SELECTOR button for the player   you want to listen to  Press TV to listen to the TV s   sound  You can also use the input selector buttons on   the main unit    e Input will automatically be selected if the TV or player  is CEC compliant and connected to the unit with  HDMI cable       Select the desired listening mode    After pressing  B RECEIVER  press the     listening  mode buttons to switch the mode so that you can enjoy  different listening modes       Adjust the volume with 4  VOL     Advanced Manual    Part names and functions of the remote          REMOTE MODE INPUT SELECTOR                                gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller        D    RECEIVER button  Turns the unit on or into standby  mode     2 REMOTE MODE INPUT SELECTOR buttons  Switch  the input to be pl
241. isplay the following acknowledgment    This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit   http   www openssl org     The names  OpenSSL Toolkit  and  OpenSSL Project  must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this  software without prior written permission  For written permission  please contact openssl core openssl org   Products derived from this software may not be called  OpenSSL  nor may  OpenSSL  appear in their names without prior  written permission of the OpenSSL Project   Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment    This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit   http   www openssl org     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES   INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FORA  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS  BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES   INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE  DATA   OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF  THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH D
242. isplaying the Apple logo    e Make sure you have selected the correct remote  controller mode    e When you use the AV receiver s remote controller  point  it toward this unit    e Before operating with the remote controller  you may  need to play on your iPod iPhone to make the input  selector be recognized    e Depending on your iPod iPhone model and generation   some buttons may not work as expected    e Try resetting your iPod iPhone     E The unit unexpectedly selects your iPod iPhone as   the input source   e Always pause iPod iPhone playback before selecting  a different input source  If playback is not paused  the  Direct Change function may select your iPod iPhone  as the input source by mistake during the transition  between tracks     Others    E Strange noises can be heard from the unit  e  f you have connected another unit to the same wall  outlet as this unit  this noise may be an effect from the    other unit  If the symptoms improve by unplugging the  power cord of the other unit  use different wall outlets for  this unit and the other unit     E When performing Automatic Speaker Setup  the   measurement fails and the message  Ambient noise is   too high   is displayed    e  his can be caused by a malfunction in your speaker  unit  Check if the unit produces normal sounds     E The Late Night function does not work  e Make sure the source material is Dolby Digital  Dolby  Digital Plus  Dolby TrueHD  or DTS     B The Cinema Filter function does not work   e Thi
243. it persons to whom the Software is furnished to do  so  subject to the following conditions    The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software    THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  AS IS   WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND  NONINFRINGEMENT  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM   DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY  WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT  TORT OR OTHERWISE  ARISING FROM  OUT  OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE     2  ixml   Copyright  c  2000 2003 Intel Corporation All rights reserved    Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met       Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer      Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution    ul Neither name of Intel Corporation nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote    products derived from this software without specific prior written permission    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CON
244. ith YCbCr4 2 2  Color Depth supported is 12 bit only     En 23           Connections   Initial Setup    Precautions    For European Models    Declaration of Conformity   We declare  under our sole responsibility    that this product complies with the   standards        Safety       Limits and methods of measurement of  radio disturbance characteristics       Limits for harmonic current emissions       Limitation of voltage changes  voltage  fluctuations and flicker       RoHS Directive  2011 65 EU           Hereby  Onkyo Corporation  declares that this TX NR646 is in compliance  with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive  1999 5 EC         QCauacrosuijero  Onkyo Corporation  neknapupa  ue TX NR646 e B  CbOTBeTCTBMe CbC CbLUECTBEHMTe NZNCKBAHMA M ApyruTenpunoxKumu  paasnopen  oa Ha  1upekraBa 1999 5 EC        Onkyo Corporation t  mto prohla  uje  Ze TX NR646 spl  uje z  kladn    po  adavky a v  echna p    slu  n   ustanoveni Sm  rnice 1999 5 ES        Undertegnede Onkyo Corporation erkl  rer herved  at f  lgende udstyr  TX NR646 overholder de v  sentlige krav og   vrige relevante krav i direktiv  1999 5 EF        Hiermit erkl  rt Onkyo Corporation  dass sich das Ger  t TX NR646 in    bereinstimmung mit den grundlegenden Anforderungen und den   brigen  einschl  gigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999 5 EG befindet        K  esolevaga kinnitab Onkyo Corporation seadme TX NR646 vastavust  direktiivi 1999 5 EU p  hin  uetele ja nimetatud direktiivist
245. itial  Setup      Height speaker types    Installing speakers in ceiling                                                          e  o  lt      C   d  em  il  o  UC    a  bi Top Front    c    Top Middle       D Top Rear    Ceiling speakers  etc  are used for  maximizing effects in Dolby Atmos or     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Dolby Surround listening mode  Install Top  Front speakers so that they are positioned  at a point between directly above the  listening position and directly above the  front speakers  Install Top Middle speakers  so they are directly above the listening  position  Install Top Rear speakers so  they are positioned at a point between  directly above the listening position and  directly above the back speakers  You can  select                  or          on the  unit  For connection with the unit  use the  SPEAKERS BACK or HEIGHT terminals   e Dolby Laboratories recommends  placing the speakers as described in   Installing speakers in ceiling  to obtain  the best Dolby Atmos effect     Using Dolby Enabled Speakers          JP rns    em    U U                                                  Dolby Enabled Speakers  Front        0      Dolby Enabled Speakers  Surround     A Dolby Enabled Speaker is specially  designed to be used as a height speaker   There are two types of Dolby Enabled  Speakers  one type is designed to be  placed on top of other speakers such as  front speakers and surround speakers     En 5    50       
246. ive any third party  for a charge no more    En 25     gt Remote Controller               Connections      Initial Setup       than your cost of physically performing source distribution  a complete machine readable copy of the corresponding source code   to be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange  or    C  Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute corresponding source code    This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you received the program in object code or executable  form with such an offer  in accord with Subsection b above     The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it  For an executable work   complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains  plus any associated interface definition files  plus  the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the executable  However  as a special exception  the source code  distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed  in either source or binary form  with the major components   compiler  kernel  and so on  of the operating system on which the executable runs  unless that component itself accompanies  the executable    If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place  then offering equivalent  access to copy the source code from the 
247. ject matter of this License  The Publisher makes no warranty whatsoever in connection with  the Work and shall not be liable to You or any party on any legal theory for any damages whatsoever  including without limitation  any general  special  incidental or consequential damages arising in connection to this license  The Publisher reserves the right  to cease making the Work available to You at any time without notice    Miscellaneous    a  This License shall be governed by the laws of the location of the head office of the Author or if the Author is  an individual  the laws of location of the principal place of residence of the Author   b  If any provision of this License is invalid or unenforceable under applicable law  it shall not affect the    validity or enforceability of the remainder of the terms of this License  and without further action by the parties to this License   such provision shall be reformed to the minimum extent necessary to make such provision valid and enforceable     e  No term or provision of this License shall be deemed waived and no breach consented to unless such  waiver or consent shall be in writing and signed by the party to be charged with such waiver or consent   d  This License constitutes the entire agreement between the parties with respect to the Work licensed    herein  There are no understandings  agreements or representations with respect to the Work not specified herein  The Author  shall not be bound by any additional provisions tha
248. ker  Impedance   European   Australian and  Asian models        6ohms       Set the impedance of the connected speakers     4ohms   When any of the connected speakers have   4 O or more to less than 6 O impedance    6ohms   When the connected speakers all have   6 Q or more impedance   e For impedance  check the indications on the back  of the speakers or their instruction manual        Crossover    Allows you to change speaker configurations  such as crossover frequency  Settings are  automatically configured if you use the Automatic Speaker Setup  Audio will not be output  while you are making this setting     Height    Surround    100 Hz    100 Hz    Select the crossover frequency from  40Hz  to   200Hz  to start outputting frequencies for each  channel     Full Band   Full band will be output    e  Full Band  can be selected only when  Front  is  set to  Full Band     e  f an item cannot be selected even though  connection is correct  check that the settings in   Configuration     Speaker Channels  matches  the number of connected channels     Select the crossover frequency from  40Hz  to   200Hz  to start outputting frequencies for each  channel     Full Band   Full band will be output    e  Full Band  can be selected only when  Front  is  set to  Full Band     e  f an item cannot be selected even though  connection is correct  check that the settings in   Configuration     Speaker Channels  matches  the number of connected channels           Setting Item    Default Valu
249. l 70157  ADVANTAGE 70032  AH  70157  Aiwa 70157  Arcam 70157  Atoll 70157  Atoll Electronique 70157  Audio Research 70157  Audiolab 70157  Audiomeca 70157  Audioton 70157  AVI 70157  Balanced Audio 70157  Technology  BAT 70157  Cairn 70157  California Audio Labs   70029  70303  Cambridge 70157  Cambridge Audio 70157  Carver 70157  CCE 70157  Curtis Mathes 70029                       gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller   Cyrus 70157 Primare 70157  Denon 70766 Proton 70157  DKK 70000 QED 70157  DMX Electronics 70157 Quad 70157  Dynaco 70157 Quasar 70029  Epworth 70157 Radiola 70157  Genexxa 70032  70000 RCA 70032  Goldmund 70157 Restek 70157  Grundig 70157 Revox 70157  Harman Kardon 70157  73044 Rotel 70157  HIFIAkademie 70157 SAE 70157  Hitachi 70032 Sansui 70157  JVC 70072 SAST 70157  Integra 71817 Siemens 70157  Kenwood 70036  70157 Silsonic 70036  Krell 70157 Simaudio 70157  Linn 70157 Sonic Frontiers 10157  Loewe 70157 Sony 70000  70490  Magnavox 70157 Sylvania 70157  Marantz 70157  70029 TAG McLaren 70157  Matsui 70157 TAG McLaren Audio   70157  MCS 70029 Tandy 70032  Memorex 10032 Tascam 73095  73511   Meridian 70157 13533  Micromega 70157 Teac 73095   73931   Miro 70000 73532  73551  Mission 70157 Technics 70303  70029   Myryad 70157 70207  NAD 70721  70000 Thorens 70157  Naim 70157 Thule Audio 70157  New Acoustic 70721  70000 Universum 70197  Dimension Victor 70072  NSM 70157 Wards 70032  70000   Onkyo 71817 70197  Optimus 70032  70000 Yamaha 70036  700
250. lby TrueHD can       Stereo    be selected if back       Multich       speakers or height       Dolby Surround    speakers are not  connected        DTS Neural X       Orchestra         Unplugged         Studio Mix      Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       Dolby Atmos       Orchestra       Unplugged  Studio Mix  AllCh Stereo  Full Mono                   AllCh Stereo                  Full Mono     Input Format    Listening Mode             AllCh Stereo            Full Mono           Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed      Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed    3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be    installed     Input Format    Listening Mode       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed      Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed    3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be    installed     Input Format    Listening Mode    Dolby D          PCM    Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       Dolby Surround  Neo 6 Music        DTS Neural X       Orchestra        Unplugged        Studio Mix         AllCh Stereo      DSD    Pure Audio  European     Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       DSD    2       Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music    DTS Neural X       Orchestra         Unplugged           Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian model
251. lectrocompaniet 32545 Yamaha 32298  33871   Elite 32854 obar  Funai 30675  Harman Kardon 33228  32927 B DVD R  Insignia 32596  32428  Accurian 30675  30675 AEG 30675  Integra 32147  32900  Akai 30675  32910  33100  Aristona 30646  SE pond   CyberHome 31023  JVC 32365  32612 ne  a  39855 Dick Smith Electronics   30675  Lexicon 32545 A seve  LG 31602  32811     30741 Funai 30675                                                                                                    Connections    Initial Setup         Playing Back              gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel     gt Remote Controller                            Amino    01615  01898   01481  02482                                            Bright House    01877  01376   00476                                     01998  02302  British Telecom 02294   03028 Broadstripe 00476  01376  Anguang Network 03936 BSI 02979  Anhui Network 03936 BT 02294  Arcadyan 02952 BT Vision 02294  Arion 03336 Buckeye Cable 01376  00476   Armstrong 01376  00476 System 01877  02187  Arris 02187  01982  C amp M 03407  03319     01998  02378    02962  02979             Arvig Communication  Systems    01376  01982   01998  02345                                     Yamaha 30646   Zenith 30741  BH VCR   DirecTV 20739   Humax 20739   Loewe 21062   Metz 21062  Optimus 21062  Panasonic 21062  20616  Philips 20739  Quasar 21062   RCN 20739  ReplayTV 20616   Sonic Blue 20616   Sony 20636   TiVo 20739  20636                E Cable Set Top Box  A to E     
252. led devices   If the unit is on and the Bluetooth enabled device is   connected  the input will be automatically switched to   BLUETOOTH  Play music in this state    For details on using the remote controller for these   operations  see the Advanced Manual    e  t may take about a minute until connection is  established when the unit is on since the Bluetooth    Advanced Manual    function takes some time to start up    e  f the volume setting on the Bluetooth enabled device is  low  the sound will not be output from this unit    e Due to the characteristics of Bluetooth wireless  technology  the sound produced on this unit may slightly  be behind the sound played on the Bluetooth enabled  device    e The on screen displays are not displayed when the  OSD language is set to Chinese  Operate by confirming  the display on the main unit   European  Australian   Taiwanese and Asian models     5 AM FM Radio       The Basic Manual explains the method using automatic  tuning  For manual tuning  see the Advanced Manual     1  Press TUNER on the main unit several times to  select either  AM  or  FM      2  Press TUNING MODE on the unit  so that the   AUTO  indicator on the display lights     3  Press VTUNINGA on the unit   The automatic tuning to a radio station starts  Searching  stops when one is tuned  When tuned into a radio  station  the   gt  TUNED     indicator on the display lights   The  FM STEREO  indicator lights if the radio station is  an FM radio station    gt  TUNED 4  
253. list of conditions and the  following disclaimer      Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution      Neither the name of the Xiph org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS   OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR                      Connections   Initial Setup    CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF  USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY  WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE    7  libpng  COPYRIGHT NOTICE  DISCLAIMER  and LICENSE   If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices immediately following this sentence   This code is released under the libpng license   libpng versions 1 2 6  August 15  20
254. ller        J4 QE  C oC   C  2 Quer   Geet  areas  c  a34fFa1f1       Co       C CH  V  SC  V          J                                     2  Operate the remote controller by referring to the name  and function of each of the buttons      gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller            E  C ALBUM    TOP MENU AR MENU    L                           TOP MENU  This button displays the top menu for  each media or server     2  AIV  ENTER  These buttons navigate through items  and activate the selected item    lt   gt   These buttons allow you to navigate to other  pages when the list continues on other pages     3   lt  lt   This button fast reverses the current track  This  button is not operable from 10 seconds before the  playback ends     4  k   This button plays the current track from the  beginning  Pressing this button twice plays the  previous track     5        button  Moves the cursor up or down on the  Internet radio stations list in  My Favorites        MENU  This button displays the menu of each  Internet radio service     D RETURN  This button returns to the previous screen      gt     This button fast forwards the current track  This  button is not operable from 10 seconds before the  playback ends     9  gt ei  This button plays the next track                     D H       m    SEARCH REPEAT RANDOM MODE  q2 MOVIE TV   MUSIC   GAME   STEREC   mm ll    S    eese    O  O  O  OO      DISPLAY    e238    e             p  This button starts the playback  
255. lowing for the procedures for configuring  Spotify   www spotify com connect   e The Spotify software is subject to third party licenses  found here   www spotify com connect third party licenses    E Playing Back    Just by clicking the Connect icon in the playback screen   of the Spotify application and selecting this unit  you can  automatically turn this unit on  auto power on function    switch input to the NET position  and start playback of high   quality streaming from Spotify  To enable the auto power on  function  make sure the  Network Standby  setting item in  this unit s Setup is  On      E Notes for using the multi zone function    e To enjoy Spotify music in a separate room  select  zone 2  and manually select  NET  as the input of  the separate room  Also select this unit in the Spotify  application    e Volume adjustment with the Spotify application is  possible only for the equipment connected to the  ZONE2 speaker terminals  If any other terminal is  used for connection  adjust the volume on the audio  equipment placed in a separate room    e To enjoy Spotify music in the main room after playing  itin a separate room  select  NET  as the input of the       srotify    SiriusXM Internet Radio  North American only     If you want to listen to the service  you must subscribe  To  subscribe go to www siriusxm com internetradio with your  computer  When you subscribe  you will be provided with  a username and password which has to be entered into  the AV receiver
256. ls outside the scope of this License   However  linking a  work that uses the Library  with the Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library  because  it contains portions of the Library   rather than a  work that uses the library   The executable is therefore covered by this License   Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables   When a  work that uses the Library  uses material from a header file that is part of the Library  the object code for the work may  be a derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not  Whether this is true is especially significant if the work  can be linked without the Library  or if the work is itself a library  The threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law   If such an object file uses only numerical parameters  data structure layouts and accessors  and small macros and small inline  functions  ten lines or less in length   then the use of the object file is unrestricted  regardless of whether it is legally a derivative  work   Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6    Otherwise  if the work is a derivative of the Library  you may distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6   Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6  whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself   6  As an exception to the Sections above  you may also combine or link a  work that 
257. me clock driver    55 Ulrich Wind   Ulrich  Windl grz uni regensburg de   corrected and validated HTML documents according to the HTML DTD  References   mailto  mark andrews gisc org   mailto  altmeier atlsoft de   mailto  vbais mailman 1  intel co   mailto  kirkwood striderfm intel com   mailto  michael barone Imco com   mailto  Jean Francois Boudreault viagenie qc ca   mailto  karl owl HQ ileaf com   mailto  greg brackley bigfoot com   mailto  Marc Brett westgeo com   mailto  Piete Brooks cl cam ac uk   mailto  reg dwf com   mailto  clift ml csiro au   mailto  casey csc co za   mailto  Sven_Dietrich trimble COM   mailto  dundas salt jpl nasa gov   mailto  duwe immd4 informatik uni erlangen de   mailto  dennis mrbill canet ca   mailto  jhay icomtek csir co za   mailto  glenn herald usask ca   mailto  iglesias uci edu   mailto  jagubox gsfc nasa gov   mailto  jbj chatham usdesign com   mailto  Hans Lambermont nl origin it com   mailto  H1Lambermont chello nl   mailto  phk FreeBSD ORG   http   Awww4 informatik uni erlangen de  7ekardel   mailto  kardel at ntp dot org   mailto  jones hermes chpc utexas edu   mailto  dkatz cisco com   mailto  leres ee  bl gov   mailto  lindholm ucs ubc ca   mailto  louie ni umd edu   mailto  thorinn diku dk   mailto  mayer ntp org   mailto  mills udel edu     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel    mailto  moeller gwdgv1 dnet gwdg de  mailto  mogul pa dec com   mailto  tmoore fievel daytonoh ncr com  mailto  kamal whence com   mailto  derek toybox d
258. mply that this Work is a product of Your own    6  The name of the Author may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from the Work without  the prior written consent of the Author    d  You agree not to sell  lease  or rent any part of the Work  This does not restrict you from including the Work    or any part of the Work inside a larger software distribution that itself is being sold  The Work by itself  though  cannot be sold   leased or rented    e  You may distribute the Executable Files and Source Code only under the terms of this License  and You  must include a copy of  or the Uniform Resource Identifier for  this License with every copy of the Executable Files or Source  Code You distribute and ensure that anyone receiving such Executable Files and Source Code agrees that the terms of this  License apply to such Executable Files and or Source Code  You may not offer or impose any terms on the Work that alter   or restrict the terms of this License or the recipients  exercise of the rights granted hereunder  You may not sublicense the   Work  You must keep intact all notices that refer to this License and to the disclaimer of warranties  You may not distribute   the Executable Files or Source Code with any technological measures that control access or use of the Work in a manner  inconsistent with the terms of this License    f  You agree not to use the Work for illegal  immoral or improper purposes  or on pages containing illegal   immoral or improper mate
259. n  conjunction when the TV is set to output audio from the TV    e Linked system functions with the AV receiver may not work  depending on the component model connected  In such cases   operate the AV receiver directly    e When the player recorder cannot be operated with the remote  controller of the AV receiver  the corresponding component may  not be programmed to support the remote controller operation of  CEC  Program the remote control code of the component maker  to the remote controller for using     About HDMI    HDMI  High Definition Multimedia Interface  is a digital    interface standard for connecting TVs  projectors  Blu    ray Disc DVD players  set top boxes  and other video  components  Until now  several separate video and audio  cables have been required to connect AV components   With HDMI  a single cable can carry control signals  digital  video and digital audio  2 channel PCM  multichannel  digital audio  and multichannel PCM     The HDMI video stream  i e   video signal  is compatible  with DVI  Digital Visual Interface    1   so TVs and displays  with a DVI input can be connected by using an HDMI to   DVI adapter cable   This may not work with some TVs and  displays  resulting in no picture     This unit supports HDCP  High bandwidth Digital Content  Protection    2   so it can display picture only on HDCP   compatible components    HDMI of the unit supports the following functions    Audio Return Channel  3D  x v Color  Deep Color  LipSync   4K  Passt
260. n a person crosses or approaches the space  between the AV receiver and the wireless LAN device    e We assume no responsibility whatsoever for any  damages resulting from the use of this apparatus except  in the cases deemed acceptable under the applicable  laws and regulations    e Operation in all environment is not guaranteed for  wireless LAN  The communication may not be possible  or have desirable communication speed     Precautions    e Do not use this apparatus near an electronic device  handling high accuracy controls or weak signals  Doing  so may cause an accident due to a malfunction of the  device    e Do not use this apparatus in use prohibited location  such as an aircraft equipment or a hospital  Doing so  may cause an accident due to a malfunction of an  electronic device or an electro medical apparatus   Follow the instructions of the medical facilities     E Electronic device which requires cautions   Hearing aid  pace maker  other medical electronic devices   fire alarm  automatic door  and other automatic control  device    When using a pace maker or other medical electronic  devices  confirm with the medical electronic device maker  or dealer for the effect of the radio wave     En 65          Connections Initial Setup Playing Back AdyanceaiVvianual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                                                                                                                                                           
261. nd Source Code or Derivative Work in  aggregate with other  possibly commercial  programs as part of a larger  possibly commercial  software distribution    e  The Articles discussing the Work published in any form by the author may not be distributed or republished    without the Author s consent  The author retains copyright to any such Articles  You may use the Executable Files and Source  Code pursuant to this License but you may not repost or republish or otherwise distribute or make available the Articles  without  the prior written consent of the Author          Remote Controller              Connections   Initial Setup    Any subroutines or modules supplied by You and linked into the Source Code or Executable Files this Work shall not be  considered part of this Work and will not be subject to the terms of this License    Patent License  Subject to the terms and conditions of this License  each Author hereby grants to You a perpetual  worldwide   non exclusive  no charge  royalty free  irrevocable  except as stated in this section  patent license to make  have made  use   import  and otherwise transfer the Work    Restrictions  The license granted in Section 3 above is expressly made subject to and limited by the following restrictions     a  You agree not to remove any of the original copyright  patent  trademark  and attribution notices and  associated disclaimers that may appear in the Source Code or Executable Files    b  You agree not to advertise or in any way i
262. nd even with only two or three  speakers  This works by controlling how sounds reach the  listener s left and right ears     En 17       50          Connections   Total Setup   Playing Back       E TV Logic    Suitable for TV shows produced in a TV studio  This mode  enhances the surround effects to the entire sound to give  clarity to voices and create a realistic acoustic image     E Unplugged    Suitable for acoustic instruments  vocals and jazz  This  mode emphasizes the front stereo image  giving the  impression of being right in front of the stage     En 18     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       Using the Listening Modes             Initial Setup    Connections       Selectable Listening Modes    Listening modes that can be selected with the listening   mode buttons will differ depending on the input signal   format and actual speaker configuration  Also note that   depending on the player settings and content  some   listening modes may not be available for selecting    e Listening modes available when headphones are  connected are  Pure Audio  European  Australian and  Asian models   Mono  Direct  and Stereo     E Future listening mode update    A future firmware update is planned to enable the unit to   support playback in DTS X audio format  For this reason   the available listening modes will vary depending on the   firmware version     Versions before the release of an update with support for  the DTS X audio format  e Neo 6 Cinema and Ne
263. nu  for example    2  Speaker   Make advanced settings for the speakers    3  Audio Adjust   Make a variety of settings related to sound    4  Source   Make settings for input sources  such as volume difference  adjustments for each input selector for the connected  equipment    5  Listening Mode Preset   You can preset your favorite listening mode    6  Hardware   Make a variety of settings such as for linked operation  with connected HDMI equipment  the standby mode and  network connection for this unit    7  Remote Controller   Make settings related to the remote controller    8  Miscellaneous   Update the firmware and perform initial settings  etc     En 29       60       Connections      Initial Setup    Playing Back  gt Remote Controller     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel          1  Input Output Assign HDMI Input    You can change input assignment between the input selectors and HDMI IN jacks        TV Out    Select the HDMI jack to be connected with the TV  Make settings for the on screen display  function on the TV when you use the setting menu  for example        Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details          Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       HDMI Out    MAIN    Select the HDMI jack to be connected with the  TV     MAIN   When connecting the TV to the HDMI  OUT MAIN jack    SUB   When connecting the TV to the HDMI  OUT SUB jack    MAIN SUB   When connecting to both the  MAIN and SUB jacks    BD DVD    CBL SAT    HDMI 1  HDCP  2 2     H
264. o 6 Music are available     Versions that support the DTS X audio format  e DTS X and DTS Neural X are available   Neo 6 Cinema  and Neo 6 Music become unavailable after the update      il MOVIE TV button    You can select a mode suitable for movies and TV  programs     Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller                Input Format    Listening Mode    Input Format       Listening Mode          PCM    Direct  Mono       Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Cinema        DTS Neural X       TV Logic        AllCh Stereo         Full Mono           T D          Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed      Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed    3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be    installed     Input Format    Listening Mode          Input Format Listening Mode       Analog Direct    Multich PCM    Direct       Mono       Multich       DSD       Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format    Direct       Mono             DSD    2          Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Cinema              DTS Neural X       TV Loge            AllCh Stereo
265. o not assign a jack  select          To select an  HDMI IN jack already assigned to another input  selector  change its setting to         first    Video Input    You can change assignment of the COMPONENT VIDEO IN 1 and 2 jacks and the VIDEO    IN 1 to 3 jacks between the input selectors  If you do not assign a jack  select             Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details   PHONO           COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign the  COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the PHONO  button    VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the PHONO button    TV J        COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign the          COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the TV button    VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the TV button           BD DVD    COMPONENT  1     COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign the  COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the BD DVD  button     VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the BD DVD button        CBL SAT    STRM BOX    VIDEO 1    VIDEO 2     COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign the  COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the CBL SAT  button     VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the CBL SAT button      COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign  the COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the STRM  BOX button     VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the STRM BOX button        PC    VIDEO 3     COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign the  COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks t
266. o operate the unit     e Refer to the content of an item  which appears on  the lower left of the screen when the cursor is on the  item     En 12    an mmm       NEEN im      Advanced Manual    5  The test tones sound from the connected speakers    and automatic speaker setting starts   Measurement will be made 3 times or more for each    speaker  It takes several minutes to be completed  Keep    the room as quiet as possible during measurement  If    any of the speakers do not produce the test tone  check    for disconnection     e During measurement  each speaker outputs the test    tones at a high volume  Be careful of sound leak    that may disturb your neighbors  or be careful not to    frighten young children     6  When the measurement is completed  the  measurement result is displayed   Press  lt   gt  on the remote controller to check the  settings  Press ENTER with  Save  selected  Select     On  in the next screen and press ENTER on the remote    controller     e You should normally select  On  All Channels    and    to disable just the front speakers  you should select   On  Except Front Left Right      e If there is an error message  follow the on screen  instruction to remove the error cause     7  When  Please unplug setup microphone   is  displayed  disconnect the microphone     2 Source Connection       You can check the connections on the different inputs and  make HDMI link function settings     1  When the Source Connection start screen is  displayed  sel
267. o the PC button    VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the PC button        GAME    AUX    COMPONENT     COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign  the COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the GAME  button     VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the GAME button     The setting cannot be changed        CD           COMPONENT 1    COMPONENT 2   Assign the  COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks to the CD button    VIDEO 1  to  VIDEO 3   Assign a desired  VIDEO IN jack to the CD button        e When you convert video signals input to the COMPONENT VIDEO IN jacks and output them from the  HDMI OUT jack  set the output resolution of the player to 480i or 576i  If the input has 480p 576p or  higher resolution  an error message will appear     En 31             Connections         Initial Setup    Digital Audio Input    Playing Back    You can change input assignment between the input selectors and DIGITAL IN COAXIAL     OPTICAL 1 to 2 jacks  If you do not assign a jack  select              Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       BD DVD    COAXIAL     COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired DIGITAL IN jack to the BD DVD button                             CBL SAT           COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired DIGITAL IN jack to the CBL SAT button    STRM BOX  j      COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired DIGITAL IN jack to the STRM BOX button    PC        COAXIAL    OPTICAL 1    OPTICAL 2   Assign a  desired 
268. ock         Game Sports         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono    T D             Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode    DTS Direct  DTS   x2       Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG         Game Action         Game Rock         Game Sports         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono    T D       DTS Express Direct   DTS Express    2  Dolby Surround  DTS Neural X  Game RPG    Game Action    Game Rock    Game Sports    AllCh Stereo 4  Full Mono    T D                                        Dolby TrueHD Direct     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch     2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     4 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed        Input Format    Listening Mode             Dolby TrueHD            Dolby Surround       DTS Neural X       Game RPG        
269. om the selected input           Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details   DTS DTS ES  Last Valid Set the listening mode for playing digital audio   DTS HD signals in DTS and DTS HD High Resolution  formats  Select the listening mode specified for  Blu ray or such other DTS HD Master Audio  source    Other Multich Source   Last Valid Set the listening mode for playing DSD signals          of DVD Audio and Super Audio CD that are input  from HDMI IN jack           e The setting cannot be changed when input other than  TUNER    NET  or  BLUETOOTH  is selected     e When input is  NET  or  BLUETOOTH   switch between displaying and not displaying video by    pressing MODE on the remote controller     5  Listening Mode Preset    You can preset your favorite listening mode to each input   For example  you can always  apply straight decode to the Dolby TrueHD source of Blu ray Disc to play it in unchanged    sound field      When the list of input sources is displayed  set the signal type and listening mode   Although it is possible to select the listening mode during playback  the selected mode will  be reset when the unit enters standby mode                 Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details   Analog PCM Last Valid Set the listening mode for playing PCM signals  of CD and analog signals of record and cassette  tape    Mono Multiplex Last Valid Set the listening mode for playing Dolby Digital  and other digital signals recorded in monaural or  multiplex audio    2 ch 
270. omponent with RI jack   The RI cable can be connected in any order  When there  are two RI jacks  both jacks work in the same way and are  interchangeable    To connect the RI Dock or cassette tape deck via RI  the  following settings are required     E Rename the input selector    To make the RI functions work  you must rename the input  selectors on the unit  Press CD or GAME to display  CD   or  GAME  on the main unit display  Then press and hold  CD or GAME 3 seconds or more to switch the display to   DOCK  or  TAPE      E To program the RI remote control code    Program the remote control code to any REMOTE MODE  button on the remote controller  This will allow you to  operate the component by pointing the remote controller at  the unit instead of the component    1  Press and hold DISPLAY for 3 or more seconds while  holding down the REMOTE MODE button to which you  want to program the remote control code    e The remote indicator will light   e  he RECEIVER and ZONE2 buttons cannot be  programmed     QUOC  See  Pro    OO      DISPLAY          2  With the number buttons  enter the following 5 digit   remote control code within 30 seconds    RI Dock  81993   Cassette tape deck with RI jack  42157   e Programming is complete when the remote indicator   flashes twice  The remote indicator flashes once  slowly when programming the remote control code  fails  Try programming again                    Input selector on the RI Dock  Switch to  DOCK  or   TAPE   For details  ref
271. one will be output each time you change  the value  Select the desired level     Front 0 dB First select the frequency of the speaker from   25 Hz  to  16 kHz  with the  lt     cursors  then  use Alf to adjust the volume of the frequency  between   6dB  to   6dB      Center 0 dB First select the frequency of the speaker from   25 Hz  to  16 kHz  with the ap cursors  then  use Alf to adjust the volume of the frequency  between   6dB  to   6dB            Back Right    0 dB    Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB     A test tone will be output each time you change   the value  Select the desired level    e This setting cannot be changed if   Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to   Yes  and Zone2 is set to on        Back Left    Surround Left    0 dB    0 dB    Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB     A test tone will be output each time you change   the value  Select the desired level    e This setting cannot be changed if   Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to   Yes  and Zone2 is set to on     Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB    A test tone will be output each time you change  the value  Select the desired level     Height 0 dB First select the frequency of the speaker from    25 Hz  to  16 kHz  with the ap cursors  then   use A F to adjust the volume of the frequency   between   6dB  to   6dB     e  his cannot be selected if  Configuration      Powered Zone 2  is set to  Yes  and Zone2  is set to on        Surround 0 dB First select the fr
272. onnections       Initial Setup         Playing Back                                                                                                                               Comag 02797  02026   02458  02813   02308  01413   Comsat 01413   Comwell 01956   Continent 01986   Coship 03787  03790   01672  02525   03574   Cosmos TV 01545   Croner 02813   Crown 01284   Crypto 03012   Crystal 03012  01416   Cyfra  00853  01409                Cyfrowy Polsat    02262  02527   00253  00853                                                                                                 Dantax 01626  Danystar 02938  DASAN 03321  D box 01114  DCR 03517  Delta 02443  Denver 02418  02738  Deutsche Telekabel 01195  01197  Dgtec 01631  02418                Dick Smith Electronics    02418  02813                Dicra    02738  02842   03012    DigitalBox 02540  01631   02289  01100   03240   DigitSat e 02842   Digiturk 03517  02097   Digiwave 01631   Dikom 02938  02842   Dilog 01957  01780   DiPro 02278   DirecTV 01377  01442   00099   Dish Mexico 00775   Dish Network 00775   DishHD 04090   Dishpro 00775   DishTV 01300  02604   01780   Di Way 02289   DMT 03321   DMTech 02738   DNA 01780  01957   01176  02144   Donghai 02938   Doro 01672   DragonSat 02928   DRE 02622   Dream 01237             Dream Multimedia    01237  01652   01923                Dream Satellite TV    01416  03374       DSE    02418  02813             D Smart    02231                Digenius 00299  00740   Digi 01416  01195 
273. operating the PC inside your home network  The unit  supports remote playback with Windows Media   Player 12   To use the remote playback function with Windows Media    Player 12  Windows Media Player 12 must be configured in  advance    e Using a DLNA compatible controller  Such as an  Android application   you can select a music file stored  on Windows Media   Player 12 and stream to this unit  by operating the controller  For information on how to  remotely play using the controller  refer to the controller s  instruction manual     ll Setting PC  1  Turn on your PC and start Windows Media  Player 12     2  In the  Stream  menu  select  Turn on media streaming   to display a dialog box   e  f media streaming is already turned on  select  More  streaming options     in the  Stream  menu to list  players in the network  and then go to step 4     3  Click  Turn on media streaming  to list players in the  network    4  Select this unit in  Media streaming options  and check  that it is set to  Allow      5  Click  OK  to close the dialog box    6  Open the  Stream  menu and check that  Allow remote  control of my Player     is checked    e Depending on the version of Windows Media  Player     the names of the items you need to select may differ  from the explanation here     E Remote playback  1  Turn on the power of the unit   2  Turn on your PC and start Windows Media  Player 12   3  Select and right click the music file to play with Windows  Media  Player 12   e To remotely
274. or Wi Fi  listening to the broadcast for the first time  adjust the settings     antenna position and orientation to get the best reception     Internet radio  AM loop antenna   supplied    HE  Router  Indoor FM antenna     supplied      ge i  e  CERTIFIED NAS    Fix with a tack on  the wall                     Headphones connection   Connect stereo headphones with a standard plug  1 4   inch or   6 3 mm  to the PHONES jack on the front panel   Sound from the speakers will be off while you are using the  headphones    e  f you selected any other listening mode than Pure  Audio  European  Australian and Asian models   Stereo   Mono and Direct  connecting headphones will switch the   Assemble the AM loop antenna  supplied   listening mode to Stereo      North American and  European  Australian  Taiwanese models  and Asian models        Power cord   Taiwanese models include removable power cords   Connect the power cord to AC INLET of the unit and then  connect to the outlet  Always disconnect the outlet side  first when disconnecting the power cord  When the unit is  turned on  a large instantaneous current may flow affecting  functionality of the computer and other devices  so it is  recommended to use a separate outlet        En 10           Connections      Playing Back    Advanced Manual    Initial Setup     Initial Setup  automatically starts on the TV when you first  turn the unit on           ON STANDBY          DOLBY ATMOS                      BD DVD       Settings proc
275. ore starting  please connect speakers and sources   Now  would you like to start initial setup    1st Step   AccuEQ Room Calibration   2nd Step   Source Connection   3rd Step   Remote Mode Setup   4th Step   Network Connection    Yes  No       Re doing initial setup  If you terminate the  procedure on the way or change the setting made in  the initial setup and want to call up the setup wizard  again  press    RECEIVER and then SETUP on the  remote controller  select  8  Miscellaneous     Initial  Setup   and press ENTER      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       1 AccuEQ Room Calibration       The test tone coming from each speaker will be measured  to enable setting of the number of speakers  volume  level  each speaker s optimum crossover frequencies   and distance from the primary listening position  and also  enable correction of distortion caused by the room acoustic  environment    e You cannot return to the previous screen during speaker   setup  even if you press RETURN     1  Place the speaker setup microphone           Initial Setup B      e    AccuEQ Room Calibration  This step you can automatically calibrate  your room to get correct surround sound  uN  Would you like to calibrate your room now  or later     Do it Now  Do it Later          When the screen above is displayed  before starting the  procedure  place the supplied speaker setup microphone  at the measurement position   by referring to the following  figure                          
276. ork are not derived from the Program   and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves  then this License  and its terms  do not apply  to those sections when you distribute them as separate works  But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole  which is a work based on the Program  the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License  whose permissions for  other licensees extend to the entire whole  and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it    Thus  it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you  rather  the intent is to  exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Program    In addition  mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the Program  or with a work based on the  Program  on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License    You may copy and distribute the Program  or a work based on it  under Section 2  in object code or executable form under the  terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following     a  Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine readable source code  which must be distributed  under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange or   b  Accompany it with a written offer  valid for at least three years  to g
277. orks  within the Source form or documentation  if provided along with the Derivative Works  or  within a display generated   by the Derivative Works  if and wherever such third party notices normally appear  The contents of the NOTICE file are for  informational purposes only and do not modify the License  You may add Your own attribution notices within Derivative Works  that You distribute  alongside or as an addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work  provided that such additional attribution  notices cannot be construed as modifying the License     You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and may provide additional or different license terms and  conditions for use  reproduction  or distribution of Your modifications  or for any such Derivative Works as a whole  provided Your  use  reproduction  and distribution of the Work otherwise complies with the conditions stated in this License     Submission of Contributions     Unless You explicitly state otherwise  any Contribution intentionally submitted for inclusion in the Work by You to the Licensor  shall be under the terms and conditions of this License  without any additional terms or conditions    Notwithstanding the above  nothing herein shall supersede or modify the terms of any separate license agreement you may have  executed with Licensor regarding such Contributions     Trademarks     This License does not grant permission to use the trade names  trademarks  service marks  or product names of th
278. ote that linked operation is not always guaranteed with all  CEC devices     Operation has been confirmed on the following devices  as of   February 2015     TV  Random order     e Toshiba TV sets   e Sharp TV sets   Players Recorders  Random order     e Onkyo and Integra RIHD compatible players   e Toshiba players and recorders   e Sharp players and recorders  only when used together with  Sharp TV sets     Caution  For linking functions to work properly  do not connect more   RIHD compatible components than the quantities specified below    to the HDMI jacks  Linking functions are not guaranteed when more   RIHD compatible components than the below mentioned quantities   are connected  Furthermore  do not connect the AV receiver to   another AV receiver AV amplifier via HDMI    e Blu ray Disc DVD players  up to 3    e Blu ray Disc DVD recorders  up to 3    e Cable TV tuner  terrestrial digital tuner  and satellite broadcasting  tuner  up to 4 units     Checking whether the HDMI Linked Operation  Settings Are Enabled      Turn on the power of all connected components      Turn off the power of the TV  and confirm that the power  of the connected components is turned off automatically  with the link operation    3  Turn on the power of the Blu ray Disc DVD player     N        En 62      Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       recorder    4  Start playback on the Blu ray Disc DVD player recorder   and verify the following    e The AV recei
279. played on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the  cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER  to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen   press RETURN                                               Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       E Operation    1  Press RECEIVER on the remote controller    e Always press RECEIVER first to change the remote  controller to RECEIVER mode  the mode to operate  this unit  since its mode may be changed to operate  another component    a a 2t tL J  OOW  ico deca    e OO CO  ONN     2  Press SETUP to display the Setup menu     y  e OQ  QO    GEES SE                                                       3  Press A Y to select the desired menu  and then press  ENTER        CH Setup    4 Input OutputAssign ATWO   2  Speaker 2 HDMI Input   3  Audio Adjust 3  Video Input   4  Source 4  Digital Audio Input  5  Listening Mode Preset   6  Hardware   T  Remote Controller    8  Miscellaneous          4  Press A Y to select the item  and then press ENTER     Advanced Settings  Setup Menu     5  With the Af cursors  select the item to configure  the settings            1 1  TV Out    HDMI Out MAIN  OSD Language English  Impose OSD On    Screen Saver 3 minutes          To exit the setup menu  press SETUP     Overview of the Setup menu    1  Input Output Assign   Make settings to assign the various jacks and for the on   screen display function on the TV when you use the setting  me
280. quickly access the frequently used setting items  including sound quality adjustment    DISPLAY button  Switches the information on the  display     En 15    50           Connections Initial Setup    2 Network Functions       You can enjoy sources such as Internet radio by connecting  the unit to a network  For details on the operation  see the  Advanced Manual    e The on screen displays are not displayed when the  OSD language is set to Chinese  Operate by confirming  the display on the main unit   European  Australian   Taiwanese and Asian models                                               Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen on the TV  Select the item with the cursors of  the remote controller and press ENTER to confirm your  selection     k To return to the previous screen  press RETURN      Available services may vary depending on your area of residence      tunein    SiriusXM Internet Radio  Slacker Personal Radio  Deezer  AUPEO  PERSONAL RADIO  AirPlay       Internet radio services    The unit comes preset with Internet radio services     such  as Tuneln  After selecting the desired service  follow the  on screen instructions  using the cursors to select radio  stations and programs  then press ENTER to play     dina DLNA    You can play music files stored in the computer or NAS  device connected to the network  Select the server with the  cursors  select the desired music file and press ENTER to  start playback     En 16    Advanced Man
281. r and the unit are  connected via HDMI cable    Connect the player using a digital optical cable   OPTICAL   digital coaxial cable  COAXIAL   or RCA  cable  Also  some players require audio output setting   Only analog and 2ch PCM audio signals can be output  from an external component to Zone 2    When the  NET  input source is selected  DSD and  Dolby TrueHD audio signals cannot be output to Zone 2     Remote Controller    e Make sure that the batteries are installed with the  correct polarity    e Install new batteries  Do not mix different types of  batteries  or old and new batteries    e Make sure that the remote controller is not too far away  from the unit  and that there is no obstruction between  the remote controller and the remote control sensor of  the unit    e Make sure that the unit is not subjected to direct  sunshine or inverter type fluorescent lights  Relocate if  necessary    e If the unit is installed in a rack or cabinet with colored   glass doors or if the doors are closed  the remote  controller may not work reliably     If the above does not solve the problem  check the  following     B The remote controller does not work  e Before operating this unit with the remote controller  be  sure to press RECEIVER     Bl Operating other Onkyo component by using a RI   remote control code is not available   e Make sure that the Onkyo component is properly  connected with RI cable  When RI cable is used for  connection  make sure to connect analog audio cable a
282. r level adjustment   e You cannot select this item when audio is output from  the TV s speakers     Bass  Treble  Adjust volume of the front speaker   e  t cannot be set if the listening mode is Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models  or Direct     will change to  BLUETOOTH  accordingly   When listening to AM FM broadcasting  you cannot    while you are using the remote controller for Zone 2 will  switch the controlled target to the main room  To control    Phase Matching Bass  Suppress phase shift in the  midrange to enhance bass sound  Thus smooth and    select different stations for the main room and separate  room  Therefore broadcasting of the same station will be  heard in the both rooms     Playing Back   1  Press ZONE2 on the remote controller  point  the remote controller at the main unit and press  ORECEIVER    Z2  lights on the main unit display and the multi zone  function is enabled   Zone 2 is now on                  es  CE OE 2     Ke     eer   ONM     2  Press ZONE2 again on the remote controller and  press INPUT SELECTOR of the input to be played in  a separate room    e  f you turn the unit to standby during multi zone  playback  the Z2 indicator is dimmed and the  playback mode is switched to playback in a separate  room only  Performing steps 1 and 2 while the unit  is in standby also switches the playback mode to  playback in a separate room only  To play the same  source in the main room and separate room  hold  down ZONE2 for approximately 3
283. r to power it     Turn off the controller component  PC etc   connected to    e If the USB storage device has been partitioned  each  section will be treated as an independent device     5  After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller   press SETUP                C OCC     C    CE              Gei MODE   acts                C  C  N                      2    SE                      d        gt C      gt              En 55            Connections   Initial Setup       The Setup menu is displayed on the TV screen        CH Setup    T  InputOutputAssign   1TVOut   2  Speaker 2 HDMI Input  3  Audio Adjust 3  Video Input   4  Source 4  Digital Audio Input  5  Listening Mode Preset   6  Hardware   7  Remote Controller    8  Miscellaneous             6  With the cursors  select  8  Miscellaneous     Firmware  Update     Update via USB   and then press ENTER        ix Setup    1  Input Output Assign 1  Firmware Update  2  Speaker 2  Initial Setup   3  Audio Adjust 3  Lock   4  Source   5  Listening Mode Preset   6  Hardware   T  Remote Controller    8  Miscellaneous             e  f  Firmware Update  is grayed out and cannot be  selected  wait for a while until it starts up    e You will not be able to select  Update via USB  if  there is nothing to update     7  Press ENTER with  Update  selected to start update    e During the update  the TV screen may go black  depending on the updated program  In that case   check the progress on the display of the unit  The TV  screen will rem
284. radio station you want to register     2  Press MEMORY on the unit so that the preset number  on the display flashes     r    CLEAR    4  DIMMER MEMORY TUNING MODE             3  Press   PRESET several times to select a number  between 1 and 40 while the preset number is flashing   about 8 seconds      Y TUNING A       PRESET                  Initial Setup    Connections       4  Press MEMORY again to register the station   e When the station is registered  the preset number  stops flashing   e Repeat this procedure for all of your favorite AM FM  radio stations     ll Selecting a Preset Radio Station    1  Press CH     on the remote controller to select a preset  number    e Alternatively you can press   PRESET on the  main unit  You can also select by directly entering  the preset number with the number buttons on the  remote controller     aie Coco    08    E                                           ll Deleting a Preset Radio Station    1  Press CH     on the remote controller to select the  preset number to delete     2 lt  RU    2  Press and hold MEMORY on the main unit and press  TUNING MODE to delete the preset number   e When deleted  the number on the display goes off                                            r    CLEAR    4  DIMMER MEMORY TUNING MODE DISPLAY                              Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller       Using RDS  European  Australian and Asian  models     RDS stands for Radio Data System and is a metho
285. rch for     Y TUNING        PRESET            e The following RDS station types are displayed   None  News  News reports   Affairs  Current affairs   Info  Information   Sport  Educate  Education   Drama  Culture  Science  Science and technology   Varied  Pop M  Pop music   Rock M  Rock music   Easy M  Middle of the road music   Light M  Light classics   Classics  Serious classics   Other M  Other music   Weather  Finance  Children  Children s programmes   Social  Social affairs   Religion  Phone In  Travel  Leisure  Jazz  Jazz music   Country  Country music   Nation M  National music   Oldies  Oldies music   Folk M  Folk music   Document  Documentary     En 3          EN m         m  Connections Initial Setup Playing Back    gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          Details on AM FM reception   Playing Music Files on a USB Storage Device    3  Press ENTER to search the radio stations of the  selected type           Playing Music Files on a USB                SETUP ENTER RETURN                                                                                                                                               E     Storage Device sum E  4  When such a radio station is found  the indication on the  display flashes  Then  press ENTER again  m   2  Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  e  f no stations are found  the message  Not Found  is e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance TOP screen   displayed  displayed on the TV s
286. receiver contains a microPC for signal IL   processing and control functions  In very rare situations  O A  8    severe interference  noise from an external source  or iuc   static electricity may cause it to lockup  In the unlikely as   a   event that this happens  unplug the power cord from the tC eC ae   wall outlet  wait at least 5 seconds  and then plug it back  i ana ss   In      REMOTE MODE  e Onkyo is not responsible for damages  such as CD  b E     C 29   rental fees  due to unsuccessful recordings caused by d et YL   the unit s malfunction  Before you record important data  ue    r1   make sure that the material will be recorded correctly  OEC   e KCN    e N  Resetting the unit  Power   Resetting the unit to the status at the time of shipment  may solve the problem  If the measures mentioned in the E Cannot turn on the unit  troubleshooting do not solve the problem  reset the unit e Make sure that the power cord is properly plugged into  with the following procedure  If you reset the unit status  the wall outlet     Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet  wait 5  seconds or more  then plug it in again     down  the case  when you turn the unit on again   AMP Diag  2  Press OON STANDBY on the main unit   Clear  is Mode  will appear on the main unit s display  The unit  appeared on the display and the unit will enter standby will then enter a mode that detects abnormal conditions     If no problems are detected   AMP Diag Mode  will  disappear and the unit will re
287. rent station        50      Remote Controller          Connections Initial Setup       Why is this track playing   Discover some of the  musical attributes that Pandora uses to create your  personal radio stations     l m tired of this track  If you are tired of a track  you  can put the track to sleep and Pandora will not play it for  one month     Create station from this artist  Creates a radio station  from this artist     Create station from this track  Creates a radio station  from this track     Delete this station  This will permanently delete a  station from your Pandora account  All of your thumbs  feedback will be lost should you choose to re create the  station with the same track or artist     Rename this station  Lets you rename the current  radio station     Bookmark this artist  Pandora will bookmark your  favorite artist for your profile on www pandora com     Bookmark this track  Pandora will bookmark the  current track and allow you to buy them all from Amazon  or iTunes in one step     Add to My Favorites  Adds a station to My Favorites  list     PANDORA    PANDORA  the PANDORA logo  and the Pandora trade  dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of Pandora  Media  Inc  Used with permission     Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       Spotify    This unit is compatible with Spotify Connect  To enable  Spotify Connect  install the Spotify application on your  smartphone or tablet and create a Spotify premium  account   e Refer to the fol
288. required by applicable law or agreed to in writing  software distributed under the License is distributed on an  AS IS   BASIS  WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND  either express or implied    See the License for the specific language governing permissions and limitations under   the License     16  Boost   http   www boost org    Boost Software License   Version 1 0   August 17th  2003   Permission is hereby granted  free of charge  to any person or organization obtaining a copy of the software and accompanying  documentation covered by this license  the  Software   to use  reproduce  display  distribute  execute  and transmit the Software   and to prepare derivative works of the Software  and to permit third parties to whom the Software is furnished to do so  all subject  to the following    The copyright notices in the Software and this entire statement  including the above license grant  this restriction and the  following disclaimer  must be included in all copies of the Software  in whole or in part  and all derivative works of the Software   unless such copies or derivative works are solely in the form of machine executable object code generated by a source language  processor    THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  AS IS   WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING BUT  NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  TITLE AND NON   INFRINGEMENT  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE DISTRIBUTING THE SOFT
289. rial  The Work is subject to applicable export laws  You agree to comply with all such laws and  regulations that may apply to the Work after Your receipt of the Work    Representations  Warranties and Disclaimer  THIS WORK IS PROVIDED  AS IS    WHERE IS  AND  AS AVAILABLE    WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OR GUARANTEES  YOU  THE USER  ASSUME  ALL RISK IN ITS USE  INCLUDING COPYRIGHT INFRINGEMENT  PATENT INFRINGEMENT  SUITABILITY  ETC  AUTHOR  EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ALL EXPRESS  IMPLIED OR STATUTORY WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS  INCLUDING  WITHOUT LIMITATION  WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY  MERCHANTABLE QUALITY OR FITNESS  FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  OR ANY WARRANTY OF TITLE OR NON INFRINGEMENT  OR THAT THE WORK  OR ANY  PORTION THEREOF  IS CORRECT  USEFUL  BUG FREE OR FREE OF VIRUSES  YOU MUST PASS THIS DISCLAIMER ON  WHENEVER YOU DISTRIBUTE THE WORK OR DERIVATIVE WORKS    Indemnity  You agree to defend  indemnify and hold harmless the Author and the Publisher from and against any claims  suits   losses  damages  liabilities  costs  and expenses  including reasonable legal or attorneys  fees  resulting from or relating to any  use of the Work by You    Limitation on Liability  EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW  IN NO EVENT WILL THE AUTHOR OR  THE PUBLISHER BE LIABLE TO YOU ON ANY LEGAL THEORY FOR ANY SPECIAL  INCIDENTAL  CONSEQUENTIAL   PUNITIVE OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THIS LICENSE OR THE USE OF THE WORK OR OTHERWISE   E
290. rmation you have  entered  use    Y         to select  OK  then press ENTER   An account information confirmation screen appears     5  If you do not have an account  select  Access without  Sign In  and press ENTER to use a restricted version of  the service  Note that use will be restricted    e  f you want to use multiple user accounts  see  Using  Multiple Accounts   Login can be made from the   Users  screen     6  Use A    to select a menu item and then press ENTER   To sign out  use    Y to select  Sign out  from this screen  and then press ENTER      Use    Y to select a station and then press ENTER or P    to start playback from the station  The playback screen  appears    8  You can control the tracks with the buttons on the   remote control   Enabled buttons     II  E  Ki    N    Rate Song as Favorite  Stores information to server   making it more likely that the song will be played again     Ban Song  Stores information to server  making it less  likely that the song will be played again     Ban Artist  Stores information to server  making it less  likely that the songs from this artist will be played again     Mark Favorite  Adds the currently playing station to  your favorites     Unmark Favorite  Deletes the currently playing station  from your favorites     Add song to Library  Adds the currently playing track  to your library     Delete song from Library  Deletes the currently  playing track from your library     Add to My Favorites  Adds a station or song to
291. rmitted only in or  among countries not thus excluded  In such case  this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the  body of this License    13  The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and or new versions of the Lesser General Public License  from time to time  Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version  but may differ in detail to  address new problems or concerns    Each version is given a distinguishing version number  If the Library specifies a version number of this License which applies to   it and  any later version   you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version   published by the Free Software Foundation  If the Library does not specify a license version number  you may choose any  version ever published by the Free Software Foundation    14  If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose distribution conditions are  incompatible with these  write to the author to ask for permission  For software which is copyrighted by the  Free Software Foundation  write to the Free Software Foundation  we sometimes make exceptions for this  Our  decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and  of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally    NO WARRANTY   15  BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE  THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY  TO THE  EXTENT PERMITTED
292. round speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed      1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     7 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed     4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed      1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed       Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed              En 23       AN       Connections   Initial Setup       Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format Listening Mode             DTS HD MSTR Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       DTS HD MSTR     2       Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music         DTS Neural X
293. rround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode    Dolby TrueHD Direct  Mono       Dolby TrueHD            Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Cinema          DTS Neural X       TV Logic         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono            T D     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode    DTS 96 24 Direct               Mono  DTS 96 24       Dolby Surround             Neo 6 Cinema    DTS Neural X  TV Loge    AllCh Stereo    Full Mono   T D                         Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed       Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     
294. s        Direct       Stereo  Dolby D       Dolby Surround  Neo 6 Music   DTS Neural X  Orchestra                                Unplugged    Studio Mix    AllCh Stereo     Full Mono                  1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch        Studio Mix       2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed        AllCh Stereo       3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker    or surround speakers are installed           Full Mono        4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed      5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be             Full Mono            Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed      Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed    3 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be    installed        En 22       Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be    installed     installed                 Connections Initial Setup         Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller                Input Format Listening Mode    Input Format Listening Mode    Input Forma
295. s  well   Connecting only an RI cable will not be enough     e Make sure you have selected the correct remote  controller mode        50      Remote Controller          Connections Initial Setup       e When the RI remote control code is input  point the  remote controller at remote control sensor of the unit    e Make sure that the input display is correctly set    e Input the RI remote control code again     Bl Cannot operate Onkyo components  ones without RI   connection  and components of other makers   e Operate the remote controller by setting toward the light  receiving section of each component    e When using the remote controller to control other  manufacturers  AV components  some buttons may not  work as expected  Also  some components may not  operate at all    e Make sure you have selected the correct remote  controller mode    e Make sure you have entered the correct remote control  code    e Make sure to set the same ID on both the unit and  remote controller    e Input a correct remote control code again  If there are  several codes  try each code     Display and OSD    B The display does not light   e Make sure that Dimmer function is not working  Press  DIMMER button and change the brightness level of the  display    e The display is turned off when the Pure Audio   European  Australian and Asian models  listening mode  is selected     E The on screen menus do not appear   e On your TV  make sure that the video input to which this  unit is connected is sele
296. s GmbH  UK Branch   Meridien House  Ground floor  69   71 Clarendon Road   Watford  Hertfordshire  WD17 1DS  United Kingdom  Tel   44  0 8712 00 19 96 Fax   44  0 8712 00 19 95  China   Onkyo China Limited  Hong Kong    Unit 1033  10 F  Star House  No 3  Salisbury Road   Tsim Sha Tsui Kowloon  Hong Kong    Tel  852 2429 3118 Fax  852 2428 9039  http   www hk onkyo com      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel    Onkyo China PRC  Mainland    1301  555 Tower  No 555 West NanJing Road  Jing   an District   Shanghai  China 200041    Tel  86 21 52131366 Fax  86 21 52130396  http   www cn onkyo com     Asia  Oceania  Middle East  Africa   Please contact an Onkyo distributor referring to Onkyo  SUPPORT site    http   www intl onkyo com support     The above mentioned information is subject to change  without prior notice   Visit the Onkyo web site for the latest update        F1502 0     2940 197 9      50            Remote Controller          Connections Initial Setup Playing Back   d  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller          ONKYO       The Basic Manual includes information needed when starting up    and also instructions for frequently used operations   he Advanced  Manual has more detailed information and advanced settings         AV RECEIVER    Advanced Manual    CONTENTS  Details on AM FM reception 2 Operating Music Files with the Remote Controller 15 TV operation 48  Tuning into a Radio Station 2 About the Remote Controller 15 Blu ray Disc player DVD player DV
297. s function can be used in the following listening  modes  Dolby Digital  Dolby Digital Plus  Dolby TrueHD   Multichannel  DTS  DTS ES  DTS 96 24  DTS HD High  Resolution Audio  DTS HD Master Audio  DTS Express   DSD     B How dol change the language of a multiplex source  e Select  Main  or  Sub  for  3  Audio Adjust     Multiplex   Mono     Multiplex Input Channel      E Cannot connect to the AV receiver from a Web   browser   e Make sure that the IP address of the AV receiver is  correctly input to the Internet browser    e When DHCP is used for allocating the IP address  the IP  address of this AV receiver may have been changed    e Make sure that both AV receiver and PC are properly  connected to the network     E Power consumption in standby mode  e In the following cases  the power consumption in   standby mode may reach up to a maximum of 4 4 W        When  Network Standby  in  6  Hardware     Power  Management     Network  is set to  On         When  HDMI CEC  RIHD   is set to  On    Depending  on the TV status  this unit will enter normal standby  mode         The  HDMI Standby Through  setting is set to other  than  Off         When  Bluetooth Wakeup  in  6  Hardware     Power  Management  is set to  On         When  USB Power Out at Standby  is set to  On     En 61       50      Remote Controller          Connections Initial Setup       Linked Operation with CEC compatible  Components    Link operation with a product conforming to the CEC of the  HDMI standard    N
298. s of the Bluetooth enabled  device connected to the unit     Ready   Not paired    Pairing   Pairing    Connected   Successfully connected                Auto Input Change    The input of the unit will automatically be   switched to  BLUETOOTH  when connection is   made from a Bluetooth enabled device to the   unit     On   The input will automatically become    BLUETOOTH  when a Bluetooth enabled   device is connected     Off   The function is disabled    e If the input is not switched automatically  set  to  Off  and change the input manually        Auto Reconnect    This function automatically reconnects to the  Bluetooth enabled device connected last when    you change the input selector to  BLUETOOTH       On   Use this function    Off   Do not use this function   e This may not work with some Bluetooth   enabled devices        Pairing Information          The information of the previous pairing stored in  this unit will be initialized    Pressing ENTER when  Clear  is displayed   initializes the pairing information stored in this   unit    e This function does not initialize the pairing  information on the Bluetooth enabled device   When pairing the unit again with the device   be sure to clear the pairing information on  the Bluetooth enabled device in advance   For information on how to clear the pairing  information  refer to the Bluetooth enabled  device s instruction manual        Device   Displays the name of the Bluetooth enabled  device connected to the unit   e
299. s selected     ARC   Audio signals are  input from ARC compatible TV and TV input selector  is selected     3D   Input signals are 3D     USB         NET  input is selected and USB storage device is  connected     NET    gt     NET  input is selected and  the unit is connected to the network     DIGITAL     Digital signals are input and the digital input selector is  selected    Cursor indicators  NET or USB is controlled       USB  and  NET  will flash if the connection is not correct     2  Stays lit when headphones are connected     3  Lights when NET or USB is controlled     4  Lights according to the type of input digital signals and  the listening mode         Stays lit when Music Optimizer is enabled         Lights in the following conditions   AUTO   Tuning mode  is auto      gt  TUNED  lt 4   Receiving AM FM radio      lt   flashes while tuning is automatically performed     FM  STEREO   Receiving FM stereo     RDS   European   Australian and Asian models   Receiving RDS  broadcasting    D  MUTING   Flashes when muting is on    Lights in the following conditions   SLEEP   Sleep timer  has been set     ASb   Auto Standby   Auto Standby  is on     ch   Channel is being set     Hz   Crossover  frequencies are being set     m ft   Speaker distances  are being set     dB   Speaker volume is being set     9  Displays various information of the input signals   Pressing DISPLAY displays the type of input digital  signals and the listening mode          Initial Setup         
300. same place counts as distribution of the source code  even though third parties are not  compelled to copy the source along with the object code    You may not copy  modify  sublicense  or distribute the Program except as expressly provided under this License  Any attempt  otherwise to copy  modify  sublicense or distribute the Program is void  and will automatically terminate your rights under   this License  However  parties who have received copies  or rights  from you under this License will not have their licenses  terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance    You are not required to accept this License  since you have not signed it  However  nothing else grants you permission to modify  or distribute the Program or its derivative works  These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this License  Therefore   by modifying or distributing the Program  or any work based on the Program   you indicate your acceptance of this License to do  so  and all its terms and conditions for copying  distributing or modifying the Program or works based on it    Each time you redistribute the Program  or any work based on the Program   the recipient automatically receives a license from  the original licensor to copy  distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions  You may not impose any  further restrictions on the recipients  exercise of the rights granted herein  You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by  third parties to t
301. sic files in a shared folder  you must first  configure Windows   8 or Windows   7  Make sure the unit  and PC or NAS device are connected to the same router                                                                                      Router       e The sharing options must be configured and a shared  folder created on the PC in advance    e For information on how to configure the NAS device  and create a shared folder  refer to the NAS device s  instruction manual     Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       Setting PC    E Configuring the Sharing Options    1  Select  Choose home group and sharing options  on the   Control Panel    e If the menu is not displayed  check whether  View  by  is set to  Category      2  Select  Change advanced sharing settings      3  Check whether the following radio buttons are selected  in  Home or Work     Enable network discovery    Turn on file and printer sharing    Turn on sharing so anyone with network access can  read and write files in the Public folders     Turn off password protected sharing     4  Select  Save Changes  and click  OK  on the dialog box     ll Creating a Shared Folder     Select and right click the folder to share      Select  Properties       Select  Advanced Sharing  on the  Sharing  tab      Select the  Share this folder  check box and click  OK      Select  Share  for  Network File and Folder Sharing        Select  Everyone  from the pull down menu  Click  Add    and then  Share     e To se
302. since you have not signed it  However  nothing else grants you  permission to modify or distribute the Library or its derivative works  These actions are prohibited by law if you  do not accept this License  Therefore  by modifying or distributing the Library  or any work based on the  Library   you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so  and all its terms and conditions for copying   distributing or modifying the Library or works based on it    10  Each time you redistribute the Library  or any work based on the Library   the recipient automatically receives  a license from the original licensor to copy  distribute  link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and  conditions  You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients    exercise of the rights granted herein    You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License    11  If  as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason  not  limited to patent issues   conditions are imposed on you  whether by court order  agreement or otherwise  that  contradict the conditions of this License  they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License  If you  cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent  obligations  then as a consequence you may not distribute the Library at all  For example  if a patent license  would not permit royalty free redistribut
303. source    select  OK  and press ENTER  In this case  in the Blu ray Disc Player settings try setting  BD   E WEP method video supplementary sound   or secondary sound  to  Off     Select  WEP  in  Security Method  and select 7 Terminating initial setup T the listening mode after changing the setting to     Default Key ID   Then select  OK  and press    ENTER  CO   em     i  a  Pencryption setting has net been maderon the After finishing the initial setup  keep  Finished  selected    wireless LAN router  select  None  in  Security Ri i midi on the ed controller  Connection and  Method   select  OK  and press ENTER  SEWING OLE UNIS NOW COMPETE     E if you selected  Use iOS Device  iOS7 or  later      2  On the iOS device  go to  Settings   Wi Fi  and turn  on the setting  then select this unit in  SETUP NEW  AIRPLAY SPEAKER      3  Tap  Next      B When connection is successful     Successfully Connected  is displayed on the screen     CH Network Connection    v MAC Address XXXXXXXXXXX    v IP Address  Subnet Mask  Gateway  DNS Server  v Gateway Ping  v Internet Service Test   Successfully connected        Next          If the screen is not displayed  try doing the setting again    If  Push Button  connection with the wireless LAN router   does not work  try  Enter Password     e A confirmation screen asking you to agree to the  privacy policy is displayed after connection  Select   Yes  and press ENTER to indicate agreement     En 14          Playing Back       1 Basic Operat
304. source in another room from the main room   e 32 bit DSP  Digital Signal Processor  with excellent  calculation performance   e Music Optimizer    for compressed digital music files   e Phase Matching Bass System   e Automatic speaker setup available using supplied  calibrated microphone  AccuEQ Room Calibration    e Supports playback of MP3  WMA  WMA Lossless   FLAC  WAV  Ogg Vorbis  Apple Lossless  DSD  Dolby  TrueHD via network and USB storage device  the  supported formats will differ depending on the use  environment     Refer to the back cover for supplied accessories     En 2    Advanced Manual     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel      Remote Controller               D D0 uw       0             5 0  qd  5                   ON STANDBY SERIES HEET DEER  ODTS X JASA  1  I  O DOLBY ATMOS H                B  Si       Eet                                               LISTENING MODE r    CLEAR      MOVIE TV MUSIC GAME   DIMMER MEMORY TUNING MODE DISPLAY             Connections Initial Setup   Playing Back Advanced Manual  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller        5     MASTER VOLUME               porto nnn on nn on eo en oo eo eo oe oo ee ne en on no en nn nn nn nnn ne nn ee en nnn nn en nen one en nnn nn nn nnn ne Qn ne ren enn enn rn en enn rn nn nn nn nn nr nnn ne nn nnn een nnn nn en en nn    Posse ses He See See eee ee    p                                 AUX INPUT  PHONES HDMI    PURE AUDIO                                European  Australian  A B LL Les
305. t  Search  with the cursors and press ENTER    e After a search is done  the list of possible brand  names is displayed  If the brand name list is not  displayed  select  Not Listed  with the cursors and  press ENTER to return to the brand name input  screen in step 5    7  With the cursors  select the target brand name  and then  press ENTER    e When the brand name is specified  the remote  control code of the brand and how to register it will be  displayed on the TV screen     8  Follow the guidance displayed on the TV screen     9  If the component can successfully be operated with its  registered remote control code  select  OK  with the  cursors and press ENTER    e Only TV remote control codes can be entered for TV              Connections      Initial Setup       E Consulting the Remote Control Code List  Find the remote control code in the remote control code list     1  Look up the Remote Control Codes for the  corresponding remote control code    e The codes in the Remote Control Code List are those  known as of the date of publication and may be  changed    e The following REMOTE MODE buttons are  preprogrammed with remote control codes   BD DVD  Onkyo Blu ray Disc DVD player  CD  Onkyo CD player  STRM BOX  Apple TV   e Only TV remote control codes can be entered for TV    e Program a remote control code in accordance  with the input since each button also works as the  input selector   For example  when the CD player  is connected to the CD jack  program the remo
306. t 01615  Evertek 02302 Maige TV 03937  Finnet 02030 Matanuska 01481  02254   Freebox 01976 Telephone 02482  02586  Frontier 02378 Association  Communications Mega TV 02683  GDCATV 02980 Meo 02401  Google 03666  Guangdong Cable 02980             50       Connections    Initial Setup       MHTC    01481  01998   02254  02302   02482      Playing Back                      Minerva Networks    03118                      MIO    02275  02802       mio TV    02275  02802                      Mitsubishi Electric  MM amp G Enterprises    03274  01481  01998   02302  02482                                              PT 02401   Qwerty 01898  01481   01615   Qwerty TV 01898   Reliance 02556   RIO Media 02030   Rostelecom 03611   Sagem 02407  03288   Sagemcom 02436  02407   03007   Samsung 02407   SaskTel 01998                Scientific Atlanta    00858  02345   02047  02401   03028  02378                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             MOD 03647  01917   Motorola 02378  02437   01998  02030   00858  02952   02275  03916   01585  02401   Movistar 01585  03288   Moyo 03611   MTS 01998  03611   01615  01481   01898   MyLGTV 02682   Now TV 02009  02014   NTT 03237  03274   NU Telecom 01998  03028   Numericable 02436   Oi TV 03452  03454   04165   Open IPTV 01615   Optimus Clix 02437   Orange
307. t Listening Mode             Dolby D  Pure Audio  European     Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       Dolby D              Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music         DTS Neural X  Orchestra         Unplugged         Studio Mix 4       AllCh Stereo         Full Mono          DTS Pure Audio  European   Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo       DTS    2       Dolby Surround       Neo 6 Music          DTS Neural X  Orchestra         Unplugged         Studio Mix         AllCh Stereo         Full Mono          DTS Express Pure Audio  European     Australian and Asian models        Direct       Stereo   DTS Express    2  Dolby Surround  Neo 6 Music                 DTS Neural X       Orchestra          Unplugged    Studio Mix    AllCh Stereo     Full Mono                         1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch     2 Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed     4 Surround speakers or height speakers need to be installed     5 Center speaker  surround speakers or height speakers need to be  installed     Input Format Listening Mode     1 Cannot be selected when the input format is monaural or 2 ch       Center speaker or surround speakers need to be installed     3 Can only be selected when the input format is 2 ch and a center speaker  or surround speakers are installed       Surround spe
308. t be connected to the same  network as this unit    Up to 20 000 folders can be displayed  and folders may be  nested up to 16 levels deep     Caution  Depending on the media server  the unit may not  recognize it  or may not be able to play its music files     E Remote playback  Remote playback is the function that enables this unit to  play music files saved in different components by operating  the DLNA compliant controller component and PC in the  home network   e Windows Media  Player 12  e DLNA certified  within DLNA Interoperability Guidelines  version 1 5  media server or controller component     The setting varies depending on the media server or controller  components  Refer to your components  instruction manual for details   If the operating system of your personal PC is Windows   8 Windows  7  Windows Media  Player 12 is already  installed  For more information  see the Microsoft web site     USB Storage Device Requirements    e USB mass storage device class  but not always  guaranteed     e FAT16 or FAT32 file system format    e If the USB storage device has been partitioned  each  section will be treated as an independent device    e Up to 20 000 folders can be displayed  and folders may  be nested up to 16 levels deep    e USB hubs and USB storage devices with hub functions  are not supported  Do not connect these devices to the  unit     Caution   e  f the media you connect is not supported  the message  No  Storage  will be displayed     En 63               
309. t may appear in any communication from You  This License may not be  modified without the mutual written agreement of the Author and You     19  Tremolo   http   wss co uk pinknoise tremolo   Copyright  C  2002 2009 Xiph org Foundation Changes Copyright  C  2009 2010 Robin Watts for Pinknoise Productions Ltd  Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer      Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution      Neither the name of the Xiph org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission    THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS  OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF  USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS I
310. t user name and password to a shared folder   set  Permissions  in  Advanced Sharing  on the   Sharing  tab    e Check whether a workgroup is set     Oo OO PS Co M   A       Pla VINA  Playing    Playing from a Shared Folder    e Operation  You can set up by viewing the guidance   displayed on the TV screen  OSD   Select the item with the   cursor buttons of the remote controller and press ENTER   to confirm your selection  To return to the previous screen    press RETURN    e  European  Australian  Taiwanese and Asian models   If the OSD language is set to Chinese  the operations  in this section are not displayed on the TV  Operate by  looking at the display on the main unit  Note that the  display on the main unit does not support the display  of Chinese characters  Characters that cannot be  displayed are replaced with asterisks                                           PLAYLIST       E Playing Back    1  Press NET on the remote controller to display the NET  TOP screen   e  f the  NET  indicator on the display flashes  the unit  is not properly connected to the network  Check the  connection     CIC ICIO   alata   CO CO     CO  OC CO  ONNI                                               En 13        gt Remote Controller       Connections Initial Setup Playing Back andan  gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       5   tunein  SiriusXM Internet Radio  Slacker Personal Radio  Deezer  AirPlay       2  With the cursors  select  Home Media   and then press  ENTER  
311. te  control code for the CD player to CD     2  Press and hold DISPLAY for 3 or more seconds while  holding down the REMOTE MODE button to which you  want to program the remote control code    e  he remote indicator lights in the input mode     L4 t X  OO     O00  OOo      DISPLAY                3  With the number buttons  enter the 5 digit remote control  code within 30 seconds    e Programming is complete when the remote indicator  flashes twice  The remote indicator flashes once  slowly when programming the remote control code  fails  Try programming again                    Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       E Remapping the Colored Buttons    The colored button assignment on the AV receiver s remote  controller can be remapped to match that on the remote  controller of the component whose remote control code you  programmed to REMOTE MODE  However  you will not be  able to remap the colored buttons if Zone 2 is selected     1  Hold down the REMOTE MODE button to map andA   Red  simultaneously until the remote indicator lights   about 3 seconds     e Remapping is possible only for codes included in the  categories of the Remote Control Code List  DVD    player  TV  etc    ee   OO OO                      2 43 i  w O O CO  uw   OOO    2  Within 30 seconds  press the colored buttons from left to  right  in the order you want to remap    e For example  if the colored buttons on the remote  controller of the other component are yellow 
312. ted so that  music files stored in it can be played  USB devices can  be supplied with power when connected with a USB  cable     4  COMPONENT VIDEO IN jack  Component video input  jack      ETHERNET port  Used for LAN connection      COMPOSITE VIDEO IN jacks  Analog video signals are  input     7  HDMI IN OUT jacks  Digital video signals and audio  signals are transmitted between the unit and the  connected devices    Wireless antenna  Used for Wi   Fi connection or when using a  Bluetooth enabled device  Adjust  their angles according to the  connection status        En 4           N             AC INLET     Taiwanese models     DEE                        9 SPEAKERS terminals  Speakers are connected  To  use the Multi zone function  connect the speakers in the  separate room to the ZONE2 speaker terminals    Power cord  North American  European  Australian  and Asian models    AC INLET  Taiwanese models   The supplied power  cord is connected    41  DIGITAL IN COAXIAL OPTICAL jacks  Digital audio  signals are input     2  GND terminal  The ground wire of the turntable is  connected    d3 COMPOSITE AUDIO IN jacks  Analog audio signals are  input    LINE OUT ZONE 2 jack  Audio output jack connected  to the pre main amplifier for multi zone playback in a  separate room     5  PRE OUT SUBWOOFER jack  A subwoofer with built in  amplifier is connected      D Lights in the following conditions   Z2   Zone 2 output  is on     HDMI   HDMI signals are input and HDMI  input selector i
313. ter pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller    press one of the following four buttons   icut d    eZ  ke 2      OQ OO    2  Press the selected button repeatedly to switch the  modes displayed on the display of the unit   e Set the listening mode of your choice by listening to  the actual sound                    For details on the listening modes see  Listening Mode  Types   For listening modes selectable with each button   refer to  Selectable Listening Modes      En 16      Playing Back     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel       Listening Mode Types    The unit allows you to enjoy audio in a variety of listening  modes  This section lists the types of listening modes  available on the unit and describes their functions     ll Future listening mode update    A future firmware update is planned to enable the unit to   support playback in DTS X audio format  For this reason   the available listening modes will vary depending on the   firmware version     Versions before the release of an update with support for  the DTS X audio format  e Neo 6 Cinema and Neo 6 Music are available     Versions that support the DTS X audio format  e DTS X and DTS Neural X are available   Neo 6 Cinema  and Neo 6 Music become unavailable after the update      In alphabetical order    B AllCh Stereo    Ideal for background music  this mode fills the entire  listening area with stereo sound     B Direct    In this mode  audio from the input source is output as is   For example  if a 2 ch source 
314. ter standby  mode   ASb  will light      Off   The unit will not automatically enter  standby mode    e  Auto Standby  is appeared on the display  and TV screen 30 seconds before the Auto  Standby comes on    e  Auto Standby  does not work when Zone 2  is active    e Default values vary depending on the  regions        Auto Standby in  HDMI Standby  Through    Off    Enable or disable  Auto Standby  while  HDMI   Standby Through  is on     On   The setting will be enabled     Off   The setting will be disabled    e This setting cannot be set to  On  if  Auto  Standby  is set to  Off            Auto LipSync       On       This setting automatically corrects any  desynchronization between the video and audio  signals based on data from the HDMI LipSync  compatible TV     On   Automatic correction will be enabled    Off   Automatic correction will be disabled           USB Power Out at  Standby       Off       When this function is  On   you can still have  equipment connected to the USB port supplied  with power even when this unit is in standby    e When this function is being used  the power  consumption increases even when the unit  is on standby  However  the increase in  power consumption is kept to a minimum  by automatically entering the HYBRID  STANDBY mode  where only the essential  circuit is operating        En 41          Connections      Initial Setup    Playing Back  gt Front Panel   Rear Panel   Remote Controller                                                   
315. the library  you must  provide complete object files to the recipients  so that they can relink them with the library after making changes to the library and  recompiling it  And you must show them these terms so they know their rights    We protect your rights with a two step method   1  we copyright the library  and  2  we offer you this license  which gives you  legal permission to copy  distribute and or modify the library  To protect each distributor  we want to make it very clear that there  is no warranty for the free library  Also  if the library is modified by someone else and passed on  the recipients should know that  what they have is not the original version  so that the original author s reputation will not be affected by problems that might be  introduced by others    Finally  software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program  We wish to make sure that a company  cannot effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder  Therefore  we   insist that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the full freedom of use specified in   this license    Most GNU software  including some libraries  is covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License  This license  the GNU  Lesser General Public License  applies to certain designated libraries  and is quite different from the ordinary General Public  License  We use this license for certain libraries in
316. this unit to a simple one for  display on the equipment connected by network   1  Press ENTER to display the Edit screen   2  Select a character or symbol with the cursors  and press ENTER   Repeat it to input 31 or less characters    A a   Switches between upper and lower  cases   Pressing  10 on the remote  controller also toggles between upper and  lower cases     e Moves the cursor to the arrow  direction    OT Removes a character on the left of the  cursor    Space   Puts a space   e Pressing CLR on the remote controller will  remove all the input characters   3  After inputting  select  OK  with the cursors  and press ENTER   The input name will be saved     You can enter a password  maximum of 31  places  so that only the entered user can use  AirPlay   1  Press ENTER to display the Edit screen   2  Select a character or symbol with the cursors  and press ENTER   Repeat it to input 31 or less characters    A a   Switches between upper and lower  cases   Pressing  10 on the remote  controller also toggles between upper and  lower cases            Moves the cursor to the arrow  direction    OT Removes a character on the left of the  cursor    Space   Puts a space   e Pressing D on the remote controller will  switch whether to mask the password with   K  or display in the plain text   e Pressing CLR on the remote controller will  remove all the input characters   3  After inputting  select  OK  with the cursors  and press ENTER   The input password will be saved     UI   
317. time you change  Height Left 9 0ft 2 70m Specify the distance between each speaker and the value  Select the desired level   the listening position  Front Right 0 dB Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB    e This setting cannot be changed if _ A test tone will be output each time you change   Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to hevans Selectihe desired level  a Height Left 0 dB Select lue bet 12 dB   d   12 dB       T    Height Right 9 0ft 2 70m Specify the distance between each speaker and MEMMIUS SE Cen at een i Tra ie sicher S  ine 1S ening peso  the value  Select the d ired level      EL aget e This setting cannot be changed if  e EENEG  Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to   Yes  and Zone2 is set to on  RU M g    Yes  and Zone2 is set to on   Surround Right 7  Oft 2 10m Specify the distance between each speaker and  the listening position              En 34       50          Connections       Initial Setup      Playing Back     gt Front Panel  gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller             Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details    Setting Item Default Value   Setting Details          Height Right    0 dB    Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB     A test tone will be output each time you change   the value  Select the desired level    e This setting cannot be changed if   Configuration     Powered Zone 2  is set to   Yes  and Zone2 is set to on        Surround Right    0 dB    Select a value between   12 dB  and   12 dB    A test t
318. tion that corresponds to the jack where the player is  connected    e While the Pure Audio  European  Australian and Asian  models  listening mode is selected only video signals  input through HDMI IN can be output    e Check if  Resolution Error  is displayed on the main  unit display when video input via HDMI IN jack is not  displayed  In this case  the TV does not support the  resolution of the video input from the player  Change the  setting on the player    e Reliable operation with an HDMI to DVI adapter is not  guaranteed  In addition  video signals from a PC are not  supported    e Try switching off the DeepColor function  To turn off the       50       Connections    Initial Setup       DeepColor function  simultaneously press the STRM  BOX and OON STANDBY buttons on the main unit   While holding down STRM BOX  press OON STANDBY    To reactivate the DeepColor function  repeat the above  described step until  Deep Color On  is appeared on the  display     B  There is no picture from a source connected to the   component video input jack   e  f multiple video inputs are put into one input  the output  Will be made in the order of HDMI  COMPONENT  VIDEO composite video  In this case  to output  composite video  set  HDMI Input  to           E images flicker   e  t is possible that the resolution of the player is not  compatible with the TV s resolution  If you have  connected the player to this unit with an HDMI cable  try  changing the output resolution on the player  
319. tively    Company    We have no control over  the nature  content and availability of those services  The inclusion  of any links does not necessarily imply a recommendation or  endorse the views expressed within them    All information  content and services available through this device  belong to third parties and are protected by copyright  patent   trademark and or other intellectual property laws of applicable  countries    The information  content and services provided through this device  are for your personal  noncommercial use only  Any information   content or services may not be used in any manner other than  previously approved by the appropriate content owner or service     gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       provider    You may not modify  copy  republish  translate  exploit  create  derivative works  upload  post  transmit  sell or distribute in any  manner any information  content or services available through this  device  unless expressly permitted by the appropriate copyright   patent  trademark and or other intellectual property owner  including   without limitation  content owner or service provider    THE CONTENT AND SERVICES AVAILABLE THROUGH THIS  DEVICE ARE PROVIDED  AS IS     COMPANY DOES NOT WARRANT INFORMATION  CONTENT OR  SERVICES SO PROVIDED  EITHER EXPRESSLY OR IMPLIEDLY   FOR ANY PURPOSE    COMPANY EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTIES   EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED   TO  WARRANTIES OF TITLE  NON INFRINGEM
320. topped    e In reinforced concrete buildings or steel framed or iron  framed buildings    e Near large metallic furniture    In a crowd of people or near a building or obstacle    e In a location exposed to the magnetic field  static  electricity or radio wave interference from radio  communication equipment using the same frequency  band  2 4 GHz  as the AV receiver  such as a 2 4 GHz  wireless LAN device  IEEE802 11b g n  or microwave  oven    e  f you live in a heavily populated residential area       Playing Back     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel      Remote Controller        apartment  townhouse  etc   and if your neighbor s  microwave oven is placed near your AV receiver  you  may experience radio wave interference  If this occurs   move your AV receiver to a different place    When the microwave oven is not in use  there will be no  radio wave interference     Radio Wave Reflections    The radio waves received by the AV receiver include the  radio wave coming directly from the devices and waves  coming from various directions due to reflections by walls   furniture and building  reflected waves   The reflected  waves  due to obstacles and reflecting objects  further  produce a variety of reflected waves as well as variation   in reception condition depending on locations  If the audio   cannot be received properly due to this phenomenon  try  moving the location of the wireless LAN device a little    Also note that audio may be interrupted due to the reflected  waves whe
321. tribution    Jean loup Gailly Mark Adler   jloup gzip org madler alumni caltech edu    The data format used by the zlib library is described by RFCs  Request for Comments  1950 to 1952 in the files  ftp   ds internic net rfc rfc1950 txt  zlib format   r  c1951 txt  deflate format  and rfc1952 txt  gzip format      15  Apple Lossless   Apache License   Version 2 0  January 2004   http   www apache org licenses     TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE  REPRODUCTION  AND DISTRIBUTION  Definitions      License  shall mean the terms and conditions for use  reproduction  and distribution as defined by Sections 1 through 9 of this  document      Licensor  shall mean the copyright owner or entity authorized by the copyright owner that is granting the License      Legal Entity  shall mean the union of the acting entity and all other entities that control  are controlled by  or are under  common control with that entity  For the purposes of this definition   control  means  i  the power  direct or indirect  to cause the  direction or management of such entity  whether by contract or otherwise  or  ii  ownership of fifty percent  50   or more of the  outstanding shares  or  iii  beneficial ownership of such entity      You   or  Your   shall mean an individual or Legal Entity exercising permissions granted by this License      Source  form shall mean the preferred form for making modifications  including but not limited to software source code   documentation source  and configuration files    
322. turn to a normal state  If   CHECK SP WIRE  appears on the display  the speaker  cables may be short circuited  Turn the unit off  and  check to see if the cable core of any of the speaker  cables is in contact with that of another speaker cable or  with the rear panel  After that  turn the unit on again  If   NG  appears  unplug the power cord immediately and  contact your Onkyo dealer     WARNING  If smoke  smell or abnormal noise is produced  by the unit  unplug the power cord from the wall outlet  immediately and contact the dealer or Onkyo Support     Audio    e Make sure that the speaker setup microphone is not still  connected    e Check that the output jack of the connected equipment  and the input jack of this unit are connected correctly    e Make sure that none of the connecting cables are bent   twisted  or damaged    e If the MUTING indicator on the display flashes  press  MUTING on the remote controller to unmute the unit    e While headphones are connected to the PHONES jack   no sound is output from the speakers    e  f  Audio Select     PCM Fixed Mode  is set to  On   set  it to  Off     If the above does not solve the problem  check the   following     E There is no sound from the television   e The input selector of this unit needs to be in the position  that corresponds to the jack where the television is  connected    If your TV does not support ARC  you need  in addition  to the HDMI OUT MAIN jack connection  a digital optical  cable connection between t
323. ty     While redistributing the Work or Derivative Works thereof  You may choose to offer  and charge a fee for  acceptance of   support  warranty  indemnity  or other liability obligations and or rights consistent with this License  However  in accepting such  obligations  You may act only on Your own behalf and on Your sole responsibility  not on behalf of any other Contributor  and only  if You agree to indemnify  defend  and hold each Contributor harmless for any liability incurred by  or claims asserted against   such Contributor by reason of your accepting any such warranty or additional liability      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel    END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS  APPENDIX  How to apply the Apache License to your work     To apply the Apache License to your work  attach the following boilerplate notice  with the fields enclosed by brackets       replaced with your own identifying information   Don t include the brackets   The text should be enclosed in the appropriate  comment syntax for the file format  We also recommend that a file or class name and description of purpose be included on the  same  printed page  as the copyright notice for easier identification within third party archives     Copyright   2011 Apple Inc  All rights reserved     Licensed under the Apache License  Version 2 0  the  License     you may not use this file except in compliance with the License   You may obtain a copy of the License at    http   www apache org licenses LICENSE 2 0    Unless 
324. u may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy  and you may at your option offer warranty protection in  exchange for a fee    You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it  thus forming a work based on the Program  and copy  and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above  provided that you also meet all of these conditions     a  You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the  date of any change    b  You must cause any work that you distribute or publish  that in whole or in part contains or is derived from  the Program or any part thereof  to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License    c  If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run  you must cause it  when started    running for such interactive use in the most ordinary way  to print or display an announcement including an appropriate copyright  notice and a notice that there is no warranty  or else  saying that you provide a warranty  and that users may redistribute the  program under these conditions  and telling the user how to view a copy of this License   Exception  if the Program itself is  interactive but does not normally print such an announcement  your work based on the Program is not required to print an  announcement     These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole  If identifiable sections of that w
325. ual    e This unit needs to be connected to the same router as a  computer or NAS device     Home media    You can play music files in a shared folder on the computer  or NAS device connected to the network  Select the server  with the cursors  select the desired music file and press  ENTER to start playback   e This unit needs to be connected to the same router as a  computer or NAS device     r   USB    Connect the USB storage device to the USB port on the  rear of the unit  select the desired folder or music file  with the cursors  and press ENTER to confirm and start  playback     3 AirPlay         You can wirelessly enjoy music files stored on an iPhone     iPod touch    or iPad    You can also play back music files  on the computer with iTunes    Important  This unit needs to be connected to the network  through the same router as the iOS terminal or PC     E Playing music files from an iPhone  iPod  touch  or iPad    Update the OS version on your iOS device to the latest  version before connecting it to this unit     1  Press NET on the remote controller     2  Tap the AirPlay icon  select this unit from the list of  devices displayed  and click  Done         e The AirPlay icon is displayed in the control center if you  are using iOS 7 and later  To display the control center      gt Front Panel    3      gt Rear Panel   Remote Controller       swipe from the bottom of the screen of the iOS device   If the AirPlay icon is not displayed  confirm that this unit  and the 
326. udio TV Out  MAIN        Off       You can enjoy audio through the speakers of the   HDMI connected TV while this unit is on     On   Use this function   Off   Do not use this function   e To select  On   set  HDMI CEC  RIHD   to   Off     e The setting is fixed to  Auto  if  HDMI CEC   is set to  On     e Listening mode cannot be changed while   Audio TV Out  MAIN   is set to  On  and  audio is being output through the speakers  of the TV    e Depending on your TV set or input signal of  the component  audio may not output through  the speakers of the TV even if this setting  is set to  On   In such case  audio is output  from the speakers of the unit    e  f you operate the MASTER VOLUME control  on the unit when  Audio TV Out  MAIN   or   HDMI CEC  RIHD   is  On  and audio is  output from the TV speakers  audio will be  output from the unit  If you do not want to  output audio from the unit  change the unit or  TV settings  or reduce the volume of the unit    e This setting is fixed to  Off  if  TV Out      HDMI Out  is set to  SUB            Connections    Initial Setup    Playing Back          Setting Item    Default Value    Setting Details       Audio TV Out  SUB     Audio Return  Channel    Off    Auto    You can enjoy audio through the speakers of the  HDMI connected TV while this unit is on     On   Use this function    Off   Do not use this function    Listening mode cannot be changed while   Audio TV Out  SUB   is set to  On  and  audio is being output through the
327. undesirable consequences  the  authors accept NO LIABILITY for damages of any kind    These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the IJG code  not just to the unmodified library  If you use our  work  you ought to acknowledge us    Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG author s name or company name in advertising or publicity relating to this  software or products derived from it  This software may be referred to only as  the Independent JPEG Group s software     We specifically permit and encourage the use of this software as the basis of commercial products  provided that all warranty or  liability claims are assumed by the product vendor    ansi2knr c is included in this distribution by permission of L  Peter Deutsch  sole proprietor of its copyright holder  Aladdin  Enterprises of Menlo Park  CA  ansi2knr c is NOT covered by the above copyright and conditions  but instead by the usual  distribution terms of the Free Software Foundation  principally  that you must include source code if you redistribute it   See the  file ansi2knr c for full details   However  since ansi2knr c is not needed as part of any program generated from the IJG code  this  does not limit you more than the foregoing paragraphs do    The Unix configuration script  configure  was produced with GNU Autoconf  It is copyright by the Free Software Foundation but  is freely distributable  The same holds for its supporting scripts  config guess  config sub  Itconfig  Itmain s
328. unit or the speakers  Stop play on the  AirPlay enabled device immediately if the volume  becomes too loud at any point            Connections Initial Setup    4 Bluetooth         You can wirelessly enjoy music files stored in a smartphone  or other Bluetooth enabled device  The coverage area is 48  feet  15 meters    e The Bluetooth enabled device needs to support the  A2DP profile   e Note that connection is not always guaranteed with all  Bluetooth enabled devices     E Pairing   Pairing is necessary when connecting the Bluetooth   enabled device for the first time  Before starting the  procedure  learn how to enable the Bluetooth setting  function and to connect with other devices on the  Bluetooth enabled device     1  Press BLUETOOTH on the remote controller    The unit begins pairing and  Now Pairing     is displayed        NIE  ae a  CL m  C 20 CO C 2  eum    pc  DNN                                                     2  While    Now Pairing     is on the display  complete  connection on the Bluetooth enabled device in the  nearby area within about 2 minutes    If the name of this unit is displayed on the Bluetooth    enabled device s display  select this unit  Paring will end   after a short time    e  f a password is requested  enter  0000     e You can pair with another Bluetooth enabled device  by pressing and holding the BLUETOOTH button  until  Now Pairing     is on the display  This unit can  store the data of up to 8 paired devices     E Playing Bluetooth enab
329. unit s z   jacks and speaker s jacks    to   and   to    for each P d  channel  If connection is wrong  a bass sound may become A    poor due to reverse phase  Up to two subwoofers with  built in power amplifier can be connected to the subwoofer  jacks  Set the cut off filter selection switch of the subwoofer  to DIRECT  If the subwoofer does not have a cut off filter  selection switch but has a cut off frequency adjusting dial   turn it to the maximum frequency  If your subwoofer does  not have built in power amplifier  you can connect a power  amplifier between the unit and the subwoofer    e The speaker setting is 7 1 channels at the time of  purchase  You can change it manually or by using  automatic speaker setting    e Short circuiting the   cable and   cable or contacting  the cable core to the rear panel of the unit may cause  failure  Also do not connect two or more cables to one  speaker terminal or one speaker to several terminals           En 7       Initial Setup Playing Back Advanced Manual  gt Remote Controller     gt Front Panel   Rear Panel       2 Connecting the TV and players       HDMI  assiGNABLE                     HDCP 2 2    BD DVD         HDCP 2 2   HDCP 2 2    CBL SAT  3  STRMBOX  4  PC           2       TV                                                 EL  To use the ARC function  connect to the ARC  compatible HDMI jack of the TV and make an  appropriate setting on the unit  See  2 Source    Connection  of  Step 2  Initial Setup    a kl D Sij L a 
330. ur living room     E ES Discrete  DTS ES Discrete     This mode is for use with DTS ES Discrete sources and  enables 6 1 ch or 7 1 ch playback using back channel   Completely discrete seven channels will improve spatial  imaging and enable 360 degree sound localization  producing a sound crossing between the surround  channels    e This listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream    e Use on the DVD with DTS ES logo  particularly on the  software containing DTS ES Matrix soundtrack     E ES Matrix  DTS ES Matrix     This mode is for use with DTS ES Matrix soundtrack and  enables 6 1 ch or 7 1 ch playback using matrix encoded  back channel    e  his listening mode can be selected only if your Blu ray  Disc DVD player is digitally connected to the unit or the  player s output setting is bitstream    e Use on the CD  DVD or LD with DTS ES logo   particularly on the software containing DTS ES Matrix  soundtrack     B Full Mono    In this mode  all speakers output the same sound in mono   so the sound you hear is the same regardless of where you  are within the listening room     E Game Action    In this mode  sound localization is distinct with emphasis  on bass     E Game Rock    In this mode  sound pressure is emphasized to heighten  live feel     E Game RPG    In this mode  the sound has a dramatic feel with a similar  atmosphere to Orchestra mode     E Game Sports  Suitabl
331. ur own  risk    Onkyo will not be liable and you will have no remedy for  damages for any claim of any kind whatsoever concerning  your use of the program or the accompanying online  documentation  regardless of legal theory  and whether  arising in tort or contract    In no event will Onkyo be liable to you or any third party for  any special  indirect  incidental  or consequential damages  of any kind  including  but not limited to  compensation   reimbursement or damages on account of the loss of  present or prospective profits  loss of data  or for any other  reason whatsoever     En 54          Playing Back    Updating the Firmware via Network    Before Starting    e Check that the unit is turned on  and the connection to    the Internet is secured     e Turn off the controller component  PC etc   connected to    the network     e Stop any playing Internet radio  USB storage device  or    server content     e If the multi zone function is active  press OFF on the    main unit to turn it off     e If  HDMI CEC  RIHD   is set to  On   set it to  Off      default value          After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller   press SETUP  Then  after selecting  6  Hardware      HDMI  and pressing ENTER  select  HDMI CEC     RIHD   to select  Off      x The description may differ from the on screen display but that will not    change the way to operate or the function     E Update    1  After pressing RECEIVER on the remote controller     press SETUP                 TIDE  
332. ure  ws  Actual display varies  zc EDO se um   depending on the country  Dat PH SET  FM STEREO    Registering a radio station  You can register up to 40   of your favorite AM FM radio stations    1  Tune into the AM FM radio station you want to  register    2  Press MEMORY on the unit so that the preset  number on the display flashes    3  Press   PRESET   on the unit several times to  select a number between 1 and 40 while the preset  number is flashing  about 8 seconds      4  Press MEMORY again on the main unit to register  the station      gt Front Panel     gt Rear Panel  gt Remote Controller       When registered  the preset number stops flashing   To select a preset radio station  press   PRESETS  on the main unit or CH     on the remote controller     e To delete a preset station  after selecting the preset    number you want to delete with   PRESET on the  main unit  press TUNING MODE while holding down  MEMORY on the main unit  When the preset number is  deleted  it disappears from the display     AM FM frequency step setting   It may be necessary for you to change the  frequency step to tune the radio in your area   Change the step with the following procedure  Note  that when this setting is changed  all radio presets  are deleted     1 After pressing   RECEIVER on the remote  controller  press SETUP    2  Use the cursor buttons to select  6  Hardware   and press ENTER    3  Select  Tuner  with the cursor and press ENTER    4  Select  AM   FM Frequency Step   Nort
333. uses the Library  with the  Library to produce a work containing portions of the Library  and distribute that work under terms of your  choice  provided that the terms permit modification of the work for the customer s own use and reverse  engineering for debugging such modifications   You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are  covered by this License  You must supply a copy of this License  If the work during execution displays copyright notices  you  must include the copyright notice for the Library among them  as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this  License  Also  you must do one of these things   8  Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine readable source code for the Library  including whatever changes were used in the work  which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above    and  if the work is an executable linked with the Library  with the complete machine readable  work that  uses the Library   as object code and or source code  so that the user can modify the Library and then relink  to produce a modified executable containing the modified Library   It is understood that the user who changes  the contents of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use  the modified definitions    b  Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library  A suitable mechanism is one that 
334. ut fee  and encourage the use of this source code as a  component to supporting the PNG file format in commercial products  If you use this source code in a product  acknowledgment  is not required but would be appreciated    8  libvorbis  Copyright  c  2002 2004 Xiph org Foundation  Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the following  conditions are met     Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer     Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution     Neither the name of the Xiph org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission   THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS  OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL  DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF  USE  DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AN
335. ver automatically turns on  and selects  the input to which the Blu ray Disc DVD player   recorder is connected    e The TV automatically turns on  and selects the input  to which the AV receiver is connected    5  Following the instruction manual of the TV  select  Use  the TV speakers  from the menu screen of the TV  and  confirm that the audio is output from the speakers of  the TV  and not from the speakers connected to the AV  receiver    6  Select  Use the speakers connected from the AV  receiver  from the menu screen of the TV  and confirm  that the audio is output from the speakers connected to  the AV receiver  and not from the TV speakers     Caution    e Even if you set to output audio on the TV speakers  audio will  be output from the speakers connected to the AV receiver when  you adjust the volume or switch the input on the AV receiver    To output audio from the TV speakers  redo the corresponding  operations on the TV    e  n case of an RIHD connection with RI and RI EX audio control  compatible components  do not connect the RI cable at the  same time    e On the TV  when you select anything other than the HDMI  jack to which the AV receiver is connected  the input on the AV  receiver will be switched to  TV     e The AV receiver will automatically power on in conjunction  when it determines it to be necessary  Even if the AV receiver  is connected to an RIHD compatible TV or player recorder  it  will not power on if it is not necessary  It may not power on i
336. ware   Permission is hereby granted  free of charge  to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files   the  Software    to deal in the Software without restriction  including without limitation the rights to use  copy  modify  merge   publish  distribute  sublicense  and or sell copies of the Software  and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do  so  subject to the following conditions    The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software   THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  AS IS   WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND  NONINFRINGEMENT  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE X CONSORTIUM BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM  DAMAGES OR   OTHER LIABILITY  WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT  TORT OR OTHERWISE  ARISING FROM  OUT OF OR IN  CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE    Except as contained in this notice  the name of the X Consortium shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the  sale  use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from the X Consortium     12  RSA Data Security  Inc  MD5 Message Digest Algorithm   Copyright  C  1991 2  RSA Data Security  Inc  Created 1991  All rights reserved    License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it is identified as the  RSA Data S
337. x 13835 11498  11687   Panda 10698  10208  11767  12676   10508 14035  12125   PARK 12104   uz  Penney 10178 Powerpoint 10037  10698  Peony 10208 Premier 13419  13183   Perdio 10037   19799  Perfekt 10037 Prestiz 13419  Philco 10171  13426  Es SE E  12414  11394  EE i  10037  10178     1 3639 Prinston 1 1 037    Pro Vision 10037  10556  Phil 11887  11867       me 10037  12372 10714  12197  12800  10556  Profitronic 10037  13614  11506  ProLine 10625  10634   11744  12768  10037  11037   12680  11454  12676  10639  11866  Proscan 11447  12183   10017  10512  12256  13577   13623  10171  13382  13332   12769  11365  13717  13895   11394  10000  12746  13636   10178  11589 14035  Phocus 10714 Prosonic 10714  12676   Phoenix 10037 12125  10668   PHOENIX Apollo 12239 12197  10037   Phonola 10037  10556 a 11585   Pi 10679  11457   Gees KEE Protech 10037  10668   11636  10512  11037  12171 Proton 10178  PJ 11506 Proview 11687  11498  Planar 10679  14247  Proxima 10735  11589 Pulsar 10017  Plantron 10037 Pye 10037  10556  Playsonic 10714  10037 Q Bell 12561  Quadro 11667  QuantumFX 12397  Quasar 11291  13899              10650          50       Connections       Initial Setup         Playing Back             Rolsen    12098  13067   13434                   Rowa    10898  13047   10698  11038   13001  10037                RTF    10037          Runco    10017                   Saba    10625  12676   10714          Saga    12197       Sagem    10618                   Saivod    10668  11
338. y  connected  and make sure they are both turned on    e Make sure that the router LAN side port is properly    En 59       50          Connections      Initial Setup       connected to the AV receiver    e Make sure that connecting to Internet from other  components is possible  If connecting is not possible   turn off all components connected to the network  wait  for a while  and then turn on the components again    e  f a specific radio station is unavailable for listening   make sure the registered URL is correct  or whether the  format distributed from the radio station is supported by  this unit     e Depending on ISP  setting the proxy server is necessary     e Make sure that the used router and or modem is  supported by your ISP     Bl Cannot access the network server   e This unit needs to be connected to the same router as  the network server    e Make sure your network server has been started up    e Make sure your network server is properly connected to  the home network    e Make sure your network server is correctly set    e Make sure that the router LAN side port is properly  connected to the AV receiver     E Playback stops while listening to music files on the   network server   e Make sure the network server is compatible with this  unit    e When the PC is serving as the network server  try  quitting any application software other than the server  software  Windows Media  Player 12 etc      e If the PC is downloading or copying large files  the  playback m
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
pt5180p2 rev2.book  "取扱説明書"  Citizen Services Manual  - Information Management Services  CFP-15M Manual  DOLBY® Digital Cinema System  Decorrugation (T32) - Intrepid Geophysics  manual MOP  Technical Specifications  Lenovo ThinkPad T420S  42720 - Protocol (48 preps)    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file